Quarterlytics / Financial Services / Banks - Regional / Banner

Banner

banr · NASDAQ Financial Services
Claim this profile
Ticker banr
Exchange NASDAQ
Sector Financial Services
Industry Banks - Regional
Employees 1001-5000
← All annual reports
FY2024 Annual Report · Banner
Sign in to download
Loading PDF…
Banner Corporation 
2024 Annual Report 
Dear Fellow Shareholders: 
Consistently delivering solid financial results is our long-standing, unwavering 
goal. We’ve been doing just that for many years. That may seem boring to some, 
but I believe it signals reliability. After all, delivering value to our shareholders is 
what’s important. We’re happy to be called “boring”—especially during times of 
considerable economic uncertainty. 
Each year we focus on being a top-tier performer among our regional peers, 
and we delivered that again last year. We achieved it by staying focused on 
what we can control—consistently implementing our super community bank 
strategy, maximizing our net interest margin advantage, delivering outstanding 
service, and effectively maintaining our moderate risk profile. Some years we 
create opportunities and can over-deliver profit, and other years we overcome 
operating environment challenges to deliver more modest gains. You can count 
on us to remain focused on leveraging our strengths in this regard. What’s 
“boring” at first glance is rich with stability and dependability. 
Growing Shareholder Value 
Despite a year of economic uncertainty, we delivered solid results and 
profitability in 2024, gaining momentum as the year progressed and positioning 
us well going into 2025. Revenue was $608.6 million and net income was 
$168.9 million, or $4.88 per diluted share, and cash dividends were $1.92 per 
share, consistent with the prior year. We increased common shareholder equity 
per share to $51.49, compared to $48.12 a year ago. We continue to focus on 
delivering long-term value on your investment, as evidenced by the cumulative 
total shareholder return of 43% over the past five years. 
Stable Deposits Deliver Loan Growth 
We closed 2024 with $13.51 billion in deposits, a nice increase in a highly 
competitive rate environment. Our core deposits remained strong, representing 
89% of total deposits—higher than most of our peers. Generating our own stable 
on-balance sheet liquidity remained fundamental to our success and provided 
flexibility to fund loan growth. 
We grew outstanding loan balances five percent in 2024, with demand trending 
upward as the year progressed—despite another year of weakened loan demand 
across the industry. We took advantage of market disruption and the broader 
liquidity crisis across the financial sector that began in 2023 and continued into 
2024. By staying true to our moderate risk profile and diversified loan portfolio— 
by business type, industry, loan type and geographic market—we remained stable 
during a time of market volatility. This set us apart and allowed our experienced 
team to continue servicing the needs of our existing clients and gain new market 
share, especially in our Commercial Banking and Commercial Real Estate loan 
segments. In fact, year-over-year production was up for most loan types. 
Net Interest Margin 
Last year’s loan growth and yields on interest-earning assets allowed us to 
maintain a strong net interest margin of 3.75% at year-end on a tax equivalent 
basis. Thanks to our steady low-cost deposits and strong client relationships, our 
net interest margin remained stronger than many peer banks. 
President and CEO 
Mark Grescovich 
Deposit Portfolio 
34% 
Non-interest 
bearing deposits 
55% 
Interest-bearing transaction 
and savings accounts 
11% 
CDs 
$13.51B 
Total Deposits 
Loan Portfolio 
34% CRE* 
14% Residential 
6% Consumer 
24% Commercial/Agriculture 
8% Multifamily 
14% Construction 
$11.35B 
*CRE: 
9% Owner Occupied 
14% Investment Properties 
11%  Small Balance CRE 

Employee-Driven Results 
Our highly engaged workforce and performance-driven culture proved 
fundamental to our success again last year. Results from our 2024 employee 
engagement survey showed an impressive 86% overall favorable engagement 
score, which is well above the 70% mark for a best-practice organization in the U.S. 
We invested in several important projects last year, continuing our commitment to 
invest in innovation and scalability, continually improving back-end processes and 
efficiencies. Most noteworthy was selecting a new loan and deposit origination 
system and planning its implementation, which will happen in 2025. Our largest 
technology improvement initiative in decades, this investment will considerably 
expedite account opening, provide a superior client experience and greatly improve 
our related efficiency. We also completed several highly impactful continuous 
improvement projects, creating long-lasting benefits to our operating performance 
and productivity. 
Select Financial Highlights 
Our results remain rooted in maintaining our moderate risk profile, cultivating 
our fortress balance sheet and focusing on long-term client relationships. Our 
performance last year again demonstrated our ability to thrive in all economic 
cycles and change events. The company’s 2024 financial highlights include: 
• Assets grew to $16.20 billion. 
• Total revenue was $608.6 million. 
• Net income was $168.9 million, or $4.88 per diluted share. 
• Net interest margin, on a tax equivalent basis, was 3.75%. 
• Total deposits were $13.51 billion, up from $13.03 billion in 2023, with core 
deposits representing 89% of total deposits. 
• Net loans receivable increased 5% to $11.20 billion, an all-time high, and 
average loan yields increased to 5.97%, compared to 5.58% the prior year. 
• Return on average assets was 1.07% for the year. 
Additional Accomplishments 
We received independent recognition from numerous national sources last year 
for our financial strength and stability as well as our outstanding customer service, 
further affirming our value proposition continues to resonate with clients. For 
the eighth consecutive year, Forbes ranked us one of America’s 100 Best Banks. 
Newsweek named us to their inaugural list of the Best Regional Banks in America. 
Newsweek also named Banner one of the Most Trustworthy Companies in America 
and the highest-ranking domestic bank on their list of the World’s Most Trustworthy 
Companies. Additionally, 2024 was our eleventh year with a five-star rating from 
BauerFinancial with the additional designation of an Exceptional Performance Bank. 
At the close of the year, deposits were stable, loan production was trending up and 
pipelines were strong. As we turn toward 2025, we remain committed to taking 
advantage of market disruption to deliver organic growth while continuing to 
identify new opportunities to increase revenue and limit expenses. Our talented 
team understands that by doing everyday tasks well, we earn the right to continue 
serving our clients and gain new banking relationships. You can expect us to 
stay true to our values and guiding principle to ‘do the right thing’ for all our 
shareholders, clients, employees and communities, while striving to deliver value to 
you in the form of consistent, reliable returns on your investment. 
Sincerely, 
Mark Grescovich 
President and Chief Executive Officer 
Banner Corporation and Banner Bank 
Cash Dividend Per Share 
$1.23 
$1.64 
$1.76 
$1.92 $1.92 
2020 2021 2022 2023 2024 
$0.00 
$0.25 
$0.50 
$0.75 
$1.00 
$1.25 
$1.50 
$1.75 
$2.00 
Each total above is from year-end. 

Directors 
Roberto R. Herencia 
(Chairman) 
Ellen R.M. Boyer 
Connie R. Collingsworth 
Margot J. Copeland 
Mark J. Grescovich 
David A. Klaue 
John R. Layman 
John Pedersen 
Kevin F. Riordan 
Terry S. Schwakopf 
Paul J. Walsh 
Executive Officers 
Mark J. Grescovich, President and Chief Executive Officer 
Robert G. Butterfield, EVP, Chief Financial Officer 
Mark Borrecco, EVP, Chief Banking Officer 
Janet M. Brown, EVP, Chief Information Officer 
James M. Costa, EVP Chief Risk Officer and 
Chief Operating Officer 
Karen Harrison, EVP, Community Banking Executive 
Kayleen R. Kohler, EVP, Human Resources, 
Chief Diversity Officer 
Kenneth A. Larsen, EVP, Mortgage Banking Director 
Sherrey Luetjen, EVP, General Counsel, Secretary 
James P.G. McLean, EVP, Commercial Real Estate 
Lending Division 
Scott Newman, EVP, Chief Audit Executive 
Cynthia D. Purcell, EVP, Chief Strategy and 
Administration Officer 
M. Kirk Quillin, EVP, Chief Commercial Banking 
Executive 
James T. Reed, Jr., EVP, Commercial Banking 
Jill M. Rice, EVP, Chief Credit Officer 
Director and executive officer information is as of December 31, 2024. 
Our Value Proposition 
Connected. Knowledgeable. Responsive. 
It’s not only what we do, it’s how we do it—with relentless effort. 
Our Vision Statement 
We strive to be the bank of choice in the markets we serve. We 
are committed to being the best provider of financial services in 
the West. 
Our Mission Statement 
Banner Bank is a dynamic, full-service financial institution operating 
safely and profitably within a framework of shared integrity. 
Working as a team, we will deliver superior products and services to 
our valued clients. We will emphasize strong client relationships and a 
high level of community involvement. We will provide a culture which 
attracts, empowers, rewards and provides growth opportunities for 
our employees. Our success will build long-term shareholder value. 
Values 
“Do the Right Thing.” 
This means we believe in: 
• Honesty and Integrity 
• Mutual Respect 
• Quality 
• Trust 
• Teamwork 
• Accountability 
Markets We Serve 
San Diego 
Los Angeles 
Sacramento 
Boise 
Medford 
Portland 
Seattle 
Spokane 
Yakima 
Walla Walla 
Eugene 
Vancouver 
Tri-Cities 
Bellevue 
Bellingham 
Tacoma 
Wenatchee 
Lewiston 
Clarkston 
Pendleton 
Coos Bay 
Ontario 
Red Bluff 

Corporate Headquarters 
10 South First Avenue 
PO Box 907 
Walla Walla, WA 99362-0265 
509-527-3636 
800-272-9933 
Website: bannerbank.com 
Email: bannerbank@bannerbank.com 
Subsidiaries 
Banner Bank – bannerbank.com 
Community Financial Corporation 
Transfer Agent and Registrar 
Computershare Trust Company, N.A. 
150 Royall St., Suite 101 
Canton, MA 02021 
Independent Public Accountants 
and Auditors 
Moss Adams LLP 
Fox Tower 
805 SW Broadway, Suite 1400 
Portland, OR 97205 
Special Counsel 
Breyer & Associates PC 
8180 Greensboro Drive, Suite 785 
McLean, VA 22102 
Annual Meeting of Shareholders 
10 a.m. Pacific Time, Thursday, May 22, 2025
The Annual Meeting of Shareholders will be conducted 
solely online via live webcast. 
You can attend by visiting: 
https://meetnow.global/MKLZ2QL 
No password is required, though to vote or ask a 
question, shareholders must provide their unique 
control number. 
Dividend Payments 
Dividend payments are reviewed quarterly by the 
board of directors and, if appropriate and authorized, 
typically would be paid in the months of February, May, 
August and November. To avoid delay or lost mail, and 
to reduce costs, we encourage you to request direct 
deposit of dividend payments to your bank account. 
To enroll in the Direct Deposit Plan, call 
Computershare Investor Services at 800-697-8924. 
Dividend Reinvestment and 
Stock Purchase Plan 
Banner Corporation offers a dividend reinvestment 
program whereby shareholders may reinvest all or a 
portion of their dividends in additional shares of the 
Company’s common stock. Information concerning 
this optional program is available from the Investor 
Relations Department or from Computershare 
Investor Services at 800-697-8924. 
Investor Information 
Shareholders and others will find the Company’s 
financial information, press releases and other 
information on the Company’s website at 
www.bannerbank.com. 
Investor Relations, Banner Corporation 
PO Box 907 
Walla Walla, WA 99362 
Or call 800-272-9933 to obtain a hard copy of these 
reports, including exhibits, without charge. 
SKU: 004CTN3E23 
Member FDIC 

2024 
Banner Corporation 10-K 

UNITED STATES 
SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION 
Washington, D.C. 20549 
FORM 10-K 
☒ 
ANNUAL REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d) OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934 FOR 
THE FISCAL YEAR ENDED DECEMBER 31, 2024 
OR 
☐ 
TRANSITION REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d) OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934 FOR 
THE TRANSITION PERIOD FROM __________to__________ 
 Commission File Number 0-26584 
BANNER CORPORATION 
(Exact name of registrant as specified in its charter) 
Washington 
 (State or other jurisdiction of incorporation 
 or organization) 
91-1691604 
 (I.R.S. Employer 
 Identification Number) 
10 South First Avenue, Walla Walla, Washington 99362 
(Address of principal executive offices and zip code) 
Registrant’s telephone number, including area code: (509) 527-3636 
Securities registered pursuant to Section 12(b) of the Act: 
Common Stock, par value $.01 per share 
(Title of Each Class) 
BANR 
(Trading Symbol) 
The NASDAQ Stock Market LLC 
(Name of Each Exchange on Which Registered) 
Securities registered pursuant to section 12(g) of the Act: 
None. 
Indicate by check mark if the registrant is a well-known seasoned issuer, as defined in Rule 405 of the Securities Act  Yes ☒  No  ☐ 
Indicate by check mark if the registrant is not required to file reports pursuant to Section 13 or Section 15(d) of the Act  Yes  ☐  No ☒ 
Indicate by check mark whether the registrant (1) has filed all reports required to be filed by Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange 
Act of 1934 during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the registrant was required to file such reports), and (2) has been 
subject to such filing requirements for the past 90 days.  Yes ☒  No ☐ 
Indicate by check mark whether the registrant has submitted electronically every Interactive Data File required to be submitted pursuant to 
Rule 405 of Regulation S-T (§232.405 of this chapter) during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the registrant was 
required to submit such files)  Yes ☒   No ☐ 
Indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a large accelerated filer, an accelerated filer, a non-accelerated filer, a smaller reporting 
company or emerging growth company. See definition of "large accelerated filer," "accelerated filer," "smaller reporting company" and 
emerging growth company in Rule 12b-2 of the Exchange Act: 
Large accelerated filer 
☒ 
Accelerated filer     
☐ 
Non-accelerated filer      
☐ 
Smaller reporting company  
☐ 
Emerging growth company  
☐ 
If an emerging growth company, indicate by check mark if the registrant has elected not to use the extended transition period for complying 
with any new or revised financial accounting standards pursuant to Section 13(a) of the Exchange Act. ☐ 
Indicate by check mark whether the registrant has filed a report on and attestation to its management’s assessment of the effectiveness of its 
internal control over financial reporting under Section 404(b) of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act (15 U. S. C 7262(b)) by the registered public 
accounting firm that prepared or issued its audit report.  Yes ☒  No ☐ 
If securities are registered pursuant to Section 12(b) of the Act, indicate by check mark whether the financial statements of the registrant 
included in the filing reflect the correction of an error to previously issued financial statements.  ☐ 
Indicate by check mark whether any of those error corrections are restatements that required a recovery analysis of incentive-based 
compensation received by any of the registrant’s executive officers during the relevant recovery period pursuant to §240.10D-1(b).  ☐ 
Indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a shell company (as defined in Rule 12b-2 of the Act)  Yes ☐  No  ☒ 

The aggregate market value of the voting and non-voting common equity held by non-affiliates of the registrant based on the closing sales 
price of the registrant’s common stock quoted on The NASDAQ Stock Market on June 30, 2024, was: 
Common Stock – $1,685,017,638 
 (The exclusion from such amount of the market value of the shares owned by any person shall not be deemed an admission by the Registrant 
that such person is an affiliate of the Registrant.) 
 The number of shares outstanding of each of the classes of the registrant’s classes of common stock as of January 31, 2025: 
Common Stock, $.01 par value – 34,459,832 shares 
Documents Incorporated by Reference 
Portions of Proxy Statement for Annual Meeting of Shareholders to be held May 22, 2025 are incorporated by reference into Part III. 

BANNER CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES 
Table of Contents 
Forward-Looking Statements 
1 
PART I 
Item 1. Business  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
2 
General 
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 
 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 
 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 
 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 
2 
Lending Activities 
2 
Asset Quality 
6 
Investment Activities 
6 
Deposit Activities and Other Sources of Funds 
7 
Personnel 
8 
Taxation  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
11 
Competition . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
11 
Regulation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
11 
Corporate Information  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 
17 
Item 1A. Risk Factors  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
18 
Item 1B. Unresolved Staff Comments  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 
29 
Item 1C. Cybersecurity  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
30 
Item 2. Properties  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
31 
Item 3. Legal Proceedings 
 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 
 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
 . . . . . . . . . . . .
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
 
 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 
 
 
 
 
 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 
 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 
 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 
 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 
 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 
 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 
 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 
 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
31 
Item 4. Mine Safety Disclosures  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 
31 
PART II 
Item 5. Market for Registrant’s Common Equity, Related Stockholder Matters and Issuer Purchases of Equity Securities . . . . . . . . . 
32 
Item 6. Reserved  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 
33 
Item 7. Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 
34 
Executive Overview  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 
34 
Comparison of Financial Condition  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 
39 
Comparison of Results of Operations  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 
51 
Market Risk and Asset/Liability Management  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 
58 
Liquidity and Capital Resources . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 
63 
Capital Requirements  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 
64 
Item 7A. Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures About Market Risk . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 
64 
Item 8. Financial Statements and Supplementary Data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 
65 
Item 9. Changes in and Disagreements with Accountants on Accounting and Financial Disclosure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 
65 
Item 9A. Controls and Procedures  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 
65 
Item 9B. Other Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 
65 
Item 9C. Disclosure Regarding Foreign Jurisdictions that Prevent Inspections  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 
65 
PART III 
Item 10. Directors, Executive Officers and Corporate Governance  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 
66 
Item 11. Executive Compensation  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 
66 
Item 12. Security Ownership of Certain Beneficial Owners and Management and Related Stockholder Matters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 
66 
Item 13. Certain Relationships and Related Transactions, and Director Independence  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 
67 
Item 14. Principal Accountant Fees and Services  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 
67 
PART IV 
Item 15. Exhibits and Financial Statement Schedules  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 
68 
Item 16. Form 10-K Summary  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 
69 
Signatures  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 
71 

Forward-Looking Statements 
Certain matters in this Form 10-K constitute forward-looking statements within the meaning of the Private Securities Litigation Reform Act 
of 1995. Forward-looking statements include statements with respect to our beliefs, plans, objectives, goals, expectations, assumptions and 
statements about future economic performance and projections of financial items, including statements about our financial condition, liquidity 
and results of operations. Forward-looking statements are not statements of historical fact, are based on certain assumptions and are generally 
identified by use of the words “believes,” “expects,” “anticipates,” “estimates,” “forecasts,” “intends,” “plans,” “targets,” “potentially,” 
“probably,” “projects,” “outlook” or similar expressions or future or conditional verbs such as “may,” “will,” “should,” “would” and “could.”  
These forward-looking statements are subject to known and unknown risks, uncertainties and other factors that could cause our actual results 
to differ materially from the results anticipated or implied by our forward-looking statements, including, but not limited to: 
• 
Adverse economic conditions in our market areas or other areas where we have lending relationships, due to factors such as 
employment levels, labor shortages, inflation, a recession, or slowed economic growth. 
• 
Changes in the interest rate environment, including past increases or decreases in the Board of Governors of the Federal Reserve 
System’s (Federal Reserve) benchmark rate, which could adversely affect our revenues, expenses, asset values, debt obligations, 
and liquidity. 
• 
Impact of inflation and the Federal Reserve’s monetary policies. 
• 
Effects of any federal government shutdown. 
• 
Credit risks from lending activities, including changes in loan delinquencies, write-offs, and the allowance for credit loss, and our 
ability to manage loan delinquency rates. 
• 
Competitive pressures in the financial services industry, including repricing and competitors’ pricing initiatives on loan and deposit 
products. 
• 
Changes in consumer spending and borrowing habits. 
• 
Interest rate movements and the relative differences between short and long-term interest rates, loan and deposit rates, net interest 
margin, and funding sources. 
• 
Impact of bank failures or adverse developments at other banks and related negative press on investor, depositor and borrower 
sentiment. 
• 
Fluctuations in demand for loans, unsold homes, land, and real estate values. 
• 
Expectations regarding key growth initiatives and strategic priorities. 
• 
Ability to adapt to technological changes both internally and to meet client needs. 
• 
Ability to access cost-effective funding and to control operating costs and expenses. 
• 
Use of estimates in determining fair value of certain assets and liabilities, which may prove incorrect and significantly change 
valuations. 
• 
Staffing fluctuations in response to product demand or corporate strategies, and potential associated charges. 
• 
Disruptions, security breaches, or other adverse events, failures, or attacks on information technology systems or critical third-party 
vendors. 
• 
Secondary market conditions for loans and ability to sell loans in the secondary market. 
• 
Costs, effects, and outcomes of litigation. 
• 
Legislative or regulatory changes, including changes in policies, principles, or interpretations of regulatory capital or other rules. 
• 
Results of safety and soundness and compliance examinations by regulatory authorities, which may require restitution, increased 
reserves for credit losses, write-downs of assets, or changes in regulatory capital position, affecting liquidity and earnings. 
• 
Availability of resources to address changes in laws, rules, or regulations, or to respond to regulatory actions. 
• 
Quality and composition of our securities portfolio and impact of adverse changes in the securities markets. 
• 
Inability of key third-party providers to perform their obligations. 
• 
The potential imposition of new tariffs or changes to existing trade policies that could affect economic activity or specific industry 
sectors. 
• 
Changes in accounting principles, policies, or guidelines, including additional guidance on and interpretation of accounting issues. 
• 
Environmental, social, and governance goals and targets. 
• 
Effects of climate change, severe weather, natural disasters, pandemics, public health crises, acts of war or terrorism, civil unrest 
and other external events on our business. 
• 
Other economic, competitive, governmental, regulatory, and technological factors affecting operations, pricing, products, and 
services. 
• 
Future acquisitions of other depository institutions or lines of business, and associated risks of goodwill impairment due to changes 
in our business or market conditions. 
• 
Other risks detailed from time to time in our reports filed with and furnished to the U.S. Securities and Exchange Commission 
(SEC), including this Annual Report on Form 10-K. 
Any forward-looking statements are based upon Management’s beliefs and assumptions at the time they are made. We do not undertake and 
specifically disclaim any obligation to update any forward-looking statements included in this report or the reasons why actual results could 
differ from those contained in such statements, whether as a result of new information, future events or otherwise. In light of these risks, 
uncertainties and assumptions, the forward-looking statements discussed in this report might not occur, and you should not put undue reliance 
on any forward-looking statements. 
As used throughout this report, the terms “we,” “our,” “us,” or the “Company” refer to Banner Corporation and its consolidated subsidiaries, 
unless the context otherwise requires. All references to “Banner” refer to Banner Corporation and those to the “Bank” refer to its wholly-
owned subsidiary, Banner Bank. 
Table of Contents 
1 

PART 1 
Item 1 – Business 
General 
Banner is a bank holding company incorporated in the State of Washington which wholly owns one subsidiary bank, Banner Bank. The Bank 
is a Washington-chartered commercial bank that conducts business from its main office in Walla Walla, Washington and, as of December 31, 
2024, it had 135 branch offices and 13 loan production offices located in Washington, Oregon, California, Idaho and Utah. Banner is subject 
to regulation by the Federal Reserve. The Bank is subject to regulation by the Washington State Department of Financial Institutions-
Division of Banks (the DFI) and the Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation (the FDIC). As of December 31, 2024, we had total consolidated 
assets of $16.20 billion, net loans of $11.20 billion, total deposits of $13.51 billion and total shareholders’ equity of $1.77 billion. Banner’s 
common stock is traded on the NASDAQ Global Select Market under the ticker symbol “BANR.” 
The Bank is a regional bank that offers a wide variety of commercial banking services and financial products to individuals, businesses and 
public sector entities in its primary market areas. The Bank’s primary business is that of traditional banking institutions, accepting deposits 
and originating loans in locations surrounding our offices in Washington, Oregon, California, Idaho and Utah. The Bank is also an active 
participant in secondary loan markets, engaging in mortgage banking operations through the origination and sale of one- to four-family 
residential loans. Lending activities include commercial business and commercial real estate loans, agriculture business loans, construction, 
land and land development loans, one- to four-family residential loans, multifamily real estate loans, U.S. Small Business Administration 
(SBA) loans and consumer loans. 
We continue to invest in our delivery platform across the franchise with a primary emphasis on strengthening our presence in the higher 
growth regions of our markets. In addition, we continue to improve the efficiency of our branch delivery channel by making investments in 
streamlining the origination of new loan and deposit accounts while simultaneously enhancing our digital service and account origination 
capabilities. During the past few years, client adoption of mobile and digital banking has accelerated while physical branch transaction 
volume has declined. Banner anticipates this shift in client service delivery channel preference will continue and we strive to provide digital 
tools that support our client’s banking needs. 
We also focus on expanding our product offerings and investing heavily in marketing campaigns designed to significantly increase the brand 
awareness for the Bank. These marketing investments are a significant element in our strategy to grow client relationships and increase our 
market presence, while allowing us to better serve existing and future clients. We believe our branch network, broad product line and 
heightened brand awareness have created a franchise that is well positioned for growth and successful execution of our super community bank 
model. Our overall strategy is focused on delivering clients—including middle market and small businesses, business owners, their families 
and employees—a compelling value proposition by providing the financial sophistication and breadth of products of a regional bank while 
retaining the appeal, responsiveness, and superior service level of a community bank. 
The Company’s successful execution of its super community bank model and strategic initiatives has delivered solid core operating results 
and profitability over the last several years. The Company’s longer term strategic initiatives continue to focus on originating high quality 
assets and client acquisition, which we believe will continue to generate strong revenue while maintaining the Company’s moderate risk 
profile.  In addition, our strategic initiatives relate to efficiency, talent retention and technology improvements. 
Our operating results depend primarily on our net interest income, which is the difference between interest income on interest-earning assets, 
consisting primarily of loans and investment securities, and interest expense on interest-bearing liabilities, composed primarily of client 
deposits, Federal Home Loan Bank of Des Moines (FHLB) advances, other borrowings, subordinated notes, and junior subordinated 
debentures. Net interest income is a function of our interest rate spread, which is the difference between the yield earned on interest-earning 
assets and the average rate paid on interest-bearing liabilities, as well as a function of the average balances of interest-earning assets, interest-
bearing liabilities and non-interest-bearing funding sources including non-interest-bearing deposits. 
Our net income is also affected by the level of our non-interest income, including deposit fees and other service charges, results of mortgage 
banking operations—which includes gains and losses on the sale of loans and servicing fees—gains and losses on the sale of securities, as 
well as our non-interest expenses and provisions for credit losses and income taxes.  
Lending Activities 
General: All of our lending activities are conducted through the Bank and its subsidiary, Community Financial Corporation, a residential 
construction lender located in Portland, Oregon. We offer a wide range of loan products to meet the demands of our clients and our loan 
portfolio is very diversified by product type, borrower and geographic location within our market area. We originate loans for our portfolio 
and for sale in the secondary market. Management’s strategy has been to maintain a well-diversified portfolio with a significant percentage of 
assets in the loan portfolio having more frequent interest rate repricing terms or shorter maturities than traditional long-term fixed-rate 
mortgage loans. As part of this effort, we offer a variety of floating or adjustable interest rate products that correlate more closely with our 
cost of interest-bearing funds, particularly loans for commercial business and real estate, agricultural business, and construction and 
development purposes. In response to client demand, we also originate fixed-rate loans, including fixed interest rate mortgage loans with 
terms of up to 30 years. The relative amount of fixed-rate loans and adjustable-rate loans that can be originated at any time is largely 
determined by the demand for each in a competitive environment. 
Table of Contents 
2 

Our lending activities are primarily directed toward the origination of commercial real estate and business loans. Commercial real estate 
loans include owner-occupied, investment properties and multifamily real estate. We also originate one- to four-family residential and 
construction, and land and land development loans, of which a significant component are one- to four-family residential construction loans.  
Throughout 2024, sales of completed homes continued to outpace new originations due to constrained housing inventories. Our commercial 
business lending is directed toward meeting the credit and related deposit and treasury management needs of various small- to medium-sized 
business and agribusiness borrowers operating in our primary market areas. To a lesser extent, our commercial business lending has also 
included participation in certain national syndicated loans. Typically, most of the one- to four-family residential loans that we originate are 
sold in the secondary markets with net gains on sales and loan servicing fees reflected in our revenues from mortgage banking. However, 
demand for these loans slowed in 2023 and 2024 due to high interest rates, which reduced refinance activity. Additionally, the higher rate 
environment has impacted the refinancing of custom construction loans into the secondary market upon project completion, leading to a 
significant increase in the retention of one- to four-family residential loan production held in the portfolio. Our consumer lending is primarily 
directed at meeting demand from our existing deposit clients. At December 31, 2024 our net loan portfolio totaled $11.35 billion compared to 
$10.81 billion at December 31, 2023. 
One- to Four-Family Residential Real Estate Lending: We originate loans secured by first mortgages on one- to four-family residences in the 
markets we serve. Through our mortgage banking activities, we sell one- to four-family residential loans on either a servicing-retained or 
servicing-released basis. We have generally sold a significant portion of our conventional one- to four-family residential loan originations 
and nearly all of our government insured loans in the secondary market. As of December 31, 2024 14% of the loan portfolio, $1.59 billion, 
consisted of permanent one- to four-family residences. 
We offer fixed- and adjustable-rate mortgages (ARMs) at rates and terms competitive with market conditions, primarily with the intent of 
selling these loans into the secondary market. Fixed-rate loans generally are offered on a fully amortizing basis for terms ranging from 10 to 
30 years at interest rates and fees that reflect current secondary market pricing. Most ARM products offered by us adjust annually after an 
initial period ranging from one to five years, subject to a limitation on the annual adjustment and a lifetime rate cap. For a small portion of 
the portfolio, where the initial period exceeds one year, the first interest rate change may exceed the annual limitation on subsequent 
adjustments. Our ARM products most frequently adjust based upon the average yield on Treasury securities adjusted to a constant maturity 
of one year or other indices plus a margin or spread above the index. ARM loans held in our portfolio may allow for interest-only payments 
for an initial period, up to five years, but do not provide for negative amortization of principal and carry no prepayment restrictions. The 
retention of ARM loans in our loan portfolio can help reduce our exposure to changes in interest rates. 
Our residential loans are generally underwritten and documented in accordance with the guidelines established by the Federal Home Loan 
Mortgage Corporation (Freddie Mac or FHLMC) and the Federal National Mortgage Association (Fannie Mae or FNMA). Government 
insured loans are underwritten and documented in accordance with the guidelines established by the Department of Housing and Urban 
Development and the Department of Veterans Affairs. In the loan approval process, we assess the borrower’s ability to repay the loan, the 
adequacy of the proposed security, the employment stability of the borrower and the creditworthiness of the borrower. For ARM loans, our 
standard practice provides for underwriting based upon fully indexed interest rates and payments. Generally, we will lend up to 95% of the 
lesser of the appraised value or purchase price of the property on conventional loans, although higher loan-to-value ratios are available on 
secondary market programs. We require private mortgage insurance on conventional residential loans with a loan-to-value ratio at origination 
exceeding 80%. 
Construction, Land and Land Development Lending: Historically, we have invested a significant portion of our loan portfolio in residential 
construction and land loans to professional home builders and developers. Our land loans are typically on improved or entitled land, versus 
raw land. On a more limited basis, we also make land and land development loans to developers, builders and individuals to finance the 
acquisition and/or development of improved lots or unimproved land. In making land loans, we follow more conservative underwriting 
policies than those for construction loans but maintain similar disbursement and monitoring procedures. The initial term on land loans is 
typically one to three years with interest-only payments, payable monthly, with provisions for principal reduction as lots are sold and released. 
We also make construction loans to qualified owner occupants, which upon completion of the construction phase convert to long-term 
amortizing one- to four-family residential loans that are eligible for sale in the secondary market. We regularly monitor our construction and 
land loan portfolios and the economic conditions and housing inventory in each of our markets and increase or decrease this type of lending as 
we observe market conditions change. Our residential construction and land and land development lending has been increasing recently in 
select markets and has made a meaningful contribution to our net interest income and profitability. We also originate construction loans for 
commercial and multifamily real estate. 
Construction and land lending affords us the opportunity to achieve higher interest rates and fees with shorter terms to maturity than are 
generally available on other types of lending. Construction and land lending, however, involves a higher degree of risk than other lending 
opportunities. We attempt to address these risks by adhering to strict underwriting policies, disbursement procedures and monitoring 
practices, and the portfolio remains well diversified with respect to sub-markets, price ranges and borrowers. 
Table of Contents 
3 

Commercial and Multifamily Real Estate Lending: We originate loans secured by multifamily and commercial real estate, including loans for 
construction of multifamily and commercial real estate projects. Commercial real estate loans are made for both owner-occupied and 
investor-owned properties. Multifamily and commercial real estate lending affords us an opportunity to receive interest at rates higher than 
those generally available from one- to four-family residential lending. In originating multifamily and commercial real estate loans, we 
consider the location, marketability and overall attractiveness of the properties. Our underwriting guidelines for multifamily and commercial 
real estate loans require an appraisal from a qualified independent appraiser, as well as an environmental risk assessment and an economic 
analysis of each property with regard to annual revenue and expenses, debt service coverage and fair value to determine the maximum loan 
amount. In the approval process, we assess the borrower’s willingness and ability to manage the property and repay the loan and the 
adequacy of the collateral in relation to the loan amount. Our multifamily real estate portfolio, totaling $894.4 million as of December 31, 
2024, is well diversified and consists mostly of affordable housing projects. Our commercial real estate portfolio, totaling $3.86 billion as of 
December 31, 2024, is granular in nature and geographically diversified. 
Multifamily and commercial real estate loans originated by us are both fixed- and adjustable-rate loans with intermediate terms of generally 
five to 10 years. A significant portion of our multifamily and commercial real estate loans are linked to various FHLB advance rates, certain 
prime rates, US Treasury rates, or other market rate indices. Rates on these adjustable-rate loans generally adjust with a frequency of one to 
five years after an initial fixed-rate period ranging from one to 10 years. Our commercial real estate portfolio consists of loans on a variety of 
property types with no large concentrations by property type, location or borrower. At December 31, 2024, the average size of our 
commercial real estate loans was $1.2 million, with the largest commercial real estate loan, in terms of an outstanding balance, totaling $23.8 
million. 
Commercial Business Lending: We are active in small- to medium-sized business lending. Our commercial bankers are focused on local 
markets and devote a great deal of effort to developing client relationships and providing these types of borrowers with a full array of 
products and services delivered in a thorough and responsive manner. Our experienced commercial bankers and senior credit staff help us 
meet our commitment to small business lending while also focusing on corporate lending opportunities for borrowers with credit needs 
generally in a $3 million to $25 million range. In addition to providing earning assets, commercial business lending has helped us increase 
our deposit base. In recent years, our commercial business lending has included modest participation in certain national syndicated loans, 
including shared national credits. We also originate smaller balance business loans, principally through our retail branch network, using our 
QuickStep business loan program, which is closely aligned with our consumer lending operations and relies on centralized underwriting 
procedures. QuickStep business loans are available up to $1.0 million, business lines of credit are available up to $500,000 and owner-
occupied real estate loans are available up to $2.0 million. 
Commercial business loans may entail greater risk than other types of loans. Conventional commercial business loans generally provide 
higher yields or related revenue opportunities than many other types of loans but also require more administrative and management attention.  
Loan terms, including the fixed or adjustable interest rate, the loan maturity and the collateral considerations, vary significantly and are 
negotiated on an individual loan basis. 
We underwrite our conventional commercial business loans on the basis of the borrower’s cash flow and ability to service the debt from 
earnings rather than on the basis of the underlying collateral value. We seek to structure these loans so that they have more than one source of 
repayment. The borrower is required to provide us with sufficient information to allow us to make a prudent lending determination. In most 
instances, this information consists of at least three years of financial statements and tax returns, a statement of projected cash flows, current 
financial information on any guarantor and information about the collateral. Loans to closely held businesses typically require personal 
guarantees by the principals. Our commercial business loan portfolio is geographically dispersed across the market areas serviced by our 
branch network and there are no significant concentrations by industry or product. 
Our commercial business loans may be structured as term loans or as lines of credit. Commercial business term loans are generally made to 
finance the purchase of fixed assets and have maturities of five years or less. Commercial business lines of credit are typically made for the 
purpose of providing working capital and are usually approved with a term of one year. Adjustable- or floating-rate loans are primarily tied to 
prime and Secured Overnight Financing Rate (SOFR) indices. 
Agricultural Lending: Agriculture is a major industry in several of our markets. We make agricultural loans to borrowers with a strong 
capital base, sufficient management depth, proven ability to operate through agricultural cycles, reliable cash flows and adequate financial 
reporting. Payments on agricultural loans depend, to a large degree, on the results of operations of the related farm entity. The repayment is 
also subject to other economic and weather conditions and market prices for agricultural products, which can be highly volatile. 
Agricultural operating loans generally are made as a percentage of the borrower’s anticipated income to support budgeted operating 
expenses. These loans are secured by a blanket lien on all crops, livestock, equipment, accounts and products and proceeds thereof. In the 
case of crops, consideration is given to projected yields and prices from each commodity. The interest rate is normally floating, based on the 
prime rate or another index, plus a negotiated margin. Because these loans are made to finance a farm’s or ranch’s annual operations, they are 
usually written on a one-year review and renewable basis. The renewal is dependent upon the prior year’s performance and the forthcoming 
year’s projections as well as the overall financial strength of the borrower. We carefully monitor these loans and related variance reports on 
income and expenses compared to budget estimates. To meet the seasonal operating needs of a farm, borrowers may qualify for single 
payment notes, revolving lines of credit and/or non-revolving lines of credit. 
Table of Contents 
4 

In underwriting agricultural operating loans, we consider the cash flow of the borrower based upon the expected operating results and the 
value of collateral used to secure the loans. Collateral generally consists of cash crops produced by the farm, such as milk, grains, fruit, grass 
seed, peas, sugar beets, mint, walnuts, onions, potatoes, corn and alfalfa, or livestock. In addition to considering cash flow and obtaining a 
blanket security interest in the farm’s cash crop, we may also collateralize an operating loan with the farm’s operating equipment, breeding 
stock, real estate and federal agricultural program payments to the borrower. 
We also originate loans to finance the purchase of farm equipment. Loans to purchase farm equipment are made for terms of up to seven 
years. On occasion, we also originate agricultural real estate loans secured primarily by first liens on farmland and improvements thereon 
located in our market areas, although generally only to service the needs of our existing clients. Loans are generally written in amounts 
ranging from 50% to 75% of the tax assessed or appraised value of the property for terms of five to 20 years. These loans typically have 
interest rates that adjust at least every five years based upon a Treasury index or FHLB advance rate plus a negotiated margin. Fixed-rate 
loans are granted on terms usually not to exceed five years. In originating agricultural real estate loans, we consider the debt service coverage 
of the borrower’s cash flow, the appraised value of the underlying property, the experience and knowledge of the borrower, the borrower’s 
past performance with us and the market area. These loans normally are not made to start-up businesses and are reserved for existing clients 
with substantial equity and a proven history. 
Among the more common risks to agricultural lending can be weather conditions and disease. These risks may be mitigated through multi-
peril crop insurance. Commodity prices also present a risk, which may be mitigated using set price contracts. Normally, required beginning 
and projected operating margins provide for reasonable reserves to offset unexpected yield and price deficiencies. In addition to these risks, 
we also consider management succession, life insurance and business continuation plans when evaluating agricultural loans. 
Consumer and Other Lending: We originate a variety of consumer loans, including home equity lines of credit; automobile, boat and 
recreational vehicle loans; and loans secured by deposit accounts. While consumer lending has traditionally been a small part of our business, 
with loans made primarily to accommodate our existing client base, it has received consistent emphasis in recent years. Part of this emphasis 
includes a Banner Bank-owned credit card program. Similar to other consumer loan programs, we focus this credit card program on our 
existing client base to add to the depth of our client relationships. In addition to earning balances, credit card accounts produce non-interest 
revenues through interchange fees and other activity-based revenues. Our underwriting of consumer loans is focused on the borrower’s credit 
history and ability to repay the debt as evidenced by documented sources of income. 
  
Loan Solicitation and Processing: We originate real estate loans in our market areas by direct solicitation of builders, developers, depositors, 
walk-in clients, real estate brokers and visitors to our website. One- to four-family residential loan applications are taken by our mortgage 
loan officers or through our website and are processed in branch or regional locations. In addition, we have specialized loan origination units 
focused on construction and land development, commercial real estate and multifamily real estate loans. Most underwriting and loan 
administration functions for our real estate loans are performed by loan personnel at central locations. 
In addition to commercial real estate loans, our commercial bankers solicit commercial and agricultural business loans through call programs 
focused on local businesses and farmers. 
While commercial bankers are delegated reasonable lending authority based upon their 
qualifications, credit decisions on significant commercial and agricultural loans are made by senior credit officers based on their lending 
authority or, if required, by the Credit Risk Committee of the Board of Directors of the Bank. 
We originate consumer loans and small business (including QuickStep) commercial business loans through various marketing efforts directed 
primarily toward our existing deposit and loan clients. Consumer and small business commercial business loan applications are primarily 
underwritten and documented by centralized administrative personnel. 
Loan Originations, Sales and Purchases 
While we originate a variety of loans, our ability to originate each type of loan is dependent upon the relative client demand and competition 
in each market we serve. For the years ended December 31, 2024 and 2023, we originated loans, net of repayments, including our 
participation in syndicated loans and loans held for sale of $984.7 million and $886.8 million, respectively. 
We sell many of our newly originated one- to four-family residential loans to secondary market purchasers as part of our interest rate risk 
management strategy. We previously originated multifamily real estate loans for sale in the secondary market, but discontinued this line of 
business during the fourth quarter of 2023. Sales of loans generally are beneficial to us because these sales may generate income at the time 
of sale, provide funds for additional lending and other investments, increase liquidity or reduce interest rate risk. We sell one- to four-family 
residential loans on both a servicing-retained and a servicing-released basis. All loans are sold without recourse but subject to the standard 
representations and warranties contained in the loan sale agreement. The decision to hold or sell loans is based on asset liability management 
goals, strategies and policies and on market conditions.  In addition, we generally sell the guaranteed portion of SBA loans. 
We periodically purchase whole loans, loan participation interests, and participate in syndications, including shared national credits. These 
purchases are made during periods of reduced loan demand in our primary market area and to support our Community Reinvestment Act 
lending activities. Any such purchases or loan participations are generally made on terms consistent with our underwriting standards; 
however, the loans may be located outside of our normal lending area. 
Table of Contents 
5 

Loan Servicing 
We receive fees from a variety of institutional owners in return for performing the traditional services of collecting individual payments and 
managing portfolios of sold loans. At December 31, 2024, we were servicing $3.18 billion of loans for others. Loan servicing includes 
processing payments, accounting for loan funds and collecting and paying real estate taxes, hazard insurance and other loan-related items such 
as private mortgage insurance. In addition to earning fee income, we retain certain amounts in escrow for the benefit of the lender for which 
we incur no interest expense but are able to invest the funds into earning assets. 
  
Mortgage and SBA Servicing Rights: We record mortgage servicing rights (MSRs) with respect to loans we originate and sell in the 
secondary market on a servicing-retained basis and SBA servicing rights with respect to the guaranteed portion of SBA loans we sell. The 
value of MSRs is capitalized and amortized in proportion to, and over the period of, the estimated future net servicing income. Management 
periodically evaluates the estimates and assumptions used to determine the carrying values of MSRs and the amortization of MSRs. MSRs 
generally are adversely affected by higher levels of current or anticipated prepayments resulting from decreasing interest rates. MSRs are 
evaluated for impairment based upon the fair value of the rights as compared to amortized cost. Impairment is recognized through a valuation 
allowance, to the extent that fair value is less than the capitalized carrying amount. SBA servicing rights are initially recorded and carried at 
fair value.  Any change in the fair value of SBA servicing rights is recorded in non-interest income. 
Asset Quality 
Classified Assets: State and federal regulations require that the Bank review and classify its problem assets on a regular basis. In addition, in 
connection with examinations of insured institutions, state and federal examiners have authority to identify problem assets and, if appropriate, 
require them to be classified. Historically, we have not had any meaningful differences of opinion with the examiners with respect to asset 
classification. The Bank’s Credit Policy Division reviews detailed information with respect to the composition and performance of the loan 
portfolios, including information on risk concentrations, delinquencies and classified assets for the Bank. The Credit Policy Division 
approves all recommendations for new classified loans or, in the case of smaller-balance homogeneous loans including residential real estate 
and consumer loans, it has approved policies governing such classifications, or changes in classifications, and develops and monitors action 
plans to resolve the problems associated with the assets. The Credit Policy Division also approves recommendations for establishing the 
appropriate level of the allowance for credit losses. Significant problem loans are transferred to the Bank’s Special Assets Department for 
resolution or collection activities.  We review asset quality at least quarterly. 
Allowance for Credit Losses: In originating loans, we recognize that losses will be experienced and that the risk of loss will vary with, among 
other things, the type of loan being made, the creditworthiness of the borrower over the term of the loan, general economic conditions and, in 
the case of a secured loan, the quality of the security for the loan. The allowance for credit losses is maintained at a level sufficient to provide 
for expected credit losses over the life of the loan based on evaluating specific risk characteristics in the current loan portfolio and forecasted 
economic conditions, as well as historical credit loss experience. We increase our allowance for credit losses by charging a provision for 
credit losses against income. 
Real Estate Owned: Real estate owned (REO) is property acquired by foreclosure or receiving a deed in-lieu-of foreclosure and is recorded at 
the estimated fair value of the property, less expected selling costs. Development and improvement costs relating to the property are 
capitalized to the extent they add value to the property. The carrying value of the property is periodically evaluated by Management and, if 
necessary, allowances are established to reduce the carrying value to net realizable value. Gains or losses at the time the property is sold are 
credited or charged to operations in the period in which they are realized. The amounts we will ultimately recover from REO may differ 
substantially from the carrying value of the assets because of market factors beyond our control or because of changes in our strategies for 
recovering the investment. 
  
Investment Activities 
Investment Securities: Under Washington state law and FDIC regulation, banks are permitted to invest in various types of marketable 
securities. Authorized securities include but are not limited to Treasury obligations, securities of various federal agencies (including 
government-sponsored enterprises), mortgage-backed and asset-backed securities, certain certificates of deposit of insured banks and savings 
institutions, bankers’ acceptances, repurchase agreements, federal funds, commercial paper, corporate debt and equity securities and 
obligations of states and their political subdivisions. Our investment policies are designed to provide and maintain adequate liquidity and to 
generate favorable rates of return without incurring undue interest rate risk or credit risk. Our policies generally limit investments to U.S.  
Government and agency (including government-sponsored entities) securities, municipal bonds, certificates of deposit, corporate debt 
obligations and mortgage-backed securities. Investment in mortgage-backed securities may include those issued or guaranteed by Freddie 
Mac, Fannie Mae, Government National Mortgage Association (Ginnie Mae or GNMA) and investment grade privately issued mortgage-
backed securities, and collateralized mortgage obligations (CMOs). All of our investment securities, including those with a credit rating, are 
subject to market risk in so far as a change in market rates of interest or other conditions may cause a change in an investment’s earnings 
performance and/or market value. 
Table of Contents 
6 

Derivatives: We are party to various derivative instruments that are used for asset and liability management and client financing needs.  
Derivative instruments are contracts between two or more parties that have a notional amount and an underlying variable, require no net 
investment and allow for the net settlement of positions. The notional amount serves as the basis for the payment provision of the contract 
and takes the form of units, such as shares or dollars. The underlying variable represents a specified interest rate, index, or other component.  
The interaction between the notional amount and the underlying variable determines the number of units to be exchanged between the parties 
and influences the market value of the derivative contract. 
Our predominant derivative and hedging activities involve interest rate swaps related to certain term loans, interest rate lock commitments to 
borrowers, and forward sales contracts associated with mortgage banking activities. Generally, these instruments help us manage exposure to 
market risk and meet client financing needs. Market risk represents the possibility that economic value or net interest income will be 
adversely affected by fluctuations in external factors such as market-driven interest rates and prices or other economic factors. 
 Deposit Activities and Other Sources of Funds 
General: Deposits, FHLB advances (or other borrowings) and loan repayments are our major sources of funds for lending and other 
investment purposes. Scheduled loan repayments are a relatively stable source of funds, while deposit inflows and outflows and loan 
prepayments are influenced by general economic, interest rate and money market conditions and may vary significantly. Borrowings may be 
used on a short-term basis to compensate for reductions in the availability of funds from other sources. Borrowings may also be used on a 
longer-term basis to fund loans and investments, and to manage interest rate risk. 
  
We face competition from various financial institutions and intermediaries for deposits. Competition is particularly intense for transaction 
balances and savings deposits, with commercial banks, credit unions, and non-bank entities such as securities brokerage firms, mutual funds, 
and large corporations with nationwide office networks, actively competing for market share. Our efforts, including acquisitions, branch 
relocations, renovations, and marketing campaigns, are primarily focused on expanding deposit client relationships and 
balances. Additionally, our electronic and digital banking services, such as debit card and ATM programs, internet banking, remote deposit, 
and mobile banking, are designed to enhance client engagement, drive deposit growth, and generate fee income. Core deposits, consisting of 
non-interest-bearing checking accounts and interest-bearing transaction and savings accounts, constitute a fundamental element of our 
business strategy.  As of December 31, 2024 and 2023, core deposits represented 89% of total deposits. 
Deposit Accounts: We generally attract deposits from within our primary market areas by offering a broad selection of deposit instruments, 
including non-interest-bearing checking accounts, interest-bearing checking accounts, money market deposit accounts, regular savings 
accounts, certificates of deposit, treasury management services and retirement savings plans. Deposit account terms vary according to the 
minimum balance required, the time periods the funds must remain on deposit and the interest rate, among other factors. In determining the 
terms of deposit accounts, we consider current market interest rates, profitability to us, matching deposit and loan products and client 
preferences and concerns. 
  
Borrowings: While deposits are the primary source of funds for our lending and investment activities and for general business purposes, we 
also use borrowings to supplement our supply of lendable funds, to meet deposit withdrawal requirements and to more efficiently leverage our 
capital position. The FHLB serves as our primary borrowing source. The FHLB provides credit for member financial institutions such as the 
Bank. As a member, the Bank is required to own capital stock in the FHLB and is authorized to apply for advances on the security of that 
stock and certain of its mortgage loans and securities, provided that certain credit worthiness standards have been met. Limitations on the 
amount of advances are based on the financial condition of the member institution, the adequacy of collateral pledged to secure the credit, and 
FHLB stock ownership requirements. The Federal Reserve Bank serves as an additional source of borrowing capacity. The Federal Reserve 
Bank provides credit based upon acceptable loan collateral, which includes certain loan types not eligible for pledging to the FHLB. 
  
In addition, the Bank has federal funds line of credit agreements with other financial institutions. Availability of lines is subject to federal 
funds balances available for loan and continued borrower eligibility. These lines are intended to support short-term liquidity needs and the 
agreements may restrict consecutive day usage. 
We issue retail repurchase agreements, generally due within 90 days, as an additional source of funds, primarily in connection with treasury 
management services provided to our larger deposit clients. We also may borrow funds using secured wholesale repurchase agreements with 
securities brokers. 
Between 2002 and 2007, we issued junior subordinated debentures in conjunction with the sale of trust preferred securities (TPS). These 
securities were sold through special purpose business trusts established by Banner and were privately offered to pooled investment vehicles.  
The proceeds from the junior subordinated debentures issuances were predominantly invested as additional paid-in capital at the Bank. In 
addition, through acquisitions, Banner acquired additional junior subordinated debentures. During 2020, we issued and sold 5.0% fixed-to-
floating subordinated notes, which are callable in 2025 and mature in 2030. The subordinated notes become floating-rate notes based on 
SOFR in June 2025. 
Table of Contents 
7 

Personnel 
Human Capital 
At Banner, our employees are a critical component of our success. Because our business success depends on our ability to retain, develop and 
attract top talent, we seek to provide a work environment that offers professional development opportunities, career growth, competitive 
compensation and comprehensive benefits. Employing the best talent we can—including individuals who possess a broad range of 
experiences, backgrounds and skills—better positions us to anticipate and meet the needs of our business and our clients. 
As our business grows and evolves, the demand for qualified candidates continues to grow. Meanwhile, the pool of experienced candidates in 
the financial services industry is shrinking, presenting a growing challenge in securing top talent. To address this challenge, we have 
developed and continue to enhance a robust and comprehensive company-wide talent management program. This program encompasses 
talent acquisition and selection, performance coaching, career development, retention of top talent and succession planning. Our Board of 
Directors, through its Compensation and Human Capital Committee, provides oversight for our human capital strategies and compensation 
programs. 
Talent Acquisition and Attrition. To cultivate and recruit hard-to-fill positions, we partner closely with several colleges and universities 
with well-known programs relevant to our business. In 2024, we continued our Flexible Workplace Program that was formally launched in 
2022, which provides hybrid and remote career opportunities. The program aims to support hiring from an expanded group of candidates, 
improve the work experience for our employees, strengthen our leadership pipeline and promote employee retention. Our voluntary 
employee turnover rate in 2024 decreased to 13%, compared to 15% in 2023. 
  
Our employment application and hiring processes do not solicit prior compensation information from candidates. This approach helps ensure 
our new hire compensation is based on individual qualifications and roles, rather than being influenced by a candidate’s previous 
compensation history. We also accept relevant experience as an alternative to formal education requirements for many roles, to support 
expanded candidate pools. In 2023, Banner initiated a partnership with BankWork$, an organization dedicated to assisting young adults from 
under-resourced communities in building meaningful careers in banking. This partnership continued in 2024 with an expansion of the 
program to additional geographic areas. This collaboration includes a free, eight-week career training program, placement assistance, and 
ongoing coaching. 
In 2024, we hired 356 new employees into our workforce. As of December 31, 2024, approximately 39% of our workforce was working 
hybrid or remotely. Our willingness to accommodate flexible work arrangements underscores our commitment to fostering an inclusive 
workplace. 
Talent Development.  We invest significant resources developing the talent needed to meet our business goals and to make us an employer of 
choice. We offer our employees a variety of professional development opportunities, including participation in industry conferences, 
instructor-led continuing education and training sessions. We also make available online training sessions that focus on industry, regulatory, 
business and leadership topics to help employees achieve their career goals, build management skills and lead their teams.  
To foster a culture of growth and professional development, we launched a new leadership development program in 2024. 
This 
comprehensive program represents a significant investment in our leaders and aims to align our leadership skills with the Bank’s strategic 
goals. It’s also part of our dedication to building a strong talent pipeline that develops talent, drives vision and purpose, cultivates innovation 
and a strategic mindset, and encourages continuous learning through experimentation. Centered around eight core competencies, the program 
is designed to equip leaders with the skills needed to navigate the evolving financial landscape and support the Bank’s long-term objectives. 
To encourage advancement and growth within our organization, we provide information and guides to help individuals design their own 
career paths.  With this strong focus on internal talent development, we filled 30% of all open positions in 2024 with internal candidates. 
As part of our commitment to continuous learning, we require all employees to complete a variety of online training courses annually. These 
include both job-specific and general courses covering regulatory compliance, cybersecurity, fraud prevention, workplace standards, and 
ethics. We also encourage employees to enroll in outside education programs to broaden their knowledge and enhance job performance and 
facilitate career growth by providing tuition assistance to help employees obtain bachelor’s and master’s degrees. This comprehensive 
approach underscores our dedication to nurturing a skilled and empowered workforce. 
Succession Planning. Recognizing the critical significance of succession planning for our CEO and other key executives, our Board of 
Directors takes an active role in overseeing and monitoring these efforts. Annually, the Board conducts a thorough review of our succession 
plans for senior leadership roles. The primary objective is to ensure that we consistently have the appropriate leadership talent in place, 
aligning with the organization’s long-term strategic plans. To facilitate this oversight, the Board’s Compensation and Human Capital 
Committee provides dedicated governance of talent development and succession planning for senior leadership roles. 
  
Table of Contents 
8 

  
Employee Engagement. We use anonymous employee surveys to gather valuable feedback on key initiatives, leveraging the results to 
enhance existing programs and develop new ones. In our commitment to fostering employee engagement and transparency, we share the 
survey results with our workforce. Additionally, senior leadership analyzes areas of progress or opportunities for improvement, prioritizing 
responsive actions and activities. In 2024, we conducted a company-wide engagement survey, achieving an overall engagement score of 
86%, with 77% of employees participating. The survey results indicated that our employees demonstrate ethical conduct in business dealings, 
are knowledgeable about our clients’ needs, and understand their own contributions to the Bank’s goals. Beyond a formal engagement 
survey, we provide regular opportunities for managers and employees to ask questions, raise concerns and provide suggestions for ways to 
build a better and stronger company. Throughout 2024, this initiative included quarterly virtual meetings with employees to communicate 
results and progress on strategic initiatives. Additionally, in-person employee townhalls provided opportunities for employees to directly 
engage with Company leaders. This multifaceted approach supports open communication channels and strengthens our commitment to 
continuous improvement and employee satisfaction. 
Total Rewards (Compensation and Benefits). We provide robust compensation and benefits programs to help meet the needs of our 
employees. These programs include, subject to eligibility policies, variable pay tied to performance for all employees, a 401(k) plan 
(including an employer match up to 4% of eligible earnings and immediate vesting), healthcare and insurance benefits, health savings and 
flexible spending accounts, paid time off, family care resources, flexible work schedules, employee assistance programs and tuition 
assistance. New employees are eligible for group benefits on the first day of the month following their hire date. For some employees, this 
means they become eligible for coverage in their first week of employment. We also grant long-term, stock-based incentive awards to a 
select group of senior leaders who we believe will play critical roles in the Company’s future. We believe our compensation program is 
competitive within the financial industry. We periodically review our plans and programs, as well as market surveys, to help ensure our 
compensation program is consistent with our level of performance and that we have a current understanding of peer practices. 
  
We offer comprehensive health insurance coverage, including telehealth services, to employees working an average of at least 20 hours per 
week. Coverage is also available to eligible family members including domestic partners. Beyond traditional health insurance, we offer a 
range of mental health-related programs and benefits, including text-based and telehealth services, a 24-hour nurse line and an employee 
assistance program. Additionally, we offer virtual physical therapy benefits and virtual support for hypertension and diabetes, as well as 
subsidized child, adult and senior care planning services. To further support employees and their caregivers dealing with cancer, we offer 
cancer support services. This service provides dedicated cancer care coaches 24/7 to provide personalized guidance to navigate the 
complexities of cancer care. 
In addition to our core benefits program, we recognize the importance of supporting employees during significant life events. Therefore, we 
offer parental leave, providing eight weeks of leave for both birth and non-birth parents, including adoption or surrogacy. Our benefits 
package also includes traditional sick leave up to 10 days per year and 12 weeks of short-term disability coverage. Furthermore, employees 
have the flexibility to take up to 16 paid personal hours each year to observe individual days of significance, such as religious holidays, 
culturally significant days, or other personal reasons. This comprehensive benefits package reflects our commitment to the well-being and 
work-life balance of our valued employees. 
Pay Equity. Pay equity and pay transparency are fundamental to our compensation philosophy and core values. We began conducting 
thorough pay equity studies in 2017 in collaboration with external experts to methodically assess employee groups in similar roles. These 
studies consider various factors such as job location and experience to promote fair and objective pay comparisons. In 2024, we engaged a 
global workplace equity organization that provides a technology platform to measure, achieve and sustain pay and workplace equity. This 
technology enables us to embed workplace equity into our core business by conducting analyses as frequently as our business model and 
strategic goals necessitate. Through continuous monitoring, we remain committed to identifying and addressing any pay disparities, to 
support pay equity across our organization. 
  
Incentive Compensation Risk Management. We strive to align incentives with the risk and performance frameworks of the Company. The 
Company’s “pay for performance” philosophy connects individual, operating unit and Company results to compensation, providing 
employees with opportunities to share in the Company’s overall growth and success. We develop, execute and govern all incentive 
compensation plans to discourage imprudent or excessive risk-taking and balance financial reward in a manner that supports our clients, 
employees and Company. 
Inclusion, Diversity, Equity, and Advocacy. We seek to hire the best and brightest—including individuals who possess a broad range of 
experiences, backgrounds and skills. We believe that diverse perspectives and inclusive environments result in better outcomes for all our 
stakeholders and empower our employees to make more meaningful contributions within our Company and communities. 
  
We aim to maintain a work environment where every employee is treated with dignity and respect, is free from discrimination and 
harassment, and is allowed to devote their full attention and best efforts to performing their job to the best of their ability. Further, we 
maintain a Respectful Workplace Policy in alignment with this commitment. We strive to operate with an “open door policy” where 
employee concerns can be discussed anytime directly with leadership or human resources team members. We regularly conduct employee 
engagement surveys and exit surveys to help collect meaningful feedback to inform our human capital practices. We have always 
championed the principles of fairness, respect, and opportunity, ensuring that all employees are recognized and rewarded based on their merit, 
talent, contributions, and performance. 
Our cross-functional, employee-led IDEAs Council provides leadership and serves as a catalyst for inclusion initiatives across our 
organization.  The council is intended to help develop effective strategies to attract, develop and retain top talent. 
Table of Contents 
9 

In 2024, we worked with the Department of Defense as a new employer partner in its Military Spouse Employment Partnership (MSEP).  
This partnership connects military spouses with employers committed to recruiting, hiring, promoting and retaining military spouses. As an 
MSEP partner, we have agreed to post job openings to the Partnership’s portal, increase employment opportunities for military spouses, 
provide career advancement opportunities to military spouses who perform well, and when possible, work to retain military spouses when 
they relocate.  We also committed to tracking and reporting military spouse employment data. 
As part of a multi-year employee engagement strategy, we launched our LGBTQ+ Employee Resource Group (ERG) to complement our four 
established groups: Black, Indigenous, People of Color (BIPOC), Veterans, Women in Leadership, and Working Parents and Caregivers.  
Our ERGs give employees the opportunity to discuss issues important to the group and are designed to support our business goals, while 
promoting an inclusive and supportive culture. 
We have a strong team collectively capable of professionally operating the business and fulfilling our vision.  The following tables illustrate 
our workforce composition by level as of December 31, 2024: 
Female 
Male 
Workforce Composition: 
Individual Contributor 
68 % 
32 % 
Manager 
65 % 
35 % 
Director* 
43 % 
57 % 
Executive 
40 % 
60 % 
Total workforce 
67 % 
33 % 
* Refers to director-level employees, not Board of Directors 
Non-White 
White 
Workforce Composition: 
Individual Contributor 
32 % 
68 % 
Manager 
26 % 
74 % 
Director* 
19 % 
81 % 
Executive 
7 % 
93 % 
Total workforce 
30 % 
70 % 
* Refers to director-level employees, not Board of Directors 
Health, Safety and Well-being.  The success of our business is fundamentally connected to the well-being of our employees. We provide 
employees and their families with access to a variety of programs to support their physical and mental health. We offer a wellness coach 
benefit (which can also be shared with up to five friends and family) that provides unlimited free one-on-one personal coaching in several 
different categories such as fitness, nutrition, life coaching, and financial coaching, as well as a range of tools to improve sleep quality. 
Volunteerism. We strive to be a good corporate citizen by encouraging employees to engage in the communities where they live and work.  
To encourage volunteering, we offer Community Connections, a program that offers employees up to 16 hours of paid time off to volunteer at 
non-profit organizations of their choice. We also encourage employees to serve in leadership roles in these organizations as part of their 
professional development. We are proud to support many local community organizations through financial contributions and employee-
driven volunteerism, including Junior Achievement, United Way and hundreds of others. 
Human Capital Metrics.  We capture critical metrics regarding human capital management on a quarterly basis and report them to the 
Compensation and Human Capital Committee of the Board of Directors. The Human Capital Management Dashboard includes a mixture of 
trending and point-in-time metrics designed to provide information and analysis of workforce demographics; talent acquisition; workforce 
stability (retention, turnover, etc.); employee engagement; learning and development; and total rewards. As of December 31, 2024, we 
employed 1,925 full- and part-time employees and 10 temporary employees across our four-state footprint. Our employees are not 
represented by a collective bargaining agreement.  As of December 31, 2024, 57% of our employees work in Washington State.  We also have 
employees working in Oregon (19%), California (16%) and other states (8%). As of December 31, 2024, four generations were represented 
in our workplace with Millennials having the greatest representation (38%), followed by Gen-X (37%), Boomer (14%) and Gen-Z (11%). 
Table of Contents 
10 

Taxation 
Tax-Sharing Agreement 
The Company files its federal and state income tax returns on a consolidated basis under a tax-sharing agreement between Banner and the 
Bank, including the Bank’s subsidiaries. Each company of the consolidated group has calculated a minimum income tax which would be 
required if the individual subsidiary were to file federal and state income tax returns as a separate entity. Each subsidiary pays to Banner an 
amount equal to the estimated income tax due if it were to file as a separate entity. The payment is made on or about the time the subsidiary 
would be required to make such tax payments to the United States Treasury or the applicable State or Local Departments of Revenue. In the 
event the computation of the subsidiary’s federal or state income tax liability, after considering any estimated tax payments made, would 
result in a refund if the subsidiary were filing income tax returns as a separate entity, then Banner pays to the subsidiary an amount equal to 
the hypothetical refund. Banner is an agent for each subsidiary with respect to all matters related to the consolidated tax returns and refund 
claims. If Banner’s consolidated federal or state income tax liability is adjusted for any period, the liability of each party under the tax-
sharing agreement is recomputed to give effect to such adjustments, and any additional payments required as a result of the adjustments are 
made within a reasonable time after the corresponding additional tax payments are made or refunds are received. 
Federal Taxation 
For tax reporting purposes, we report our income on a calendar year basis using the accrual method of accounting on a consolidated 
basis. We are subject to federal income taxation in the same manner as other corporations with some exceptions, including particularly the 
reserve for bad debts. 
State and Local Taxation 
Washington Taxation: We are subject to a Business and Occupation (B&O) tax which is imposed by the State of Washington on gross 
receipts. Interest received on loans secured by mortgages or deeds of trust on residential properties, residential mortgage-backed securities, 
and certain U.S. Government and agency securities is not subject to this tax. 
  
California, Oregon, Idaho, Montana and Utah Taxation: Corporations with nexus in the states of California, Oregon, Idaho, Montana and 
Utah are subject to a corporate level income tax. In addition, the state of Oregon has a tax on Oregon corporate revenue. If a large percentage 
of our income were to come from these states, our state income tax provision would have an increased effect on our effective tax rate and 
results of operations. 
Local Taxation: In addition to taxes payable to the state of Oregon, we are subject to local taxes in the Multnomah County and Portland-metro 
area based on our revenues in these jurisdictions. 
Competition 
We encounter significant competition both in attracting deposits and in originating loans. Our most direct competition for deposits comes 
from other commercial and savings banks, savings associations and credit unions with offices in our market areas. We also experience 
competition from securities firms, insurance companies, money market and mutual funds, and other investment vehicles. We expect 
continued strong competition from such financial institutions and investment vehicles in the foreseeable future, including competition from 
online banking competitors and “FinTech” companies that rely on technology to provide financial services. Our ability to attract and retain 
deposits depends on our ability to provide transaction services and investment opportunities that satisfy the requirements of depositors. We 
compete for deposits by offering a variety of accounts and financial services, including electronic banking capabilities, with competitive rates 
and terms, at convenient locations and business hours, and delivered with a high level of personal service and expertise. 
Competition for loans comes principally from other commercial banks, loan brokers, mortgage banking companies, savings banks and credit 
unions and for agricultural loans from the Farm Credit Administration. The competition for loans is intense as a result of the large number of 
institutions competing in our market areas. We compete for loans primarily by offering competitive rates and fees and providing timely 
decisions and excellent service to borrowers. 
Regulation 
General: As a state-chartered, federally insured commercial bank, the Bank is subject to extensive regulation and must comply with various 
statutory and regulatory requirements, including prescribed minimum capital standards. The Bank is regularly examined by the FDIC and the 
Washington DFI and files periodic reports about its activities and financial condition with these banking regulators. The Bank’s relationship 
with depositors and borrowers is also regulated to a great extent by both federal and state law, especially in such matters as the ownership of 
deposit accounts and the form and content of mortgage and other loan documents. 
Table of Contents 
11 

Federal and state banking laws and regulations govern all areas of the operation of the Bank, including reserves, loans, investments, deposits, 
capital, issuance of securities, payment of dividends and establishment of branches. Federal and state bank regulatory agencies also have the 
general authority to limit the dividends paid by insured banks and bank holding companies if such payments should be deemed to constitute 
an unsafe and unsound practice and in other circumstances. The Federal Reserve and FDIC, as the respective primary federal regulators of 
Banner and of the Bank, have authority to impose penalties, initiate civil and administrative actions and take other steps intended to prevent 
banks from engaging in unsafe or unsound practices. The Consumer Financial Protection Bureau (CFPB) is an independent bureau within the 
Federal Reserve System. The CFPB is responsible for the implementation of the federal financial consumer protection and fair lending laws 
and regulations and has authority to impose new requirements. 
Any change in applicable laws, regulations, or regulatory policies may have a material effect on our business, operations, and prospects. We 
cannot predict the nature or the extent of the effects on our business and earnings that any fiscal or monetary policies or new federal or state 
legislation may have in the future. 
The following is a summary discussion of certain laws and regulations applicable to Banner and the Bank, which is qualified in its entirety by 
reference to the actual laws and regulations. 
Banner Bank 
State Regulation and Supervision: As a Washington state-chartered commercial bank with branches in Washington, Oregon, Idaho and 
California, the Bank is subject not only to the applicable provisions of Washington law and regulations, but is also subject to Oregon, Idaho 
and California laws and regulations. These state laws and regulations govern the Bank’s ability to take deposits and pay interest thereon, to 
make loans on or invest in residential and other real estate, to make consumer loans, to invest in securities, to offer various banking services to 
its clients and to establish branch offices. 
Deposit Insurance: The Deposit Insurance Fund of the FDIC insures deposit accounts of the Bank up to $250,000 per separately insured 
deposit relationship category. As insurer, the FDIC imposes deposit insurance premiums and is authorized to conduct examinations of, and to 
require reporting by, FDIC-insured institutions. No institution may pay a dividend if it is in default on its federal deposit insurance 
assessment. As of December 31, 2024, assessment rates ranged from five basis points to 32 basis points for all institutions, subject to 
adjustments for unsecured debt issued by the institution, unsecured debt issued by other FDIC-insured institutions, and brokered deposits held 
by the institution. The FDIC is required to update its analysis and projections for the Deposit Insurance Fund balance and reserve ratio at 
least semiannually and make necessary adjustments to the assessment rate schedules. 
The FDIC may prohibit any insured institution from engaging in any activity determined by regulation or order to pose a serious risk to the 
deposit insurance fund. The FDIC may terminate the deposit insurance of any insured depository institution if it determines after a hearing 
that the institution has engaged or is engaging in unsafe or unsound practices, is in an unsafe or unsound condition to continue operations, or 
has violated any applicable law, regulation, order or any condition imposed by an agreement with the FDIC. It also may suspend deposit 
insurance temporarily during the hearing process for the permanent termination of insurance if the institution has no tangible capital. If 
insurance of accounts is terminated, the accounts at the institution at the time of the termination, less subsequent withdrawals, shall continue 
to be insured for a period of six months to two years, as determined by the FDIC. Management is not aware of any existing circumstances 
which would result in termination of deposit insurance of the Bank. 
Standards for Safety and Soundness: The federal banking regulatory agencies have prescribed, by regulation, guidelines for all insured 
depository institutions relating to internal controls, information systems and internal audit systems; loan documentation; credit underwriting; 
interest rate risk exposure; asset growth; asset quality; earnings; and compensation, fees and benefits. The guidelines set forth the safety and 
soundness standards that the federal banking agencies use to identify and address problems at insured depository institutions. Each insured 
depository institution must implement a comprehensive written information security program that includes administrative, technical, and 
physical safeguards appropriate to the institution’s size and complexity and the nature and scope of its activities. The information security 
program must be designed to ensure the security and confidentiality of client information, protect against any unanticipated threats or hazards 
to the security or integrity of such information, protect against unauthorized access to or use of such information that could result in 
substantial harm or inconvenience to any client, and ensure the proper disposal of client and consumer information. Each insured depository 
institution must also develop and implement a risk-based response program to address incidents of unauthorized access to client information 
in client information systems. If the FDIC determines that an institution fails to meet any of these guidelines, it may require an institution to 
submit to the FDIC an acceptable plan to achieve compliance. 
  
In October 2023, considering recent and historical bank failures, the FDIC proposed guidelines aimed at establishing corporate governance 
and risk management expectations for all insured state-chartered banks, excluding those who are members of the Federal Reserve, with total 
assets exceeding $10 billion. This initiative, conducted through rulemaking under Section 39 of the Federal Deposit Insurance Act, empowers 
the FDIC to set forth enforceable standards, incorporated as an appendix to Part 364 of its regulations. The guidelines focus on defining 
obligations of the board of directors, specifying board composition and committee structures, and outlining expectations for an independent 
risk management function. The FDIC aims to enhance a bank’s safety and soundness, minimizing the likelihood of failure and mitigating 
potential losses. The FDIC has not yet finalized the proposed guidelines and continues to evaluate the proposed guidelines in light of the 
comments received during the public comment period. 
Capital Requirements: Bank holding companies, such as Banner, and federally insured financial institutions, such as the Bank, are required 
to maintain a minimum level of regulatory capital. 
Table of Contents 
12 

Banner and the Bank are subject to minimum required ratios for Common Equity Tier 1 (CET1) capital, Tier 1 capital, total capital and the 
leverage ratio and a required capital conservation buffer over the required capital ratios. 
Under the capital regulations, the minimum capital ratios are: (1) a CET1 capital ratio of 4.5% of risk-weighted assets; (2) a Tier 1 capital 
ratio of 6.0% of risk-weighted assets; (3) a total risk-based capital ratio of 8.0% of risk-weighted assets; and (4) a leverage ratio (the ratio of 
Tier 1 capital to average total consolidated assets) of 4.0%. CET1 generally consists of common stock; retained earnings; accumulated other 
comprehensive income (AOCI) unless an institution elects to exclude AOCI from regulatory capital; and certain minority interests; all subject 
to applicable regulatory adjustments and deductions. Tier 1 capital generally consists of CET1 and noncumulative perpetual preferred stock.  
Tier 2 capital generally consists of other preferred stock and subordinated debt meeting certain conditions plus an amount of the allowance for 
credit losses up to 1.25% of assets.  Total capital is the sum of Tier 1 and Tier 2 capital. 
Trust preferred securities issued by a bank holding company, such as the Company, with total consolidated assets of less than $15 billion 
before May 19, 2010, and treated as regulatory capital are grandfathered, but any such securities issued later are not eligible to be treated as 
regulatory capital. For institutions that grow above $15 billion as a result of an acquisition, the trust preferred securities are excluded from 
Tier 1 capital and instead included in Tier 2 capital. Mortgage servicing assets and deferred tax assets over designated percentages of CET1 
are deducted from capital. In addition, Tier 1 capital includes AOCI, which includes all unrealized gains and losses on available-for-sale debt 
and equity securities. However, because of our asset size, we were eligible to elect, and did elect, to permanently opt out of the inclusion of 
unrealized gains and losses on available-for-sale debt and equity securities in our capital calculations. 
For purposes of determining risk-based capital, assets and certain off-balance sheet items are risk-weighted from 0% to 1250%, depending on 
the risk characteristics of the asset or item.  
In addition to the minimum CET1, Tier 1, leverage ratio and total capital ratios, Banner and the Bank must maintain a capital conservation 
buffer consisting of additional CET1 capital greater than 2.5% of risk-weighted assets above the required minimum risk-based capital levels 
in order to avoid limitations on paying dividends, repurchasing shares, and paying discretionary bonuses. 
To be considered “well capitalized,” a bank holding company must have, on a consolidated basis, a total risk-based capital ratio of 10.0% or 
greater and a Tier 1 risk-based capital ratio of 6.0% or greater and must not be subject to an individual order, directive or agreement under 
which the FRB requires it to maintain a specific capital level. To be considered “well capitalized,” a depository institution must have a Tier 1 
risk-based capital ratio of at least 8.0%, a total risk-based capital ratio of at least 10.0%, a CET1 capital ratio of at least 6.5% and a leverage 
ratio of at least 5.0% and not be subject to an individualized order, directive or agreement under which its primary federal banking regulator 
requires it to maintain a specific capital level. 
Upon adoption of CECL, a banking organization must record a one-time adjustment to its credit loss allowances as of the beginning of the 
fiscal year of adoption equal to the difference, if any, between the amount of credit loss allowances under the prior methodology and the 
amount required under CECL. Concurrent with enactment of the CARES Act, federal banking agencies issued an interim final rule that 
delayed the estimated impact on regulatory capital resulting from the adoption of CECL. The interim final rule provided banking 
organizations that implemented CECL before the end of 2020 the option to delay for two years the estimated impact of CECL on regulatory 
capital relative to regulatory capital determined under the prior incurred loss methodology, followed by a three-year transition period to phase 
out the aggregate amount of capital benefit provided during the initial two-year delay. The changes in the final rule applied only to those 
banking organizations that elected the CECL transition relief provided under the rule. Banner and the Bank elected this option, and 2024 was 
the last year of our three- year transition period. 
Prompt Corrective Action:  Federal statutes establish a supervisory framework for FDIC-insured institutions based on five capital 
categories: well capitalized, adequately capitalized, undercapitalized, significantly undercapitalized and critically undercapitalized. An 
institution’s category depends upon where its capital levels are in relation to relevant capital measures. The well-capitalized category is 
described above. An institution that is not well capitalized is subject to certain restrictions on brokered deposits, including restrictions on the 
rates it can offer on its deposits generally. To be considered adequately capitalized, an institution must have the minimum capital ratios 
described above.  Any institution which is neither well capitalized nor adequately capitalized is considered undercapitalized. 
Undercapitalized institutions are subject to certain prompt corrective action requirements, regulatory controls and restrictions which become 
more extensive as an institution becomes more severely undercapitalized. Failure by the Bank to comply with applicable capital requirements 
would, if unremedied, result in progressively more severe restrictions on its activities and lead to enforcement actions, including, but not 
limited to, the issuance of a capital directive to ensure the maintenance of required capital levels and, ultimately, the appointment of the FDIC 
as receiver or conservator. Banking regulators will take prompt corrective action with respect to depository institutions that do not meet 
minimum capital requirements. Additionally, approval of any regulatory application filed for their review may be dependent on compliance 
with capital requirements. As of December 31, 2024, Banner and the Bank met the requirements to be “well capitalized” and the capital 
conservation buffer requirements. 
Table of Contents 
13 

Commercial Real Estate Lending Concentrations:  The federal banking agencies have issued guidance on sound risk management practices 
for concentrations in commercial real estate lending. The particular focus is on exposure to commercial real estate loans that are dependent 
on the cash flow from the real estate held as collateral and that are likely to be sensitive to conditions in the commercial real estate market (as 
opposed to real estate collateral held as a secondary source of repayment or as an abundance of caution). The purpose of the guidance is not 
to limit a bank’s commercial real estate lending but to guide banks in developing risk management practices and capital levels commensurate 
with the level and nature of real estate concentrations. The guidance directs the FDIC and other bank regulatory agencies to focus their 
supervisory resources on institutions that may have significant commercial real estate loan concentration risk. A bank that has experienced 
rapid growth in commercial real estate lending, has notable exposure to a specific type of commercial real estate loan, or is approaching or 
exceeding the following supervisory criteria may be identified for further supervisory analysis with respect to real estate concentration risk: 
• Total reported loans for construction, land development and other land represent 100% or more of the bank’s total regulatory capital; 
or 
• Total commercial real estate loans (as defined in the guidance) represent 300% or more of the bank’s total regulatory capital and the 
outstanding balance of the bank’s commercial real estate loan portfolio has increased 50% or more during the prior 36 months. 
The guidance provides that the strength of an institution’s lending and risk management practices with respect to such concentrations will be 
taken into account in supervisory guidance on evaluation of capital adequacy. As of December 31, 2024, the Bank’s aggregate recorded loan 
balances for construction, land development and land loans were 81% of total regulatory capital. In addition, at December 31, 2024, the 
Bank’s loans secured by commercial real estate represent 255% of total regulatory capital. 
Activities and Investments of Insured State-Chartered Financial Institutions:  Federal law generally limits the activities and equity 
investments of FDIC insured, state-chartered banks to those that are permissible for national banks. An insured state bank is not prohibited 
from, among other things, (1) acquiring or retaining a majority interest in a subsidiary, (2) investing as a limited partner in a partnership the 
sole purpose of which is direct or indirect investment in the acquisition, rehabilitation or new construction of a qualified housing project, 
provided that such limited partnership investments may not exceed 2% of the bank’s total assets, (3) acquiring up to 10% of the voting stock 
of a company that solely provides or re-insures directors’, trustees’ and officers’ liability insurance coverage or bankers’ blanket bond group 
insurance coverage for insured depository institutions, and (4) acquiring or retaining the voting shares of a depository institution if certain 
requirements are met. 
Washington State has enacted laws regarding financial institution parity. These laws afford Washington-chartered commercial banks the 
same powers as Washington-chartered savings banks and provide that Washington-chartered commercial banks may exercise any of the 
powers that the Federal Reserve has determined to be closely related to the business of banking and the powers of national banks, subject to 
the approval of the Director in certain situations. Finally, the law provides additional flexibility for Washington-chartered banks with respect 
to interest rates on loans and other extensions of credit. Specifically, they may charge the maximum interest rate allowable for loans and 
other extensions of credit by federally chartered financial institutions. 
Environmental Issues Associated with Real Estate Lending: The Comprehensive Environmental Response, Compensation and Liability Act 
(CERCLA) is a federal statute that generally imposes strict liability on all prior and present “owners and operators” of sites containing 
hazardous waste. However, Congress acted to protect secured creditors by providing that the term “owner and operator” excludes a person 
whose ownership is limited to protecting its security interest in the site. Since the enactment of the CERCLA, this “secured creditor 
exemption” has been the subject of judicial interpretations which have left open the possibility that lenders could be liable for cleanup costs 
on contaminated property that they hold as collateral for a loan. To the extent that legal uncertainty exists in this area, all creditors, including 
the Bank, that have made loans secured by properties with potentially hazardous waste contamination (such as petroleum contamination) 
could be subject to liability for cleanup costs, which often substantially exceed the value of the collateral property. 
Federal Reserve System:  The Federal Reserve has the authority to establish reserve requirements on transaction accounts or non-personal 
time deposits. These reserves may be in the form of cash or non-interest-bearing deposits with the regional Federal Reserve Bank. Interest-
bearing checking accounts and other types of accounts that permit payments or transfers to third parties fall within the definition of 
transaction accounts and are subject to Regulation D reserve requirements, as are any non-personal time deposits at a bank. In March 2020, 
the Federal Reserve reduced requirements to zero percent to support lending to households and businesses. Currently, the Federal Reserve 
has stated it has no plans to re-impose reserve requirements. However, the Federal Reserve may adjust reserve requirement ratios in the 
future if conditions warrant. 
Affiliate Transactions:  Banner and the Bank are separate and distinct legal entities. Banner (and any non-bank subsidiary of Banner) is an 
affiliate of the Bank. Federal laws strictly limit the ability of banks to engage in certain transactions with their affiliates. Transactions 
deemed to be a “covered transaction” under Section 23A of the Federal Reserve Act between a bank and an affiliate are limited to 10% of the 
bank’s capital and surplus and, with respect to all affiliates, to an aggregate of 20% of the bank’s capital and surplus. Further, covered 
transactions that are loans and extensions of credit generally are required to be secured by eligible collateral in specified amounts. Federal 
law also requires that covered transactions and certain other transactions listed in Section 23B of the Federal Reserve Act between a bank and 
its affiliates be on terms as favorable to the bank as transactions with non-affiliates. 
Table of Contents 
14 

Community Reinvestment Act:  The Bank is subject to the Community Reinvestment Act of 1977 (CRA), which requires that federal banking 
regulatory agencies assess a bank’s performance in meeting the credit needs of its community, including low- and moderate-income 
neighborhoods. The regulatory agency’s assessment of the bank’s record is made available to the public and is considered when a bank 
applies to establish a new branch, relocate an existing office, merge, or acquire another federally regulated financial institution. The Bank 
received an “outstanding” rating in its most recent CRA examination. 
On October 24, 2023, federal banking agencies, including the FDIC, issued a final rule to strengthen and modernize CRA regulations. The 
rule encourages banks to expand access to credit, investment, and banking services in low- and moderate-income communities; adapts to 
changes in the banking industry, such as mobile and internet banking; provides greater clarity and consistency in applying CRA regulations; 
and tailors CRA evaluations and data collection to bank size and type. The final rule establishes a new Retail Lending Test for institutions 
with total assets of $600 million or more, evaluating their record in originating and purchasing loans, including residential mortgage, 
multifamily, small business, small farm, and, in certain cases, automobile loans. Banks with total assets exceeding $2 billion will be subject 
to additional performance tests. The rule maintains the requirement for banks to delineate specific facility-based assessment areas around 
their main office, branches, and deposit-taking remote service facilities. It also allows banks to receive CRA credit for qualified community 
development activities, regardless of location. The final rule took effect on April 1, 2024, with staggered compliance dates; most provisions 
become applicable on January 1, 2026. 
Dividends:  The amount of dividends payable by the Bank to the Company depends upon its earnings and capital position, and is limited by 
federal and state laws, regulations and policies, including the capital conservation buffer requirement. Federal law further provides that no 
insured depository institution may make any capital distribution (which includes a cash dividend) if, after making the distribution, the 
institution would be “undercapitalized,” as defined in the prompt corrective action regulations. Moreover, the federal bank regulatory 
agencies also have the general authority to limit the dividends paid by insured banks if such payments should be deemed to constitute an 
unsafe and unsound practice. In addition, under Washington law, no bank may declare or pay any dividend in an amount greater than its 
retained earnings without the prior approval of the Washington DFI. The Washington DFI also has the power to require any bank to suspend 
the payment of any and all dividends. 
Privacy Standards and Cybersecurity:  The Gramm-Leach-Bliley Act of 1999 (GLBA) established a framework allowing affiliations among 
commercial banks, insurance companies, securities firms, and other financial service providers. Federal banking agencies, including the 
FDIC, have implemented guidelines mandating that financial institutions develop, implement, and maintain administrative, technical, and 
physical safeguards to protect client information. These guidelines emphasize risk management, particularly concerning information 
technology and third-party service providers. Additionally, the GLBA requires financial institutions to disclose their privacy policies to 
consumers, detailing information-sharing practices and providing options to opt out of certain disclosures. 
The California Consumer Privacy Act of 2018 (CCPA), effective January 1, 2020, grants California residents rights regarding their personal 
information, including the rights to know, delete, and opt out of the sale of their data. The CCPA also introduces a private right of action for 
data breaches, potentially increasing liability for affected businesses. While the CCPA exempts personal information collected under the 
GLBA, this exemption does not extend to the private right of action for data breaches. In November 2020, California voters approved the 
California Privacy Rights Act (CPRA), which amended the CCPA by enhancing consumer privacy rights and establishing the California 
Privacy Protection Agency for enforcement. Compliance with the CCPA, CPRA, and similar state laws may necessitate the implementation 
of specific regulatory compliance and risk management controls. Non-compliance could result in substantial fines, penalties, legal actions, 
and reputational harm. 
In 2022, federal banking agencies adopted a rule introducing new notification requirements for banking organizations and their service 
providers concerning significant cybersecurity incidents. Banks must notify their primary federal regulator as soon as possible, and no later 
than 36 hours after identifying a computer-security incident that materially affects, or is reasonably likely to materially affect, the bank’s 
operations, its ability to deliver services, or the stability of the financial sector. Service providers are required to inform affected banks 
promptly if they experience an incident that has materially disrupted, or is likely to disrupt, services for four or more hours. 
Anti-Money Laundering, Bank Secrecy and Client Identification:  The Uniting and Strengthening America by Providing Appropriate Tools 
Required to Intercept and Obstruct Terrorism Act of 2001 (USA PATRIOT Act) was signed into law on October 26, 2001. The USA 
PATRIOT and Bank Secrecy Acts require financial institutions to develop programs to prevent financial institutions from being used for 
money laundering and terrorist activities. If such activities are detected, financial institutions are obligated to file suspicious activity reports 
with the U.S. Treasury’s Office of Financial Crimes Enforcement Network. Financial institutions must establish procedures to identify and 
verify the identity of clients seeking to open new financial accounts, and the beneficial owners of accounts. Bank regulators are directed to 
consider an institution’s effectiveness in combating money laundering when ruling on Bank Holding Company Act and Bank Merger Act 
applications.  The Bank’s policies and procedures are designed to comply with the requirements of the USA PATRIOT Act. 
Other Consumer Protection Laws and Regulations:  The CFPB is empowered to exercise broad regulatory, supervisory and enforcement 
authority with respect to both new and existing consumer financial protection laws. The Bank and its affiliates and subsidiaries are subject to 
CFPB supervisory and enforcement authority. 
Table of Contents 
15 

The Bank is subject to a broad array of federal and state consumer protection laws and regulations that govern almost every aspect of its 
business relationships with consumers. While the list set forth below is not exhaustive, these include the Truth-in-Lending Act, the Truth in 
Savings Act, the Electronic Fund Transfers Act, the Expedited Funds Availability Act, the Equal Credit Opportunity Act, the Fair Housing 
Act, the Real Estate Settlement Procedures Act, the Home Mortgage Disclosure Act, the Fair Credit Reporting Act, the Right to Financial 
Privacy Act, the Home Ownership and Equity Protection Act, the Fair Credit Billing Act, the Homeowners Protection Act, the Check 
Clearing for the 21st Century Act, flood insurance laws, consumer protection laws connected with the sale of insurance, federal and state laws 
prohibiting unfair and deceptive business practices, and various regulations that implement some or all of these areas. These laws and 
regulations mandate certain disclosure requirements and regulate how financial institutions must deal with clients when taking deposits, 
making loans, collecting loans, and providing other services. Failure to comply with these laws and regulations can subject the Bank to 
various penalties, including but not limited to, enforcement actions, injunctions, fines, civil liability, criminal penalties, punitive damages, and 
the loss of certain contractual rights. 
Banner Corporation 
General:  Banner, as sole shareholder of the Bank, is a bank holding company registered with the Federal Reserve. Bank holding companies 
are subject to comprehensive regulation by the Federal Reserve under the Bank Holding Company Act of 1956, as amended, or the BHCA, 
and the regulations of the Federal Reserve. We are required to file quarterly reports with the Federal Reserve and provide additional 
information as the Federal Reserve may require. The Federal Reserve may examine us, and any of our subsidiaries. The Federal Reserve also 
has extensive enforcement authority over bank holding companies, including, among other things, the ability to assess civil money penalties, 
to issue cease and desist or removal orders and to require that a holding company divest subsidiaries (including its bank subsidiaries). In 
general, enforcement actions may be initiated for violations of law and regulations and unsafe or unsound practices. Banner is also required 
to file certain reports with, and comply with the rules and regulations of the SEC. 
The Bank Holding Company Act (BHCA):  Under the BHCA, Banner is supervised by the Federal Reserve. The Federal Reserve has a policy 
that a bank holding company is required to serve as a source of financial and managerial strength to its subsidiary banks and may not conduct 
its operations in an unsafe or unsound manner. In addition, the Dodd-Frank Act provides that a bank holding company must serve as a source 
of financial strength to its subsidiary banks. A bank holding company’s failure to meet its obligation to serve as a source of strength to its 
subsidiary banks will generally be considered by the Federal Reserve to be an unsafe and unsound banking practice or a violation of the 
Federal Reserve’s regulations or both. No regulations have yet been proposed by the Federal Reserve to implement the source of strength 
provisions of the Dodd-Frank Act. Banner and any subsidiaries that it may control are considered “affiliates” of the Bank within the meaning 
of the Federal Reserve Act, and transactions between the Bank and affiliates are subject to numerous restrictions. With some exceptions, 
Banner and its subsidiaries are prohibited from tying the provision of various services, such as extensions of credit, to other services offered 
by Banner or by its affiliates. 
Acquisitions: The BHCA prohibits a bank holding company, with certain exceptions, from acquiring ownership or control of more than 5% 
of the voting shares of any company that is not a bank or bank holding company and from engaging in activities other than those of banking, 
managing or controlling banks, or providing services for its subsidiaries. Under the BHCA, the Federal Reserve may approve the ownership 
of shares by a bank holding company in any company, the activities of which the Federal Reserve has determined to be so closely related to 
the business of banking or managing or controlling banks as to be a proper incident thereto. These activities include: operating a savings 
institution, mortgage company, finance company, credit card company or factoring company; performing certain data processing operations; 
providing certain investment and financial advice; underwriting and acting as an insurance agent for certain types of credit-related insurance; 
leasing property on a full-payout, non-operating basis; selling money orders, travelers’ checks and U.S. Savings Bonds; real estate and 
personal property appraising; providing tax planning and preparation services; and, subject to certain limitations, providing securities 
brokerage services for clients. 
Federal Securities Laws: Banner’s common stock is registered with the SEC under Section 12(b) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as 
amended. We are subject to information, proxy solicitation, insider trading restrictions and other requirements under the Securities Exchange 
Act of 1934 (the Exchange Act). In addition, the SEC has enacted rules related to the reporting of cybersecurity events that are material to the 
Company’s operations within a specified time frame. 
The Dodd-Frank Act:  The Dodd-Frank Act imposes various restrictions and an expanded framework of regulatory oversight for financial 
institutions, including depository institutions, and implements certain capital regulations applicable to Banner and the Bank that are discussed 
above under the section entitled “Capital Requirements.” 
Among other things, the Dodd-Frank Act requires public companies, like Banner, to (i) provide their shareholders with a non-binding vote (a) 
at least once every three years on the compensation paid to executive officers and (b) at least once every six years on whether they should 
have a “say on pay” vote every one, two or three years; (ii) have a separate, non-binding shareholder vote regarding golden parachutes for 
named executive officers when a shareholder vote takes place on mergers, acquisitions, dispositions or other transactions that would trigger 
the parachute payments; (iii) provide disclosure in annual proxy materials about the relationship between executive compensation paid and 
the financial performance of the issuer; and (iv) disclose the ratio of the Chief Executive Officer’s annual total compensation to the median 
annual total compensation of all other employees. 
Table of Contents 
16 

The regulations to implement the provisions of Section 619 of the Dodd-Frank Act, commonly referred to as the Volcker Rule, contain 
prohibitions and restrictions on the ability of financial institutions holding companies and their affiliates to engage in proprietary trading and 
hold certain interests in, or have certain relationships with, various types of investment funds, including hedge funds and private equity funds.  
Banner is continuously reviewing its investment portfolio to determine if changes in its investment strategies are in compliance with Volcker 
Rule regulations. 
Interstate Banking and Branching:  The Federal Reserve must approve a bank holding company’s application to acquire control, or acquire all 
or substantially all the assets, of a bank located in a state other than the holding company’s home state, without regard to whether the 
transaction is prohibited by the laws of any state. The Federal Reserve may not approve the acquisition of a bank that has not been in 
existence for the minimum time period (not exceeding five years) specified by statutory law of the host state. Nor may the Federal Reserve 
approve an application if the applicant (and its depository institution affiliates) controls or would control more than 10% of the insured 
deposits in the United States or 30% or more of the deposits in the target bank’s home state or in any state in which the target bank maintains 
a branch. Federal law does not affect states’ authority to limit the percentage of total insured deposits in the state which may be held or 
controlled by a bank holding company to the extent such limitation does not discriminate against out-of-state banks or bank holding 
companies.  Individual states may also waive the 30% state-wide concentration limit contained in the federal law. 
Federal banking agencies are generally authorized to approve interstate merger transactions without regard to whether the transaction is 
prohibited by the law of any state. Interstate branch acquisitions are permitted only if the law of the state in which the branch is located 
permits such acquisitions. 
Interstate mergers and branch acquisitions are subject to the nationwide and statewide insured deposit 
concentration amounts described above. Under the Dodd-Frank Act, the federal banking agencies may generally approve interstate de novo 
branching. 
Dividends:  The Federal Reserve has issued a policy statement on cash dividend payments by bank holding companies, which expresses its 
view that, although there are no specific regulations restricting dividend payments by bank holding companies other than state corporate laws, 
a bank holding company must maintain an adequate capital position and generally should not pay cash dividends unless the company’s net 
income for the past year is sufficient to fully fund the cash dividends and that the prospective rate of earnings appears consistent with the 
company’s capital needs, asset quality, and overall financial condition. The Federal Reserve policy statement also indicates that it would be 
inappropriate for a company experiencing serious financial problems to borrow funds to pay dividends. The capital conversion buffer 
requirement can also restrict Banner’s and the Bank’s ability to pay dividends. Further, under Washington law, Banner is prohibited from 
paying a dividend if, after making such dividend payment, it would be unable to pay its debts as they become due in the usual course of 
business. Banner is also prohibited from paying a dividend if its total liabilities, plus the amount that would be needed in the event Banner 
were to be dissolved at the time of the dividend payment exceed our total assets. 
Stock Repurchases:  A bank holding company, except for certain “well capitalized” and highly rated bank holding companies, is required to 
give the Federal Reserve prior written notice of any purchase or redemption of its outstanding equity securities if the gross consideration for 
the purchase or redemption, when combined with the net consideration paid for all such purchases or redemptions during the preceding 12 
months, is equal to 10% or more of its consolidated net worth. The Federal Reserve may disapprove such a purchase or redemption if it 
determines that the proposal would constitute an unsafe or unsound practice or would violate any law, regulation, Federal Reserve order or 
any condition imposed by, or written agreement with, the Federal Reserve. 
Corporate Information 
Our principal executive offices are located at 10 South First Avenue, Walla Walla, Washington 99362. 
Our company website is 
www.bannerbank.com. The information contained on our website is not included as a part of, or incorporated by reference into, this Annual 
Report on Form 10-K. Our Annual Report on Form 10-K, quarterly reports on Form 10-Q and current reports on Form 8-K, and amendments 
to these reports, are available free of charge through our website, as soon as reasonably practicable after we have electronically filed such 
material with, or furnished such material to, the SEC. 
Table of Contents 
17 

Item 1A – Risk Factors 
An investment in our common stock is subject to risks inherent in our business. Before making an investment decision, you should 
carefully consider the risks and uncertainties described below together with all the other information included in this report. The 
risks described below are not the only ones we face. Additional risks and uncertainties not currently known to us or that we 
currently deem to be immaterial may materially and adversely affect our business, financial condition, capital levels, cash flows, 
liquidity, results of operations and prospects. The market price of our common stock could decline significantly due to any of these 
identified or other risks, and you could lose some or all of your investment. The risks discussed below also include forward-looking 
statements, and our actual results may differ substantially from those discussed in these forward-looking statements. This report is 
qualified in its entirety by these risk factors. 
Risks Related to Macroeconomic Conditions 
Our business may be adversely affected by downturns in the national economy and the regional economies on which we depend. 
Our operations are significantly affected by national and regional economic conditions. Weakness in the national economy, or the economies 
of the markets in which we operate, could have a material adverse effect on our financial condition, results of operations and prospects. We 
provide banking and financial services primarily to businesses and individuals in the states of Washington, Oregon, California and Idaho, with 
all of our branches and most of our deposit clients located in these four states. 
Our client base is highly concentrated in the Puget Sound area and eastern Washington. A deterioration in the business environment in these 
regions, or one or more businesses with a large employee base in these areas, could have a material adverse effect on our business, financial 
condition, liquidity, results of operations and prospects. As we expand into other areas, such as San Diego, Sacramento, and throughout 
California, we face additional concentration risks in those markets. Furthermore, trade wars, tariffs, or shifts in trade policies between the 
United States and other nations could disrupt supply chains, increase costs for businesses, and reduce export opportunities for our clients.  
These developments may, in turn, negatively impact these businesses and, by extension, our operations and financial performance. 
A downturn in economic conditions, be it due to inflation, recessive trends, geopolitical conflicts, adverse weather, severe fire or other natural 
disasters, or other factors, could have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition, liquidity and results of operations, 
including but not limited to: 
• Reduced demand for our products and services, potentially leading to a decline in our overall loans or assets; 
• Elevated instances of loan delinquencies, problematic assets, and foreclosures; 
• An increase in our allowance for credit losses on loans; 
• Declines in collateral values linked to our loans, thereby diminishing borrowing capacities and asset values tied to existing loans; 
• Reduced net worth and liquidity of loan guarantors, possibly impairing their ability to meet commitments to us; and 
• Reduction in our low-cost or non-interest-bearing deposits. 
A decline in local economic conditions could disproportionately affect our earnings and capital compared to larger financial institutions with 
more geographically diverse real estate loan portfolios. Because our loan portfolio is predominantly secured by real estate, deterioration in 
real estate markets could impair borrowers’ ability to repay loans and reduce the value of the underlying collateral. Real estate values are 
influenced by a range of factors, including economic conditions, government policies, natural disasters (e.g., fires, earthquakes, flooding and 
tornadoes), and trade-related pressures affecting construction costs or material availability. Liquidating significant collateral during a period 
of depressed real estate values could negatively impact our financial condition and profitability. 
Adverse changes in regional or general economic conditions may reduce our growth rate, impair our ability to collect loans and generally 
have a negative effect on our financial condition and results of operations. 
Monetary policy, inflation, deflation, and other external economic factors could adversely impact our financial performance and 
operations. 
Our financial condition and results of operations are affected by credit policies of monetary authorities, particularly the Federal Reserve.  
Actions by monetary and fiscal authorities, including the Federal Reserve, could lead to inflation, deflation, or other economic phenomena 
that could adversely affect our financial performance. Higher U.S. tariffs on imported goods could exacerbate inflationary pressures by 
increasing the cost of goods and materials for businesses and consumers. This may particularly affect small to medium-sized businesses, as 
they are less able to leverage economies of scale to mitigate cost pressures compared to larger businesses. Consequently, our business clients 
may experience increased financial strain, reducing their ability to repay loans and adversely impacting our results of operations and financial 
condition. Furthermore, a prolonged period of inflation could cause wages and other costs to the Company to increase, which could adversely 
affect our results of operations and financial condition. Virtually all of our assets and liabilities are monetary in nature, and as a result, 
interest rates tend to have a more significant impact on our performance than general levels of inflation or deflation. However, interest rates 
do not necessarily move in the same direction or magnitude as the prices of goods and services, creating additional uncertainty in the 
economic environment. 
Table of Contents 
18 

Risks Related to Credit and Lending 
Our loan portfolio includes loans with a higher risk of loss. 
In addition to first-lien one- to four-family residential real estate lending, we originate construction and land and land development loans, 
commercial and multifamily real estate loans, commercial business loans, agricultural mortgage and business loans, and consumer loans, 
primarily within our market areas. As of December 31, 2024, we had $9.76 billion outstanding in these non-first-lien one- to four-family 
residential real estate loan categories, compared to $9.29 billion as of December 31, 2023. These loans present risks distinct from those 
associated with first-lien one- to four-family residential real estate lending for a number of reasons, including the following: 
• Construction and Land Loans.  At December 31, 2024, construction and land loans were $1.52 billion, or 14% of our total loan 
portfolio. This type of lending carries inherent uncertainties in estimating a property’s future value upon project completion and the 
overall cost (including interest) of the project. These challenges arise from difficulties in estimating construction costs, assessing 
market value upon project completion, and accounting for the impact of government regulations on real property. Accurately 
evaluating the total funds required to complete a project and determining the loan-to-value ratio for the completed project is often 
challenging. 
If construction cost estimates are inaccurate, we may be required to advance funds beyond the original loan 
commitment to ensure project completion. Additionally, if the appraised value of the completed project is overstated, we may have 
inadequate security for loan repayment, resulting in potential losses. Other risks include disputes between borrowers and builders, 
the failure of builders to pay subcontractors, and the concentration of higher loan amounts among a limited number of builders. A 
downturn in housing or the real estate market could increase delinquencies, defaults and foreclosures, and significantly impair the 
value of our collateral and our ability to sell the collateral upon foreclosure. Multiple loans to a single builder amplify these risks, as 
adverse developments in one loan or credit relationship could result in significant losses. At December 31, 2024, non-performing 
construction and land loans totaled $4.0 million, or 11% of total non-performing loans. 
Some construction loans include interest reserves, where accumulated interest is added to the loan principal rather than requiring 
borrower payments during the loan term. Rising market interest rates can rapidly deplete these reserves before project completion 
and increase borrowing costs for end-purchasers, potentially reducing their ability to finance the home or diminishing demand for the 
project. Properties under construction are also challenging to sell and typically need to be completed before a sale can occur, 
complicating the management of problem construction loans. This may require advancing additional funds or contracting with 
another builder to complete the project, exposing us to market risks and potential losses on unpaid loan funds and associated costs. 
Loans on land under development or held for future construction carry additional risks due to the lack of income generation and 
reduced collateral liquidity, both of which are highly influenced by supply and demand dynamics. These loans often involve 
substantial disbursements, with repayment dependent on the success of the project and the borrower’s ability to sell or lease the 
property or obtain permanent financing. 
Our construction loans include both those secured by sales contracts or permanent loans for finished homes and speculative 
construction loans, where end-purchasers may not be identified during or after the construction period. Speculative construction 
loans present additional risks related to finding buyers for completed projects. To mitigate this risk, we actively monitor the number 
of unsold homes in our construction loan portfolio and local housing markets to maintain a balance between home sales and new loan 
originations. We also limit the number of speculative construction loans approved for each builder based on factors such as financial 
capacity, market demand, and the ratio of sold to unsold inventory. Additionally, we diversify risk by working with a large number 
of small- to mid-sized builders across a broad geographic region, encompassing multiple sub-markets within our service area. 
• Commercial and Multifamily Real Estate Loans. At December 31, 2024, commercial and multifamily real estate loans were $4.76 
billion, or 42% of our total loan portfolio. Many of these loans involve higher principal amounts than other types of loans, and some 
commercial borrowers maintain multiple loans with us. Consequently, an adverse development with respect to a single loan or credit 
relationship can expose us to a significantly greater risk of loss compared to an adverse development with respect to a one- to four-
family residential mortgage loan. Repayment of these loans typically depends on the income generated from the property securing 
the loan, in amounts sufficient to cover operating expenses and debt service. This income may be adversely affected by changes in 
the economy or local market conditions. In addition, many of our commercial and multifamily real estate loans are not fully 
amortizing and include large balloon payments at maturity. These balloon payments may require the borrower to either sell or 
refinance the underlying property, potentially increasing the risk of default or non-payment. If we foreclose on a commercial or 
multifamily real estate loan, the holding period for the collateral is typically longer than for one- to four-family residential loans as a 
result of the smaller pool of potential buyers. At December 31, 2024, non-performing commercial and multifamily real estate loans 
totaled $2.2 million, or 6% of total non-performing loans. 
• Commercial Business Loans.  At December 31, 2024, commercial business loans were $2.42 billion, or 21% of our total loan 
portfolio. These loans are primarily made based on the borrower’s cash flow and, secondarily, on the underlying collateral provided 
by the borrower. A borrower’s cash flow can be unpredictable, and the value of collateral securing these loans may fluctuate. Most 
often, this collateral includes accounts receivable, inventory, equipment, or real estate. For loans secured by accounts receivable, the 
availability of funds for repayment may depend substantially on the borrower’s ability to collect amounts due from its clients. Other 
types of collateral securing commercial business loans may depreciate over time, be difficult to appraise, lack liquidity, or fluctuate 
in value depending on the success of the business. At December 31, 2024, non-performing commercial business loans totaled $7.1 
million, or 19% of total non-performing loans. 
Table of Contents 
19 

• Agricultural Loans. At December 31, 2024, agricultural loans were $340.3 million, or 3% of our total loan portfolio. Repayment of 
agricultural loans depends on the successful operation of the business and is subject to numerous factors beyond the control of either 
us or the borrowers. These factors include adverse weather conditions that prevent crop planting or limit yields (such as hail, 
drought, and floods), loss of crops or livestock due to disease or other causes, declines in market prices for agricultural products 
(both domestically and internationally), and the impact of government regulations (including changes in price supports, subsidies, 
tariffs, and environmental policies). Additionally, many farms rely on a limited number of key individuals whose injury or death 
could significantly affect the farm’s successful operation. If the cash flow from a farming operation is diminished, the borrower’s 
ability to repay the loan may be impaired. As a result, agricultural loans may pose a greater degree of risk than other types of loans, 
particularly those that are unsecured or secured by rapidly depreciating assets, such as farm equipment (some of which is highly 
specialized and may have little or no resale market), or assets like livestock or crops. In such cases, repossessed collateral from a 
defaulted agricultural loan may not provide an adequate source of repayment for the outstanding loan balance due to the greater 
likelihood of damage, loss, or depreciation, or because the collateral’s assessed value exceeds its eventual realization value. At 
December 31, 2024, non-performing agricultural loans totaled $8.5 million, or 23% of total non-performing loans. 
• Consumer Loans. At December 31, 2024, consumer loans were $721.4 million, or 6% of our total loan portfolio. Home equity lines 
of credit, which represented 87% of our total consumer loan portfolio at December 31, 2024, generally entail greater risk than one- to 
four-family residential mortgage loans where we are in the first lien position. For home equity lines secured by a second mortgage, it 
is less likely that we will recover all our loan proceeds in the event of default as the value of the property must be sufficient to cover 
repayment of the first mortgage loan and foreclosure-related costs before the second mortgage loan balance is repaid. For consumer 
loans that are unsecured or secured by rapidly depreciating assets, such as automobiles, any repossessed collateral from a defaulted 
loan may not provide an adequate source of repayment of the outstanding loan balance as a result of the higher likelihood of damage, 
loss, or depreciation. The remaining deficiency often does not justify further substantial collection efforts against the borrower.  
Additionally, consumer loan collections depend on the borrower’s financial stability, making them more vulnerable to adverse events 
such as job loss, divorce, illness, or personal bankruptcy. Furthermore, federal and state laws, including bankruptcy and insolvency 
laws, may limit the amount recoverable on these loans. Loans we purchased or indirectly originated may also expose us to claims 
and defenses by borrowers. In such cases, borrowers may assert claims and defenses against us as an assignee that they could have 
raised against the seller of the underlying collateral. At December 31, 2024, non-performing consumer loans totaled $4.9 million, or 
13% of total non-performing loans. 
Our business may be adversely affected by credit risk associated with residential property and declining property values. 
At December 31, 2024, first-lien one- to four-family residential loans were $1.59 billion or 14% of our total loan portfolio. Our first-lien one- 
to four-family residential loans are primarily made based on the repayment ability of the borrower and the collateral securing these loans.  
Foreclosure on the loans requires the value of the property to be sufficient to cover the repayment of the loan, and the costs associated with 
foreclosure. 
This type of lending is generally sensitive to regional and local economic conditions that significantly impact the ability of borrowers to meet 
their loan payment obligations, making loss levels difficult to predict. A downturn in the economy or the housing market in our market areas 
or a rapid increase in interest rates may reduce the value of the real estate collateral securing these types of loans and increase the risk that we 
would incur losses if borrowers default on their loans. Residential loans with high combined loan-to-value generally will be more sensitive to 
declining property values than those with lower combined loan-to-value ratios and therefore may experience a higher incidence of default and 
severity of losses. In addition, if the borrowers sell their homes, the borrowers may be unable to repay their loans in full from the sale 
proceeds. As a result, these loans may experience higher rates of delinquencies, defaults and losses, which will in turn adversely affect our 
financial condition and results of operations. At December 31, 2024, non-performing one- to four-family residential loans totaled $10.4 
million, or 28% of total non-performing loans. 
Our allowance for credit losses on loans may not be sufficient to absorb losses in our loan portfolio, which would cause our results of 
operations, liquidity and financial condition to be adversely affected. 
Lending money is a substantial part of our business and each loan carries a certain risk that it will not be repaid in accordance with its terms or 
that any underlying collateral will not be sufficient to assure repayment.  This risk is affected by, among other things: 
• cash flow of the borrower and/or the project being financed; 
• in the case of a collateralized loan, the changes and uncertainties as to the future value of the collateral; 
• the duration of the loan; 
• the character and creditworthiness of the borrower; and 
• changes in economic and industry conditions. 
Table of Contents 
20 

We maintain an allowance for credit losses that we believe is appropriate to provide for lifetime expected credit losses in our loan portfolio.  
The appropriate level of the allowance for credit losses is determined by Management through periodic reviews and consideration of several 
factors, including, but not limited to: 
• our collective loss reserve, for loans evaluated on a pool basis with similar risk characteristics based on our life of loan historical 
default and loss experience, certain macroeconomic factors, reasonable and supportable forecasts, regulatory requirements, 
Management’s expectations of future events and certain qualitative factors; and 
• our individual loss reserve, based on our evaluation of individual loans that do not share similar risk characteristics and the present 
value of the expected future cash flows or the fair value of the underlying collateral. 
Determination of the appropriate level of the allowance for credit losses inherently involves a high degree of subjectivity and requires us to 
make significant estimates of current credit risks and future trends, all of which may undergo material changes. If our estimates are incorrect, 
the allowance for credit losses may not be sufficient to cover the expected losses in our loan portfolio, resulting in the need for increases in 
our allowance for credit losses through the provision for credit losses which is recorded as a charge against income. Management also 
recognizes that significant new growth in loan portfolios, new loan products and the refinancing of existing loans can result in portfolios 
comprised of unseasoned loans that may not perform in a historical or projected manner and will increase the risk that our allowance may be 
insufficient to absorb losses without significant additional provision. 
Deterioration in economic conditions affecting borrowers, new information regarding existing loans, identification of additional problem 
loans and other factors, both within and outside of our control, may require an increase in the allowance for credit losses. If current 
conditions in the housing and real estate markets weaken, we expect we will experience increased delinquencies and credit losses. 
The ongoing Los Angeles wildfires that began in January 2025 present heightened risks to our loan portfolio and the adequacy of our 
allowance for loan losses. Borrowers impacted by the fires may face financial hardship, leading to increased loan defaults and reduced 
repayment capacity. Damage to or destruction of properties securing loans may result in collateral value depreciation, further increasing 
potential losses. Additionally, inadequate insurance coverage or denied claims may limit recovery efforts and contribute to greater 
uncertainty in estimating credit losses. Local economic disruptions, such as business closures and job losses, may impair borrowers’ ability to 
meet financial obligations, requiring adjustments to our credit loss assumptions. The concentration of our loan portfolio in fire-prone areas 
further increases exposure, while the growing frequency and severity of wildfires due to climate change heightens long-term risks. These 
factors may necessitate increases to our allowance for loan losses to account for elevated credit risks. While we continuously evaluate our 
allowance to ensure it reflects current and expected risks, there can be no assurance it will be sufficient to cover actual losses, particularly in 
the context of ongoing and future wildfire-related challenges. 
Bank regulatory agencies also periodically review our allowance for credit losses and may require an increase in the provision for credit 
losses or the recognition of further loan charge-offs, based on judgments different than those of Management. If charge-offs in future periods 
exceed the allowance for credit losses, we may need additional provision to increase the allowance for credit losses. Any increases in the 
allowance for credit losses will reduce net income and, most likely, capital, and may have a material negative effect on our financial condition 
and results of operations. 
Table of Contents 
21 

Risks Related to Merger and Acquisition Strategy 
We pursue a strategy of supplementing internal growth by acquiring other financial companies or their assets and liabilities, which 
we believe will help us fulfill our strategic objectives and enhance our earnings. We may be adversely affected by risks associated 
with growth through acquisitions. 
As part of our general growth strategy, we periodically expand our business through acquisitions. While our primary focus is organic growth, 
from time to time we engage in discussions with potential acquisition targets as part of our ordinary business activities. There can be no 
assurance that we will successfully identify suitable acquisition candidates, complete acquisitions, successfully integrate acquired operations 
into our existing operations, or expand into new markets. Future acquisitions may dilute shareholder value or may have an adverse effect 
upon our operating results during the integration process. In addition, acquired operations may fail to achieve the profitability levels of our 
existing operations or meet performance expectations. Transaction-related expenses may also adversely affect our earnings, which could, in 
turn, negatively impact the value of our stock. 
Acquiring banks, bank branches, or businesses involves several risks, including: 
• we may be exposed to potential asset quality issues or unknown or contingent liabilities of the banks, businesses, assets, and 
liabilities we acquire. If these issues or liabilities exceed our estimates, our results of operations and financial condition may be 
materially negatively affected; 
• higher than expected deposit attrition; 
• potential diversion of our management’s time and attention; 
• prices at which acquisitions can be made fluctuate with market conditions. We have experienced times during which acquisitions 
could not be made in specific markets at prices we considered acceptable and expect that we will experience this situation in the 
future; 
• the acquisition of other entities generally requires integration of systems, procedures and personnel of the acquired entity into our 
company to make the transaction economically successful. This integration process is complicated and time-consuming and can also 
be disruptive to the clients of the acquired business. If the integration process is not conducted successfully and with minimal 
adverse effect on the acquired business and its clients, we may not realize the anticipated economic benefits of particular acquisitions 
within the expected time frame, and we may lose clients or employees of the acquired business. We may also experience greater 
than anticipated client losses even if the integration process is successful; 
• to finance an acquisition, we may borrow funds, thereby increasing our leverage and diminishing our liquidity, or raise additional 
capital, which could dilute the interests of our existing shareholders; 
• we have completed various acquisitions over the years that enhanced our rate of growth. We may not be able to sustain our past rate 
of growth or to grow at all in the future; and 
• to the extent our costs of an acquisition exceed the fair value of the net assets acquired, the acquisition will generate goodwill that 
must be analyzed for impairment at least annually. 
We may incur impairment to goodwill. 
In accordance with generally accepted accounting principles (GAAP), we record assets acquired and liabilities assumed in a business 
combination at their fair value with the excess of the purchase consideration over the net assets acquired resulting in the recognition of 
goodwill. As a result, acquisitions typically result in recording goodwill. We perform a goodwill evaluation at least annually to test for 
goodwill impairment. Our test of goodwill for potential impairment is based on a qualitative assessment by Management that takes into 
consideration macroeconomic conditions, industry and market conditions, cost or margin factors, financial performance and share price. Our 
evaluation of the fair value of goodwill involves a substantial amount of judgment. If our judgment was incorrect, or if events or 
circumstances change, and an impairment of goodwill was deemed to exist, we would be required to record a non-cash charge to earnings in 
our financial statements during the period in which such impairment is determined to exist. Any such charge could have a material adverse 
effect on our results of operations. 
Risks Related to Market and Interest Rate Changes 
Our results of operations, liquidity and cash flows are subject to interest rate risk. 
Our earnings and cash flows are largely dependent upon our net interest income, which is significantly affected by interest rates. Interest rates 
are highly sensitive to factors beyond our control, such as general economic conditions and policies set by governmental and regulatory 
bodies, particularly the Federal Reserve. Increases in interest rates could reduce our net interest income, weaken the housing market by 
curbing refinancing activity and home purchases, and negatively affect the broader U.S. economy, potentially leading to slower economic 
growth or recessionary conditions. 
We principally manage interest rate risk by managing our volume and mix of our earning assets and funding liabilities. If we are unable to 
manage this risk effectively, our business, financial condition and results of operations could be materially affected. 
Table of Contents 
22 

Our net interest margin, the difference between the yield on interest-earning assets and the cost of interest-bearing liabilities, can be adversely 
affected by interest rate changes. While yields on assets and costs of liabilities tend to move in the same direction, they may do so at different 
speeds, causing the margin to expand or contract. As our interest-bearing liabilities often have shorter durations than our interest-earning 
assets, a rise in interest rates may lead to funding costs increasing faster than asset yields, compressing our net interest margin. Additionally, 
changes in the slope of the yield curve, such as flattening or inversion, can further pressure our margins as funding costs rise relative to asset 
yields.  Conversely, falling rates can initially reduce our net interest income as our floating-rate assets tend to be more immediately responsive 
to changes in market rates than most deposit liabilities. In addition, a decline in market interest rates could increase loan prepayments, 
leading to reinvestment in lower-yielding assets, reducing income. 
In a rising rate environment, retaining deposits can become costlier. At December 31, 2024, we had $1.45 billion in certificates of deposit 
that mature within one year and $12.01 billion in non-interest-bearing, negotiable order of withdrawal (NOW) checking, savings and money 
market accounts. If deposit and borrowing rates rise faster than loan and investment yields, our net interest income and overall earnings could 
decline. 
A substantial amount of our loans have adjustable interest rates, which may result in a higher rate of default in a rising interest rate 
environment. Additionally, a significant portion of our adjustable-rate loans include interest rate floors that prevent the loan’s contractual 
interest rate from falling below a specified level. At December 31, 2024, approximately 65% of our loan portfolio consisted of adjustable or 
floating-rate loans, and approximately $5.19 billion, or 70%, of those loans contained interest rate floors. The weighted average floor interest 
rate of these loans was 4.77%, and approximately $1.34 billion, or 26%, of these loans were at their floor interest rate. The presence of 
interest rate floors can increase income during periods of declining interest rates, as the rates on these loans cannot adjust downward below 
the floor. However, this benefit is subject to the risk that borrowers may refinance these loans to take advantage of lower rates. Furthermore, 
when loans are at their floor interest rates, our interest income may not rise as quickly as our cost of funds during periods of increasing 
interest rates, which could materially and adversely affect our results of operations. 
While we employ asset and liability management strategies to mitigate interest rate risk, unexpected, substantial, or prolonged rate changes 
could materially affect our financial condition and results of operations.  Additionally, our interest rate risk models and assumptions may not 
fully capture the impact of actual rate changes on our balance sheet or projected operating results. 
Our securities portfolio may be negatively impacted by fluctuations in market value and interest rates. 
Our securities portfolio may be impacted by fluctuations in market value, potentially reducing accumulated other comprehensive income and/ 
or earnings. These fluctuations may result from changes in market interest rates, rating agency actions in respect to the securities, defaults by 
the issuer or with respect to the underlying securities, lower market prices, or limited investor demand. Our available-for-sale debt securities 
in an unrealized loss position are evaluated to determine whether the decline in fair value has resulted from credit losses or other factors. If a 
credit loss is identified, an allowance for credit losses is recorded, resulting in a charge against earnings. Because available-for-sale securities 
are reported at estimated fair value, changes in interest rates can adversely affect our financial condition. The fair value of fixed-rate 
securities generally moves inversely with interest rate changes. Unrealized gains and losses on these securities are reported as a separate 
component of AOCI, net of tax. 
Decreases in the fair value of securities—available-for-sale resulting from increases in interest rates could have an adverse effect on 
shareholders’ equity. Additionally, there is no assurance that the declines in market value will not result in credit losses, which would lead to 
additional provisions for credit losses that could materially affect our net income and capital levels. 
An increase in interest rates, change in the programs offered by secondary market purchasers or our ability to qualify for their 
programs may reduce our mortgage banking revenues, which would negatively impact our non-interest income. 
Our mortgage banking operations provide a significant portion of our non-interest income, primarily through gains on the sale of one-to-four-
family residential loans. These loans are sold pursuant to programs offered by Fannie Mae, Freddie Mac, Ginnie Mae, and non-Government 
Sponsored Enterprise (“GSE”) investors, which collectively account for a substantial portion of the secondary market for such loans.  
Changes to these programs, our eligibility to participate, the criteria for loan acceptance, or related laws could materially and adversely affect 
our results of operations. 
Mortgage banking is generally considered a volatile source of income because it depends largely on loan volume, which is influenced by 
prevailing market interest rates. In a rising or higher interest rate environment, our originations of mortgage loans may decrease, resulting in 
fewer loans that are available to be sold to investors. This would result in a decrease in mortgage banking revenues and a corresponding 
decrease in non-interest income. Our results of operations are also affected by the amount of non-interest expense associated with mortgage 
banking activities, including salaries and employee benefits, occupancy, equipment, data processing, and other operating costs. During 
periods of reduced loan demand, we may face challenges in reducing these expenses proportionately, which could adversely impact our 
results of operations. 
Although we sell loans into the secondary market without recourse, we provide customary representations and warranties to buyers. If these 
representations and warranties are breached, we may be required to repurchase the loans, potentially incurring a loss. 
Table of Contents 
23 

Certain hedging strategies that we use to manage investment in mortgage loans held for sale and interest rate lock commitments may 
be ineffective to offset any adverse changes in the fair value of these assets due to changes in interest rates and market liquidity. 
We use derivative instruments to economically hedge mortgage loans held for sale and interest rate lock commitments to offset changes in fair 
value resulting from changing interest rate environments. Our hedging strategies are susceptible to prepayment risk, basis risk, market 
volatility and changes in the shape of the yield curve, among other factors. In addition, hedging strategies rely on assumptions and 
projections regarding assets and general market factors. If these assumptions and projections prove to be incorrect or our hedging strategies 
do not adequately mitigate the impact of changes in interest rates, we may incur losses that would adversely impact earnings. 
Risks Related to Regulatory, Legal and Compliance 
New or proposed FDIC guidelines on corporate governance and risk management standards may affect our profitability, capital 
adequacy, and reputation. 
In October 2023, the FDIC proposed guidelines to establish corporate governance and risk management standards for insured state 
nonmember banks with total consolidated assets of $10 billion or more. These guidelines focus on defining the responsibilities of the board 
of directors, specifying board composition and committee structures, establishing expectations for an independent risk management function, 
and introducing safeguards to prevent a "single point of failure" in risk management processes. If implemented, these guidelines could 
materially affect us and other banks subject to their requirements in the following ways: 
• 
Compliance with the guidelines may elevate operational complexity and costs, potentially diminishing our net income and return on 
equity. 
• 
The guidelines could mandate maintaining increased levels of capital or liquidity, which may restrict our ability to leverage assets 
and generate higher returns. 
• 
The guidelines may subject us to heightened regulatory oversight and enforcement actions, which could adversely affect our 
reputation and market valuation. 
• 
Banks subject to these guidelines, including us, may face competitive disadvantages compared to financial institutions not subject to 
similar standards. 
• 
The guidelines’ emphasis on board responsibilities and independence may make it more challenging to attract and retain qualified 
directors willing to serve on our board. 
The full implications of the proposed guidelines on our profitability, capital adequacy, and reputation remain uncertain at this time. However, 
the potential for increased operational burdens, reduced financial flexibility, and elevated regulatory risks underscores the importance of 
monitoring developments closely and adapting our governance and risk management practices to meet evolving regulatory expectations.  
Failure to effectively manage these challenges could have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition, and results of 
operations. 
New or changing tax, accounting, and regulatory rules and interpretations could significantly impact strategic initiatives, results of 
operations, cash flows, and financial condition. 
The financial services industry is extensively regulated. Federal and state banking regulations are designed primarily to protect the deposit 
insurance funds and consumers, not to benefit our shareholders. Regulations may sometimes impose significant limitations on operations.  
Regulatory authorities have extensive discretion in connection with their supervisory and enforcement activities, including the imposition of 
restrictions on the operation of an institution, the classification of assets by the institution and the adequacy of an institution’s allowance for 
credit losses.  Bank regulators also have the ability to impose conditions in the approval of merger and acquisition transactions. 
Additionally, actions by regulatory agencies or significant litigation against us may lead to penalties that materially affect us. These 
regulations, along with the current tax, accounting, securities, insurance, and monetary laws, regulations, rules, standards, policies, and 
interpretations control the methods by which financial institutions conduct business, implement strategic initiatives and tax compliance, and 
govern financial reporting and disclosures. These laws, regulations, rules, standards, policies, and interpretations are constantly evolving and 
may change significantly over time. Any new regulations or legislation or change in existing regulations or oversight, whether a change in 
regulatory policy or a change in a regulator’s interpretation of a law or regulation, could have a material impact on our operations, increase 
our costs of regulatory compliance and of doing business and/or otherwise adversely affect us and our profitability. Further, changes in 
accounting standards can be both difficult to predict and involve judgment and discretion in their interpretation by us and our independent 
registered public accounting firm. Changes could materially impact, potentially even retroactively, how we report our financial condition and 
results of our operations, as could our interpretation of those changes. We cannot predict what restrictions may be imposed upon us with 
future legislation. 
Table of Contents 
24 

Climate change and related legislative and regulatory initiatives may materially affect the Company’s business and results of 
operations. 
The effects of climate change continue to raise significant concerns about the state of the environment. However, under a new administration, 
federal policy may shift to reduce the emphasis on climate change initiatives and environmental regulations. This could include scaling back 
federal participation in international agreements, such as is occurring with the Paris Agreement, and reducing regulatory pressures on 
businesses, including banks, to address climate-related risks. Legislative and regulatory proposals aimed at combating climate change may 
face greater scrutiny or diminished priority. 
The lack of empirical data regarding the financial and credit risks posed by climate change still makes it difficult to predict its specific impact 
on our financial condition and results of operations. However, the physical effects of climate change, such as more frequent and severe 
weather disasters, could directly affect us. For instance, such events may damage real property securing loans in our portfolios or reduce the 
value of that collateral. If our borrowers’ insurance is insufficient to cover these losses or if insurance becomes unavailable, the value of the 
collateral securing our loans could be negatively affected, potentially impacting our financial condition and results of operations. Moreover, 
climate change may adversely affect regional and local economic activity, harming our clients and the communities in which we operate.  
Regardless of changes in federal policy, the effects of climate change and their unknown long-term impacts could still have a material adverse 
effect on our financial condition and results of operations. 
Non-compliance with the USA PATRIOT Act, Bank Secrecy Act, or other laws and regulations could result in fines or sanctions and 
limit our ability to obtain regulatory approval of acquisitions. 
The USA PATRIOT and Bank Secrecy Acts require financial institutions to develop programs to prevent financial institutions from being 
used for money laundering and terrorist activities. If such activities are detected, financial institutions are obligated to file suspicious activity 
reports with the U.S. Treasury’s Office of Financial Crimes Enforcement Network. These rules require financial institutions to establish 
procedures for identifying and verifying the identity of clients seeking to open new financial accounts. Failure to comply with these 
regulations could result in fines or sanctions and limit our ability to obtain regulatory approval of acquisitions. While we have developed 
policies and procedures designed to assist in compliance with these laws and regulations, no assurance can be given that these policies and 
procedures will be effective in preventing violations of these laws and regulations. Additionally, any perceived or actual failure to prevent 
money laundering or terrorist financing activities could significantly damage our reputation. These outcomes could have a material adverse 
effect on our business, financial condition, results of operations, and growth prospects. 
If our enterprise risk management framework is not effective at mitigating risk and loss to us, we could suffer unexpected losses and 
our results of operations could be materially adversely affected. 
Our enterprise risk management framework seeks to achieve an appropriate balance between risk and return, which is critical to optimizing 
shareholder value. We have established processes and procedures intended to identify, measure, monitor, report, analyze and control the 
types of risks we face. These risks include liquidity, credit, market, interest rate, operational, legal and compliance, and reputational risks, 
among others. We also maintain a compliance program designed to identify, measure and report on our adherence to applicable laws, 
regulations, policies and procedures. Although we continuously assess and improve these programs, there can be no assurance that our risk 
management or compliance programs, along with other related controls, will effectively mitigate all risk and limit losses in our business.  
However, as with any risk management framework, there are inherent limitations to our risk management strategies as there may exist, or 
develop in the future, risks that we have not appropriately anticipated or identified. If our risk management framework proves ineffective, we 
could suffer unexpected losses and our business financial condition and results of operations could be materially adversely affected. 
Our business and financial results could be impacted materially by adverse results in legal proceedings. 
Legal proceedings could result in judgments, significant management time and attention, or other adverse effects on our business and 
financial results. We establish estimated liabilities for legal claims when payments associated with claims become probable and the amount 
of loss can be reasonably estimated. We may incur losses for a matter even if we have not established an estimated liability. In addition, the 
actual cost of resolving a legal claim may be substantially higher than any amounts accrued for that matter. The ultimate resolution of any 
legal proceeding, depending on the remedy granted, could materially adversely affect our results of operations and financial condition. 
Table of Contents 
25 

Risks Related to Cybersecurity, Data and Fraud 
We are subject to certain risks in connection with our use of technology. 
Our security measures may not be sufficient to mitigate the risk of a cyber-attack. Communications and information systems are essential to 
our business operations, as we rely on these systems to manage our client relationships, maintain our general ledger, and support virtually all 
other aspects of our operations. Our business depends on the secure processing, storage, and transmission of confidential and other 
information through our computer systems and networks. Although we take protective measures and adapt them as circumstances evolve, our 
systems, software, and networks may remain vulnerable to breaches, fraudulent or unauthorized access, denial or degradation of service 
attacks, misuse, computer viruses, malware, or other cyber threats. If any of these events occur, they could compromise our or our clients’ 
confidential information, disrupt operations, or harm our clients or counterparties. 
We may incur significant expenses to investigate and remediate security vulnerabilities, enhance protective measures, or address the impact of 
a cyber-attack. Such incidents could expose us to litigation, regulatory scrutiny, and financial losses not fully covered by insurance. They 
could also cause significant reputational damage, which may deter clients from using our services. 
Cybersecurity risks are particularly acute in internet banking. Increases in criminal sophistication, advances in technology, or vulnerabilities 
in third-party systems (such as browsers and operating systems) could lead to breaches that compromise the security of data and transactions.  
A breach could discourage clients from using our online services, negatively impacting our business. 
While we have developed and continue to invest in systems and processes to detect and prevent security breaches, no system is foolproof.  
Breaches could result in financial losses to us or our clients, reputational harm, additional compliance costs, business disruption, regulatory 
penalties, and potential legal liabilities. These outcomes could materially adversely affect our financial condition, results of operations, and 
ability to grow our online services. In addition, our security measures may not protect us from system failures or interruptions. Although we 
have policies and procedures to mitigate such risks, we cannot guarantee their effectiveness. We also rely on third-party providers for data 
processing and operational support. While we carefully select these providers, we do not control their actions. If a third-party vendor 
experiences disruptions, cyber-attacks, or fails to meet our service standards, it could impair our ability to process transactions, deliver 
products and services, or conduct business.  Transitioning to alternative vendors could involve significant delays and costs. 
Further, information security risks may arise from the processing of client data by third-party vendors and their personnel. We cannot assure 
you that breaches, system failures, or interruptions will not occur or that they will be adequately addressed by us or our vendors.  
Additionally, our insurance coverage may not fully protect against all losses from such events. 
If any of our third-party providers experience financial, operational, or technological difficulties, or if disruptions occur in our relationships 
with them, we may be required to find alternative service providers. This could involve negotiating less favorable terms or incurring 
substantial costs to implement new systems. Any of these occurrences, whether system failures, security breaches, or vendor disruptions, 
could damage our reputation, result in client and business losses, expose us to regulatory scrutiny and legal liabilities, and have a material 
adverse effect on our financial condition and results of operations. 
Our current and future uses of Artificial Intelligence (AI) and other emerging technologies may create additional risks. 
The increasing adoption of AI in financial services presents significant opportunities but also introduces a range of risks that could impact our 
operations, regulatory compliance, and client trust. AI introduces model risk, where flawed algorithms or biased data could result in 
inaccurate credit decisions, compliance violations, or discriminatory outcomes in lending or client service. Cybersecurity threats, such as data 
breaches, adversarial attacks, and data poisoning, pose significant challenges, particularly as these systems handle large volumes of sensitive 
client information. Additionally, the opaque nature of some AI models, often referred to as "black-box" systems, raises regulatory 
compliance concerns, as regulators increasingly require transparency and explainability in AI-driven decision-making. 
Operational risks also arise from potential system failures, over-reliance on AI, and integration challenges with existing infrastructure.  
Disruptions in AI systems could impact critical functions such as fraud detection, transaction monitoring, and client support. Ethical and 
reputational risks, including unintended consequences or perceived unfairness in AI-driven decisions, may erode client trust and expose us to 
regulatory scrutiny. 
Mitigating these risks requires a robust governance framework, regularly testing and auditing of AI models, and strong human oversight.  
Investments in cybersecurity, data privacy protections, and employee training are critical to managing these risks. 
We are subject to certain risks in connection with our data management or aggregation. 
We are reliant on our ability to manage data and our ability to aggregate data in an accurate and timely manner to ensure effective risk 
reporting and management. Our ability to manage data and aggregate data may be limited by the effectiveness of our policies, programs, 
processes and practices that govern how data is acquired, validated, stored, protected and processed. While we regularly update our policies, 
programs, processes and practices, many of our data management and aggregation processes are manual and subject to human error or system 
failure. Failure to manage data effectively and to aggregate data in an accurate and timely manner may limit our ability to manage current and 
emerging risks, and to manage changing business needs. 
Table of Contents 
26 

Our business may be adversely affected by an increasing prevalence of fraud and other financial crimes. 
The Bank is susceptible to fraudulent activity that may be committed against us or our clients which may result in financial losses or increased 
costs to us or our clients, disclosure or misuse of our information or our client’s information, misappropriation of assets, privacy breaches 
against our clients, litigation or damage to our reputation. Such fraudulent activity may take many forms, including check fraud, electronic 
fraud, wire fraud, phishing, social engineering and other dishonest acts. Nationally, reported incidents of fraud and other financial crimes 
have increased. We have also experienced losses due to apparent fraud and other financial crimes. While we have policies and procedures 
designed to prevent such losses, there can be no assurance that such losses will not occur. 
Risks Related to Our Business and Industry Generally 
Ineffective liquidity management could adversely affect our financial results and condition. 
Effective liquidity management is essential to our business. We require sufficient liquidity to meet client loan requests, deposit maturities and 
withdrawals, payments on debt obligations, and other cash commitments under both normal operating conditions and unpredictable 
circumstances, including events causing industry or financial market stress. An inability to raise funds through deposits, borrowings, loan and 
investment security sales, or other sources could severely impact our liquidity. We rely on client deposits and, at times, borrowings from the 
FHLB of Des Moines and other wholesale funding sources to fund operations. Deposit flows and loan and mortgage-related security 
prepayments are strongly influenced by external factors, such as interest rate trends (both actual and perceived) and market competition.  
Changes to the FHLB of Des Moines’s lending policies or underwriting guidelines may limit our ability to borrow and adversely affect our 
liquidity. Although we have historically been able to replace maturing deposits and borrowings, future replacements may be challenging due 
to changes in our financial condition, the FHLB of Des Moines’s condition, or broader market disruptions. Our access to adequate funding 
could also be impaired by factors affecting us specifically or the financial industry generally, such as financial market disruptions, negative 
perceptions of the financial services sector, or deteriorating credit markets. Additional challenges to liquidity could arise from reduced 
business activity in our core markets, adverse regulatory actions, or negative operating results. Any significant decline in funding availability 
could impede our ability to originate loans, invest in securities, meet expenses, or fulfill obligations such as repaying borrowings and meeting 
deposit withdrawal demands, potentially resulting in a material adverse impact on our business, financial condition, and results of operations.  
Additionally, collateralized public funds (state and local municipal deposits secured by investment-grade securities) help reduce contingent 
liquidity risk by being less credit-sensitive, however, the pledging of collateral to secure these funds limits their availability as a reserve 
source of liquidity. While these deposits have historically provided stable funding, their availability depends on the fiscal policies and cash 
flow needs of individual municipalities. 
Benefits of strategic initiatives may not be realized. 
Our ability to compete depends on various factors, including our ability to develop and successfully execute strategic plans and initiatives.  
However, we may not achieve some or all of our strategic objectives. Expected cost savings and revenue growth from these initiatives may 
not materialize, and the costs of implementation may be greater than anticipated. Additionally, changes in economic conditions beyond our 
control, such as fluctuations in interest rates, may affect our ability to achieve our objectives. Failure to execute or achieve the anticipated 
outcomes of our strategic initiatives could negatively impact market perceptions of our company and impede our growth and profitability. 
Development of new products and services may impose additional costs on us and may expose us to increased operational risk. 
Our financial performance depends, in part, on our ability to develop and market innovative services and adopt new technologies that 
differentiate our products or create cost efficiencies while controlling related expenses. This reliance is heightened in the current “FinTech” 
environment, where financial institutions are heavily investing in emerging technologies, such as blockchain, and developing potentially 
industry-changing products, services, and standards. 
The introduction of new products and services requires significant time and resources, including obtaining regulatory approvals. It also 
entails substantial risks and uncertainties, such as meeting technical and control requirements, keeping pace with rapid technological 
advancements, accessing client information, and making significant ongoing investments to ensure timely market entry at competitive prices.  
Additionally, preparing marketing, sales, and other materials that accurately describe the products, services, and their risks is critical. 
Failure to manage these challenges increases the risk of operational lapses, which could result in financial liabilities. Factors such as 
regulatory and internal control requirements, capital demands, competitive alternatives, vendor relationships, and shifting market preferences 
also influence whether new initiatives can be successfully launched in a timely and appealing manner. If we fail to effectively address these 
risks in the development and implementation of new products or services, our business and reputation could suffer, potentially leading to a 
material adverse impact on our consolidated results of operations and financial condition. 
Table of Contents 
27 

We are dependent on key personnel and the loss of one or more of those key personnel may materially and adversely affect our 
prospects. 
Competition for qualified employees in the banking industry is intense, with a limited pool of candidates experienced in community banking.  
Our success relies on attracting and retaining skilled management, loan origination, finance, administrative, marketing, and technical 
personnel, as well as on the continued contributions of key executives, including our president, and other critical employees. Losing any of 
these individuals could result in a challenging transition period and negatively impact our operations. Additionally, the experience and client 
relationships of our banking facility managers are vital to maintaining strong connections with the communities we serve. The loss of these 
key personnel or directors nearing retirement without suitable replacements could adversely affect our business. 
We rely on other companies to provide key components of our business infrastructure. 
We rely on numerous external vendors to provide products and services necessary for our day-to-day operations. Accordingly, our operations 
are exposed to risks associated with vendor performance under service level agreements. If a vendor fails to meet its contractual obligations 
due to changes in its organizational structure, financial condition, support for existing products and services, strategic focus, or any other 
reason, our operations could be disrupted, potentially causing a material adverse impact on our financial condition and results of operations.  
Furthermore, we could be adversely affected if a vendor agreement is not renewed or is renewed on terms less favorable to us. Regulatory 
agencies also require financial institutions to remain accountable for all aspects of vendor performance, including activities delegated to third 
parties. Additionally, disruptions or failures in the physical infrastructure or operating systems supporting our business and clients, or cyber-
attacks or security breaches involving networks, systems, or devices used by our clients to access our services, could lead to client attrition, 
regulatory fines or penalties, reputational damage, reimbursement or compensation costs, and increased compliance expenses. Any of these 
outcomes could materially and adversely affect our financial condition and results of operations. 
Any inaccurate assumptions in our analytical and forecasting models could cause us to miscalculate our projected revenue or losses, 
which could adversely affect us. 
We use analytical and forecasting models to estimate the effects of economic conditions on our financial assets and liabilities including our 
mortgage servicing rights. Those models include assumptions about interest rates and consumer behavior that may be incorrect. If our model 
assumptions are incorrect, improperly applied or inadequate, we may record higher than expected losses or lower than expected revenues 
which could have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition and results of operations. 
Regulatory changes to Diversity, Equity and Inclusion (“DEI”) and Environmental, Social and Governance (“ESG”) practices may 
adversely impact our reputation, compliance costs, and business operations. 
In light of the recent executive order titled “Ending Illegal Discrimination and Restoring Merit-Based Opportunity” which revokes previous 
mandates promoting DEI and directs federal agencies to combat “illegal DEI” practices in the private sector, we must reassess our ESG 
strategies to ensure compliance with the evolving regulatory environment. The order signals a shift in federal oversight and enforcement 
priorities, potentially affecting internal policies, hiring practices, supplier diversity programs, and corporate governance frameworks. 
The executive order rescinds prior directives, such as Executive Order 11246, which required affirmative action and non-discriminatory 
practices by federal contractors. As a result, federal agencies may reevaluate existing contracts, scrutinize hiring and promotion policies, and 
take enforcement actions against companies perceived to be engaging in practices that do not align with the revised federal standards.  
Additionally, new guidance or rulemaking stemming from the executive order could impose restrictions on voluntary DEI initiatives, training 
programs, or supplier diversity efforts. These developments may necessitate changes to our internal policies, reporting obligations, and public 
disclosures, creating operational and compliance challenges. 
Failure to align our DEI and ESG efforts with the current legal framework could result in reputational damage, legal challenges, and adverse 
impacts on our operations. Government investigations, enforcement actions, or private litigation challenging our DEI- and ESG-related 
policies could lead to financial penalties, increased legal costs, and potential restrictions on our ability to engage in government contracting.  
Moreover, various private third-party organizations continue to evaluate companies based on ESG and DEI practices. Unfavorable ratings 
from these entities could influence investor decisions, limit access to capital, and generate negative sentiment among stakeholders. 
While the executive order aims to eliminate specific DEI programs, investors, customers, and other stakeholders may still expect transparency 
and commitment to broader ESG goals, including workforce diversity, community engagement, and responsible corporate governance.  
Companies that scale back DEI initiatives to comply with federal mandates may face backlash from institutional investors, advocacy groups, 
and employees who view such actions as a retreat from social responsibility commitments. Additionally, inconsistencies between federal and 
state-level DEI policies may create further complexities, as certain states continue to mandate affirmative action or corporate diversity 
disclosures.  Moreover, the rapid pace of change in legal frameworks, regulatory guidance and enforcement priorities resulting from the recent 
Presidential transition yields considerably increased uncertainty and compounds the difficulty of establishing and maintaining compliance. 
Table of Contents 
28 

Adapting to the recent regulatory changes is crucial to maintaining our reputation, ensuring operational continuity, and meeting stakeholder 
expectations in the evolving ESG landscape. Noncompliance or perceived noncompliance with the executive order and related regulatory 
guidance could expose us to increased regulatory scrutiny, litigation risks, and limitations on business opportunities. At the same time, 
misalignment with investor and stakeholder expectations regarding ESG and DEI commitments could impair our brand value, reduce 
employee engagement and retention, and negatively impact our stock performance. Given these factors, we must carefully assess and adjust 
our policies, disclosures, and risk mitigation strategies to navigate the shifting legal and business environment effectively. 
Risks Related to Holding Our Common Stock 
Our growth or future losses may require us to raise additional capital in the future, but that capital may not be available when it is 
needed or the cost of that capital may be exceedingly high. 
We are required by federal regulatory authorities to maintain adequate levels of capital to support our operations. We may at some point, 
however, need to raise additional capital to support continued growth or be required by our regulators to increase our capital resources. Any 
capital we obtain may result in the dilution of the interests of existing holders of our common stock. Our ability to raise additional capital, if 
needed, will depend on conditions in the capital markets at that time, which are outside our control, and on our financial condition and 
performance. Accordingly, we cannot make assurances that we will be able to raise additional capital if needed on terms that are acceptable 
to us, or at all. If we cannot raise additional capital when needed, our ability to further expand our operations could be materially impaired 
and our financial condition and liquidity could be materially and adversely affected. In addition, if we are unable to raise additional capital 
when required by our bank regulators, we may be subject to adverse regulatory action. 
We rely on dividends from the Bank for substantially all our revenue at the holding company level. 
We are an entity separate and distinct from our principal subsidiary, the Bank, and derive substantially all our revenue at the holding company 
level in the form of dividends from that subsidiary. Accordingly, we are, and will be, dependent upon dividends from the Bank to pay the 
principal of and interest on our indebtedness to satisfy our other cash needs and to pay dividends on our common stock. The Bank’s ability to 
pay dividends is subject to its ability to earn net income and to meet certain regulatory requirements. In the event the Bank is unable to pay 
dividends to us, we may not be able to pay dividends on our common stock at the same rate or at all. Also, our right to participate in a 
distribution of assets upon a subsidiary’s liquidation or reorganization is subject to the prior claims of the subsidiary’s creditors. 
Our articles of incorporation contain a provision which could limit the voting rights of a holder of our common stock. 
Our charter provides that any person or group who acquires beneficial ownership of our common stock in excess of 10% of the outstanding 
shares may not vote the excess shares. Accordingly, if a person acquires beneficial ownership of more than 10% of the outstanding shares of 
our common stock, that person’s voting rights with respect to our common stock will not be commensurate with their economic interest in our 
company. 
Anti-takeover provisions could negatively affect our shareholders. 
Provisions in our articles of incorporation and bylaws, the corporate laws of the state of Washington and federal laws and regulations could 
delay or prevent a third party from acquiring us, despite the possible benefit to our shareholders, or otherwise negatively affect the market 
value of our stock. These provisions, among others, include restrictions on voting shares of our common stock beneficially owned in excess 
of 10% of total shares outstanding; and advance notice requirements for nominations for election to our Board of Directors and for proposing 
matters that shareholders may act on at shareholder meetings. In addition, although we are in the process of transitioning from staggered 
three-year terms for directors to a declassified board structure in which each director will be elected for a one-year term, this transition is not 
complete. The partially staggered-terms structure will continue to serve as a relevant anti-takeover provision until the transition to a 
declassified board structure. Our articles of incorporation also authorize our Board of Directors to issue preferred or other stock, and 
preferred or other stock could be issued as a defensive measure in response to a takeover proposal.  In addition, because we are a bank holding 
company, the ability of a third party to acquire us is limited by applicable banking laws and regulations. The Bank Holding Company Act 
requires any bank holding company to obtain the approval of the Federal Reserve before acquiring 5% or more of any class of our voting 
securities. Any entity that is a holder of 25% or more of any class of our voting securities, or in some circumstances a holder of a lesser 
percentage, is subject to regulation as a bank holding company under the Bank Holding Company Act. Under the Change in Bank Control 
Act of 1978, as amended, any person (or persons acting in concert), other than a bank holding company, is required to notify the Federal 
Reserve before acquiring 10% or more of any class of our voting securities. 
Item 1B – Unresolved Staff Comments 
None. 
Table of Contents 
29 

Item 1C – Cybersecurity 
Risk Management and Strategy 
Our cybersecurity risk management and strategy are integrated into our enterprise-wide risk management program, leveraging a “three lines 
of defense” model to manage risk within the organization. Technology risk (including cybersecurity risk) is considered to be a key risk area 
for the Company, with Management measuring inherent risk, mitigating controls, and residual risk on a quarterly basis. 
The ability to mitigate cybersecurity risks depends on an effective risk assessment process that identifies, measures, controls, and monitors 
material risks from cybersecurity threats. 
These threats include any potential unauthorized activities that could compromise the 
confidentiality, integrity, or availability of the Company’s information systems and data. Our Information Security Program includes a 
comprehensive information security risk assessment process that incorporates the following elements: 
• 
Identifying threats, measuring risk, defining information security requirements, and implementing controls to reduce risk. 
• 
Identifying reasonably foreseeable internal and external threats that may lead to unauthorized disclosure, misuse, alteration, or 
destruction of sensitive information or information systems. 
• 
Assessing the likelihood and potential damage posed by these threats, considering the degree of information sensitivity and the 
Company’s operations, inclusive of substantive changes to people, processes and technology. 
• 
Aligning the Information Security Program with the Company’s enterprise-wide risk management program, which identifies, 
measures, mitigates, and monitors risk. 
• 
Evaluating the adequacy of policies, procedures, information systems, and other arrangements designed to control identified risks, 
considering the Company’s operations, inclusive of substantive changes to people, processes and technology. 
• 
Conducting internal and third-party security assessments, including penetration testing. 
• 
Overseeing third-party vendor risk through due diligence and monitoring. 
The risk assessment process is designed to identify assets requiring risk reduction strategies and includes an evaluation of the key factors 
applicable to the operation. The Company conducts a variety of information security assessments throughout the year, both internally and 
through third-party specialists. 
In designing our Information Security Program, we refer to established industry frameworks – in particular, the Federal Financial Institutions 
Examination Council (FFIEC) and guidance from the International Organization for Standardization (ISO). The FFIEC framework offers a 
set of guidelines to help financial institutions effectively manage and mitigate cybersecurity risks. ISO/IEC 27001 is an international standard 
developed by the ISO specifically for Information Security, Cybersecurity and Privacy Protection (ISCPP). These frameworks provide best 
practices for managing cybersecurity risks and ensuring information security, and we consider them to be aspirational benchmarks to help 
inform the design of our Information Security Program. While our program is designed to be robust, the sophistication and evolving nature of 
cyber threats mean no system can fully eliminate risk. For more information on how cybersecurity risk may affect the Company’s business 
strategy, results of operations or financial condition, please refer to Item 1A, Risk Factors — Risks Related to Cybersecurity, Data and Fraud. 
The Company uses a cross-functional approach to identify, prevent, and mitigate cybersecurity threats and incidents. We have established 
procedures for the timely escalation and, when required, disclosure of cybersecurity incidents, supported by a formal incident response plan 
that outlines the steps the Company will take to respond to a cybersecurity incident. While cybersecurity risks could materially affect the 
Company, past incidents have not materially affected our business strategy, results of operations or financial condition. For further details on 
potential cybersecurity risks, see Item 1A, Risk Factors — Risks Related to Cybersecurity, Data and Fraud. 
Governance 
Our Board of Directors annually reviews and approves the Company’s Risk Appetite Statement, which defines key risk categories and 
associated metrics that are monitored quarterly by Management and reported to the Risk Committee. Management measures and reports 
inherent risk, mitigating controls, and residual risk for each key risk category and identifies and regularly discusses emerging risks with the 
Risk Committee. 
The Company’s governance and oversight of cybersecurity risks are facilitated through our Information Security Program, which establishes 
administrative, technical, and physical safeguards designed to protect sensitive information in accordance with FDIC and FFIEC regulations.  
The program is tailored to align with the Company’s size, complexity and operational scope. 
Cybersecurity risk management is led by our Chief Information Officer (CIO) and Chief Information Security Officer (CISO), supported by 
our information technology and information security teams. The Bank’s Chief Information Officer (CIO) provides direction and oversight for 
information technology and security across the Company, including existing and emerging initiatives. In this role, she leverages more than 26 
years of information technology experience. The Bank’s Chief Information Security Officer (CISO) has been with the Company for more 
than 13 years and has maintained various applicable cybersecurity and IT audit certifications. Prior to joining the Bank, he worked for a 
Fortune 500 company and had 15 years of information technology experience working in networking, information security and information 
technology auditing. 
Table of Contents 
30 

Our Information Technology (IT) Management team is responsible for conducting risk assessments, designing the Information Security 
Program, overseeing service provider arrangements, establishing risk-based response programs for incidents involving unauthorized data 
access, providing staff training, conducting testing of key controls, systems, and procedures, and adjusting the program to reflect changes in 
people, processes, technology, sensitive information, threats, and the business environment (e.g., mergers, acquisitions, alliances, joint 
ventures, or outsourcing arrangements). 
Our IT Management team reports annually to the Risk Committee on the status of the Information Security Program, including risk 
assessment, risk management and control decisions, service provider arrangements, results of independent testing, cybersecurity incidents and 
recommendations for improvements.  Quarterly status updates are also provided to the Risk Committee. 
The Board of Directors plays a crucial role, annually reviewing and approving our Information Security Program. The Board oversees efforts 
to develop, implement, and maintain an effective Information Security Program, including reviewing Management’s reporting on program 
effectiveness. The Board of Directors’ Corporate Governance/Nominating Committee considers IT and cybersecurity expertise when 
assessing potential director candidates to help ensure effective oversight by the Board of Directors. 
We maintain a Cybersecurity Incident Response Team (CIRT) to handle technical aspects of the Company’s response to cybersecurity events 
and an Executive Cybersecurity Event Evaluation Team (ECEET) to assess potential business impacts and disclosure requirements related to 
cybersecurity events. Both teams may engage cybersecurity legal counsel and other external experts in connection with their respective 
activities. An escalation process facilitates updates to internal governance groups, including the Company’s Disclosure Committee and/or the 
Board of Directors’ Audit Committee, each of which also receives a quarterly report from the ECEET chair. 
Item 2 – Properties 
Banner maintains its administrative offices and main branch office, which is owned by us, in Walla Walla, Washington. As of December 31, 
2024, we have 135 branch offices located in Washington, Oregon, California, and Idaho. Geographically, we have 65 branches located in 
Washington, 31 in Oregon, 30 in California and 9 in Idaho. Of these branch locations, approximately 59% are owned and 41% are leased 
facilities. In addition to the branch network, we also operate 13 loan production offices, seven of which are located in Washington, three in 
California, and one in each state of Oregon, Idaho and Utah. All loan production offices are leased facilities. The lease terms for our branch 
and loan production offices are not individually material. Lease expirations range from 4 months to 14 years. Administrative support offices 
are primarily in Washington, where we have eight facilities, of which we own two and lease six. Additionally, we have two leased 
administrative support offices in Idaho and three administrative support offices in Oregon, two owned and one leased. In the opinion of 
Management, all properties are adequately covered by insurance, are in a good state of repair and are appropriately designed for their present 
and future use. 
Item 3 – Legal Proceedings 
In the normal course of our business, we have various legal proceedings and other contingent matters pending. These proceedings and the 
associated legal claims are often contested and the outcome of individual matters is not always predictable. Furthermore, in some matters, it 
is difficult to assess potential exposure because the legal proceeding is still in the pretrial stage. These claims and counter claims typically 
arise during the course of collection efforts on problem loans or with respect to actions to enforce liens on properties in which we hold a 
security interest, although we also are subject to claims related to employment matters. Claims related to employment matters may include, 
but are not limited to, claims by our employees of discrimination, harassment, violations of wage and hour requirements, or violations of other 
federal, state, or local laws and claims of misconduct or negligence on the part of our employees. Some or all of these claims may lead to 
litigation, including class action litigation, and these matters may cause us to incur negative publicity with respect to alleged claims. Our 
insurance may not cover all claims that may be asserted against us, and any claims asserted against us, regardless of merit or eventual 
outcome, may harm our reputation. Should the ultimate judgments or settlements in any litigation exceed our insurance coverage, they could 
have a material adverse effect on our financial condition and results of operation for any period. The ultimate outcome of these legal 
proceedings could be more or less than what we have accrued. We are not a party to any pending legal proceedings that we believe would 
have a material adverse effect on our financial condition, operations or cash flows, except as set forth below. 
As disclosed previously, a class and collective action lawsuit, Bolding et al. v. Banner Bank, US Dist. Ct., WD WA., was filed against Banner 
Bank on April 17, 2017. On February 22, 2024, the Court entered a written order granting final approval of a settlement agreement that 
resolved this lawsuit. The Bank submitted its final settlement payment during the third quarter of 2024 and does not anticipate any further 
funding obligations in connection with this lawsuit. 
Item 4 – Mine Safety Disclosures 
Not applicable. 
Table of Contents 
31 

PART II 
Item 5 – Market for Registrant’s Common Equity, Related Stockholder Matters and Issuer Purchases of Equity Securities 
Market Information and Holders 
Our voting common stock is principally traded on the NASDAQ Global Select Market under the symbol “BANR.” Shareholders of record as 
of December 31, 2024 totaled 1,670 based upon securities position listings furnished to us by our transfer agent.  This total does not reflect the 
number of persons or entities who hold stock in nominee or “street” name through various brokerage firms. 
Dividends 
Banner has historically paid cash dividends to its common shareholders. Payments of future cash dividends, if any, will be at the discretion of 
our Board of Directors after taking into account various factors, including our business, operating results and financial condition, capital 
requirements, current and anticipated cash needs, plans for expansion, any legal or contractual limitation on our ability to pay dividends and 
other relevant factors including required payments on our junior subordinated debentures. No assurances can be given that any dividends will 
be paid or that, if paid, will not be reduced or eliminated in future periods. Dividends on common stock from Banner depend substantially 
upon receipt of dividends from the Bank, which is the Company’s predominant source of income. Management’s projections show an 
expectation that cash dividends will continue for the foreseeable future. 
Purchases of Equity Securities by the Issuer and Affiliated Purchasers 
The following table provides information about repurchases of common stock by the Company during the quarter ended December 31, 2024: 
Period 
Total Number of 
Common Shares 
Purchased(1) 
Average Price 
Paid per 
Common 
Share 
Total Number of 
Shares Purchased 
as Part of Publicly 
Announced Plan 
Maximum Number of 
Shares that May Yet be 
Purchased as Part of 
Publicly Announced 
Plan(2) 
October 1, 2024 - October 31, 2024 
875 $ 
64.61 
— 
1,722,787 
November 1, 2024 - November 30, 2024 
148 
66.66 
— 
1,722,787 
December 1, 2024 - December 31, 2024 
171 
74.86 
— 
1,722,787 
Total for quarter 
1,194 $ 
66.33 
— 
(1) 
All shares reported in this column were surrendered by employees to satisfy tax withholding obligations upon the vesting of restricted 
stock grants in the fourth quarter of 2024, and were not repurchased as part of any publicly announced stock repurchase plan or 
program. Restricted shares canceled to pay withholding taxes totaled 46,437 and 61,724 during the years ended December 31, 2024 
and 2023, respectively. 
(2) 
On July 25, 2024, the Company announced that its Board of Directors had authorized repurchases of up to 1,722,787 shares of the 
Company’s common stock (approximately 5% of the Company’s outstanding shares) over the next 12 months. 
Under the 
authorization, shares may be repurchased by the Company in open market purchases. The extent to which the Company repurchases 
its shares and the timing of such repurchases will depend upon market conditions and other corporate considerations. 
Equity Compensation Plan Information 
The equity compensation plan information presented under subparagraph (d) in Part III, Item 12 of this Form 10-K is incorporated herein by 
reference. 
Table of Contents 
32 

Performance Graph 
The following graph compares the cumulative total shareholder return on Banner common stock with the cumulative total return on the 
NASDAQ (U.S. Stock) Index, a peer group of the KBW Regional Bank Index and the S&P 500. Total return assumes the reinvestment of all 
dividends. 
Year Ended 
Index Value 
Total Return Performance 
Banner Corporation 
NASDAQ Composite 
KBW Regional Bank Index 
S&P 500 
12/31/19 
12/31/20 
12/31/21 
12/31/22 
12/31/23 
12/31/24 
50 
100 
150 
200 
250 
Year Ended* 
Index 
12/31/19 
12/31/20 
12/31/21 
12/31/22 
12/31/23 
12/31/24 
Banner Corporation 
$ 
100.00 
$ 
87.46 
$ 
117.43 
$ 
125.86 
$ 
110.82 
$ 
143.48 
NASDAQ Composite 
100.00 
144.92 
177.06 
119.45 
172.77 
223.86 
KBW Regional Bank Index 
100.00 
91.32 
124.78 
116.15 
115.69 
130.96 
S&P 500 
100.00 
118.40 
152.39 
124.79 
157.59 
197.02 
*Assumes $100 invested in Banner Corporation common stock and each index at the close of business on December 31, 2019 and that all 
dividends were reinvested.  Information for the graph was provided by Bloomberg LP. 
Item 6 - Reserved 
Table of Contents 
33 

Item 7 – Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations 
Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations is intended to assist in understanding our financial 
condition and results of operations. The information contained in this section should be read in conjunction with the Consolidated Financial 
Statements and accompanying Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements contained in Item IV of this Form 10-K. 
Executive Overview 
Banner’s successful execution of its super community bank model and strategic initiatives has delivered solid core operating results and 
profitability over the last several years. The Company’s longer term strategic initiatives continue to focus on originating high-quality assets 
and client acquisition, which we believe will continue to generate strong revenue while maintaining the Company’s moderate risk profile. We 
strive to uphold our core values, which are to do the right thing for our clients, communities, colleagues, company and shareholders; and to 
provide consistent and reliable strength through all economic cycles and change events. 
2024 Financial Highlights 
• 
Revenues were $608.6 million for the year ended December 31, 2024, compared to $620.4 million for the prior year. 
• 
Adjusted revenue* (the total of net interest income and total non-interest income adjusted for the net gain or loss on the sale of 
securities and the net change in valuation of financial instruments) was $614.8 million or the year ended December 31, 2024, 
compared to $643.9 million for the prior year. 
• 
Net income of $168.9 million, or $4.88 per diluted share, for the year ended December 31, 2024, compared to net income of $183.6 
million, or $5.33 per diluted share for the prior year. 
• 
Net interest income was $541.7 million for the year ended December 31, 2024, compared to $576.0 million for the prior year.  
• 
Net interest margin, on a tax equivalent basis, was 3.75% compared to 4.01% in the prior year.  
• 
Mortgage banking revenue was $12.2 million for the year ended December 31, 2024, compared to $11.8 million in the prior year. 
• 
Income from deposit fees and other service charges was $43.4 million for the year ended December 31, 2024, compared to $41.6 
million for the prior year.  
• 
Non-interest expense was $391.5 million for the year ended December 31, 2024, compared to $382.5 million for the prior year. 
• 
Return on average assets was 1.07% for year ended December 31, 2024, compared to 1.18% for the prior year. 
• 
Efficiency ratio was 64.33%, compared to 61.66% in the prior year. 
• 
Net loans receivable increased 5% to $11.20 billion at December 31, 2024, compared to $10.66 billion a year ago. 
• 
Non-performing assets were $39.6 million, or 0.24% of total assets, at December 31, 2024, compared to $30.1 million, or 0.19% of 
total assets, a year ago. 
• 
The allowance for credit losses - loans was $155.5 million, or 1.37% of total loans receivable, at December 31, 2024, compared to 
$149.6 million, or 1.38% of total loans receivable a year ago. 
• 
Total deposits were $13.51 billion at December 31, 2024, compared to $13.03 billion a year ago. 
• 
Core deposits represented 89% of total deposits at December 31, 2024. 
• 
Cash dividends paid to shareholders were $1.92 per share, consistent with the prior year. 
• 
Common shareholders’ equity per share increased to $51.49 at December 31, 2024, compared to $48.12 a year ago. 
• 
Tangible common shareholders’ equity per share* decreased 1% to $40.57 at December 31, 2024, compared to $37.09 a year ago. 
* Represents a non-GAAP financial measure. For a reconciliation of the non-GAAP financial measure to the most directly comparable 
GAAP financial measure, see “Non-GAAP Financial Measures” below. 
Table of Contents 
34 

Selected Financial Data: The following condensed consolidated statements of financial condition and operations and selected performance 
ratios as of December 31, 2024, 2023 and 2022, and for the years then ended have been derived from our audited consolidated financial 
statements. 
FINANCIAL CONDITION DATA: 
December 31 
(In thousands, except shares) 
2024 
2023 
2022 
Total assets 
$ 16,200,037 
$ 15,670,391 
$ 15,833,431 
Cash and securities (1) 
3,607,933 
3,687,302 
4,178,375 
Loans receivable, net 
11,199,135 
10,660,812 
10,005,259 
Deposits 
13,514,398 
13,029,497 
13,620,059 
Borrowings 
563,012 
665,141 
456,603 
Total shareholders’ equity 
1,774,326 
1,652,691 
1,456,432 
Shares outstanding 
34,459,832 
34,348,369 
34,194,018 
OPERATING DATA: 
For the Year Ended December 31 
(In thousands) 
2024 
2023 
2022 
Interest income 
$ 
766,103 
$ 
701,572 
$ 
572,569 
Interest expense 
224,387 
125,567 
19,390 
Net interest income 
541,716 
576,005 
553,179 
Provision for credit losses 
7,581 
10,789 
10,364 
Net interest income after provision for credit losses 
534,135 
565,216 
542,815 
Deposit fees and other service charges 
43,371 
41,638 
44,459 
Mortgage banking operations revenue 
12,207 
11,817 
10,834 
Net loss on sale of securities 
(5,190) 
(19,242) 
(3,248) 
Net change in valuation of financial instruments carried at fair value 
(982) 
(4,218) 
807 
All other non-interest income 
17,482 
14,414 
22,403 
Total non-interest income 
66,888 
44,409 
75,255 
Salary and employee benefits 
250,555 
244,563 
242,266 
All other non-interest expenses 
140,983 
137,975 
135,029 
Total non-interest expense 
391,538 
382,538 
377,295 
Income before provision for income tax expense 
209,485 
227,087 
240,775 
Provision for income tax expense 
40,587 
43,463 
45,397 
Net income 
$ 
168,898 
$ 
183,624 
$ 
195,378 
PER COMMON SHARE DATA: 
At or For the Years Ended December 31 
2024 
2023 
2022 
Net income: 
Basic 
$ 
4.90 
$ 
5.35 
$ 
5.70 
Diluted 
4.88 
5.33 
5.67 
Diluted adjusted earnings per share (10) 
5.01 
5.88 
5.69 
Common shareholders’ equity per share (2) 
51.49 
48.12 
42.59 
Common shareholders’ tangible equity per share (2)(10) 
40.57 
37.09 
31.41 
Cash dividends 
1.92 
1.92 
1.76 
Dividend payout ratio (basic) 
39.18 % 
35.89 % 
30.88 % 
Dividend payout ratio (diluted) 
39.34 % 
36.02 % 
31.04 % 
Table of Contents 
35 

OTHER DATA: 
As of December 31, 
2024 
2023 
2022 
Full-time equivalent employees 
1,956 
1,966 
1,931 
Number of branches 
135 
135 
137 
KEY FINANCIAL RATIOS: 
At or For the Years Ended December 31 
2024 
2023 
2022 
Performance Ratios: 
Return on average assets (3) 
1.07 % 
1.18 % 
1.18 % 
Adjusted return on average assets (4) (10) 
1.10 
1.30 
1.19 
Return on average common equity (5) 
9.91 
11.94 
12.79 
Adjusted return on average equity (6) (10) 
10.19 
13.17 
12.83 
Average common equity to average assets 
10.80 
9.88 
9.26 
Net interest margin (tax equivalent) (7) 
3.75 
4.01 
3.68 
Non-interest income to average assets 
0.42 
0.29 
0.46 
Non-interest expense to average assets 
2.48 
2.46 
2.29 
Efficiency ratio (8) 
64.33 
61.66 
60.04 
Adjusted efficiency ratio (10) 
62.29 
57.89 
57.99 
Average interest-earning assets to funding liabilities 
107.60 
106.67 
104.16 
Loans to deposits ratio 
84.26 
83.05 
74.92 
Selected Financial Ratios: 
Allowance for credit losses - loans as a percent of total loans at end of period 
1.37 
1.38 
1.39 
Net (charge-offs)/recoveries as a percent of average outstanding loans during the period 
(0.02) 
(0.03) 
0.01 
Non-performing assets as a percent of total assets 
0.24 
0.19 
0.15 
Allowance for credit losses - loans as a percent of non-performing loans (9) 
420.83 
505.52 
615.25 
Common shareholders’ equity to total assets 
10.95 
10.55 
9.20 
Common shareholders’ tangible equity to tangible assets (10) 
8.84 
8.33 
6.95 
Consolidated Capital Ratios: 
Total capital to risk-weighted assets 
15.04 
14.58 
14.04 
Tier 1 capital to risk-weighted assets 
13.08 
12.64 
12.13 
Tier 1 capital to average leverage assets 
11.05 
10.56 
9.45 
Common equity tier I capital to risk-weighted assets 
12.44 
11.97 
11.44 
(1) 
Includes available-for-sale and held-to-maturity securities. 
(2) 
Calculated using shares outstanding. 
(3) 
Net income divided by average assets. 
(4) 
Adjusted earnings (non-GAAP) divided by average assets. 
(5) 
Net income divided by average common equity. 
(6) 
Adjusted earnings (non-GAAP) divided by average equity. 
(7) 
Net interest income as a percent of average interest-earning assets on a tax equivalent basis. 
(8) 
Non-interest expenses divided by the total of net interest income and non-interest income. 
(9) 
Non-performing loans consist of nonaccrual and 90 days past due loans still accruing interest. 
(10) Represents a non-GAAP financial measure. For a reconciliation of the non-GAAP financial measures to the most directly comparable 
GAAP financial measure, see, “Non-GAAP Financial Measures” below. 
Non-GAAP Financial Measures 
Management has presented non-GAAP financial measures in this discussion and analysis because it believes that they provide useful and 
comparative information to assess trends in our core operations and to facilitate the comparison of our performance with the performance of 
our peers. However, these non-GAAP financial measures are supplemental and are not a substitute for any analysis based on GAAP. Where 
applicable, we have also presented comparable earnings information using GAAP financial measures. For a reconciliation of these non-
GAAP financial measures, see the tables below. Because not all companies use the same calculations, our presentation may not be 
comparable to other similarly titled measures as calculated by other companies. 
Table of Contents 
36 

Adjusted revenue, diluted adjusted earnings per share and adjusted efficiency ratio are non-GAAP financial measures. To calculate the 
adjusted revenue, diluted adjusted earnings per share and adjusted efficiency ratio, we make adjustments to our GAAP revenues and expenses 
as reported on our Consolidated Statements of Operations. 
Management believes that these non-GAAP financial measures provide 
information to investors that is useful in evaluating the operating performance and trends of financial services companies, including the 
Company. The following tables set forth reconciliations of these non-GAAP financial measures (dollars in thousands, except share and per 
share data): 
For the Years Ended December 31 
2024 
2023 
2022 
ADJUSTED REVENUE: 
Net interest income (GAAP) 
$ 
541,716 
$ 
576,005 
$ 
553,179 
Non-interest income (GAAP) 
66,888 
44,409 
75,255 
Total revenue (GAAP) 
608,604 
620,414 
628,434 
Exclude:  Net loss on sale of securities 
5,190 
19,242 
3,248 
Net change in valuation of financial instruments carried at fair value 
982 
4,218 
(807) 
Gain on sale of branches 
— 
— 
(7,804) 
Adjusted revenue (non-GAAP) 
$ 
614,776 
$ 
643,874 
$ 
623,071 
ADJUSTED EARNINGS: 
Net income (GAAP) 
$ 
168,898 
$ 
183,624 
$ 
195,378 
Exclude:  Net loss on sale of securities 
5,190 
19,242 
3,248 
Net change in valuation of financial instruments carried at fair value 
982 
4,218 
(807) 
Gain on sale of branches 
— 
— 
(7,804) 
Banner Forward expenses (1) 
— 
1,334 
5,293 
Loss on extinguishment of debt 
— 
— 
793 
Related tax benefit 
(1,481) 
(5,951) 
(174) 
Total adjusted earnings (non-GAAP) 
$ 
173,589 
$ 
202,467 
$ 
195,927 
Diluted earnings per share (GAAP) 
$ 
4.88 
$ 
5.33 
$ 
5.67 
Diluted adjusted earnings per share (non-GAAP) 
$ 
5.01 
$ 
5.88 
$ 
5.69 
For the Years Ended December 31 
ADJUSTED EFFICIENCY RATIO: 
2024 
2023 
2022 
Non-interest expense (GAAP) 
$ 
391,538 
$ 
382,538 
$ 
377,295 
Exclude:  Banner Forward expenses (1) 
— 
(1,334) 
(5,293) 
CDI amortization 
(2,626) 
(3,756) 
(5,279) 
State/municipal tax expense 
(5,648) 
(5,260) 
(4,693) 
REO operations 
(293) 
538 
104 
Loss on extinguishment of debt 
— 
— 
(793) 
Adjusted non-interest expense (non-GAAP) 
$ 
382,971 
$ 
372,726 
$ 
361,341 
Net interest income (GAAP) 
$ 
541,716 
$ 
576,005 
$ 
553,179 
Non-interest income (GAAP) 
66,888 
44,409 
75,255 
Total revenue (GAAP) 
608,604 
620,414 
628,434 
Exclude:  Net loss on sale of securities 
5,190 
19,242 
3,248 
Net change in valuation of financial instruments carried at fair value 
982 
4,218 
(807) 
Gain on sale of branches 
— 
— 
(7,804) 
Adjusted revenue (non-GAAP) 
$ 
614,776 
$ 
643,874 
$ 
623,071 
Efficiency ratio (GAAP) 
64.33 % 
61.66 % 
60.04 % 
Adjusted efficiency ratio (non-GAAP) 
62.29 % 
57.89 % 
57.99 % 
(1) 
Included in miscellaneous expenses in the Consolidated Statement of Operations. 
Table of Contents 
37 

The ratio of tangible common shareholders’ equity to tangible assets is a non-GAAP financial measure. We calculate tangible common 
equity by excluding goodwill and other intangible assets from shareholders’ equity. We calculate tangible assets by excluding the balance of 
goodwill and other intangible assets from total assets. We believe this is consistent with the treatment by our bank regulatory agencies, which 
exclude goodwill and other intangible assets from the calculation of risk-based capital ratios. The following table sets forth the reconciliation 
of tangible equity and tangible assets (dollars in thousands, except share and per share data). 
December 31 
2024 
2023 
2022 
Shareholders’ equity (GAAP) 
$ 1,774,326 
$ 1,652,691 
$ 1,456,432 
Exclude goodwill and other intangible assets, net 
376,179 
378,805 
382,561 
Common shareholders’ tangible equity (non-GAAP) 
$ 1,398,147 
$ 1,273,886 
$ 1,073,871 
Total assets (GAAP) 
$ 16,200,037 
$ 15,670,391 
$ 15,833,431 
Exclude goodwill and other intangible assets, net 
376,179 
378,805 
382,561 
Total tangible assets (non-GAAP) 
$ 15,823,858 
$ 15,291,586 
$ 15,450,870 
Common shareholders’ equity to total assets (GAAP) 
10.95 % 
10.55 % 
9.20 % 
Common shareholders’ tangible equity to tangible assets (non-GAAP) 
8.84 % 
8.33 % 
6.95 % 
Common shares outstanding 
34,459,832 
34,348,369 
34,194,018 
Common shareholders’ equity (book value) per share (GAAP) 
$ 
51.49 
$ 
48.12 
$ 
42.59 
Common shareholders’ tangible equity (tangible book value) per share (non-GAAP) 
$ 
40.57 
$ 
37.09 
$ 
31.41 
Critical Accounting Estimates 
The preparation of financial statements in conformity with GAAP requires Management to make estimates, assumptions and judgments that 
affect amounts reported in the consolidated financial statements. These estimates, assumptions, and judgments are based on information 
available as of the date of the financial statements; accordingly, as this information changes, actual results could differ from the estimates, 
assumptions, and judgments reflected in the financial statements. Management believes the following estimates require difficult, subjective 
or complex judgments and, therefore, Management considers the following to be critical accounting estimates. 
Allowance for Credit Losses: The allowance for credit losses reflects Management’s evaluation of our loans and their estimated loss 
potential, as well as the risk inherent in various components of the portfolio. Significant judgment and assumptions are applied in estimating 
the allowance for credit losses. These judgments, assumptions and estimates are susceptible to significant changes based on the current 
environment. Among the material estimates required to establish the allowance for credit losses are a reasonable and supportable forecast; a 
reasonable and supportable forecast period and the reversion period; value of collateral; strength of guarantors; the amount and timing of 
future cash flows for loans individually evaluated; and determination of the qualitative loss factors. 
Management estimates the allowance for credit losses using relevant information, from internal and external sources, relating to past events, 
current conditions, and reasonable and supportable forecasts. The allowance for credit losses is maintained at a level sufficient to provide for 
expected credit losses over the life of the asset based on evaluating historical credit loss experience and making adjustments to historical loss 
information for differences in the specific risk characteristics in the current portfolio. These factors include, among others, changes in the size 
and composition of the portfolio, differences in underwriting standards, delinquency rates, actual loss experience and current economic 
conditions. 
Management considers various economic scenarios and forecasts to arrive at the estimate that most reflects Management’s expectations of 
future conditions. As of December 31, 2024, Management used a baseline forecast to estimate the allowance for credit losses. The selection 
of a more optimistic or pessimistic economic forecast would result in a lower or higher allowance for credit losses. While there are multiple 
economic forecast scenarios available, the use of a protracted slump economic forecast would have increased the allowance for credit losses - 
loans by approximately 11% as of December 31, 2024, where the use of a stronger near-term growth economic forecast would have resulted 
in a negligible decrease in the allowance for credit losses - loans as of December 31, 2024. 
Management uses a scale to assign qualitative and environmental (QE) factor adjustments based on the level of estimated impact which 
requires a significant amount of judgment. Some QE factors impact all loan segments equally while others may impact some loan segments 
more or less than others. If Management’s judgment was different for a QE factor that impacts all loan segments equally, a five basis-point 
change in this QE factor would increase or decrease the allowance for credit losses by 3.7% as of December 31, 2024. 
Table of Contents 
38 

Fair Value Accounting and Measurement: We use fair value measurements to record certain financial assets and liabilities at their estimated 
fair value. A hierarchical disclosure framework associated with the level of pricing observability is utilized in measuring financial 
instruments at fair value. The degree of judgment utilized in measuring the fair value of financial instruments generally correlates to the level 
of pricing observability. Financial instruments with readily available active quoted prices or for which fair value can be measured from 
actively quoted prices generally will have a higher degree of pricing observability and a lesser degree of judgment utilized in measuring fair 
value. Conversely, financial instruments rarely traded or not quoted will generally have little or no pricing observability and a higher degree 
of judgment utilized in measuring fair value. Determining the fair value of financial instruments with unobservable inputs requires a 
significant amount of judgment. This includes the discount rate used to fair value our trust preferred securities and junior subordinated 
debentures. A 25 basis-point increase or decrease in the discount rate used to calculate the fair value of our trust preferred securities would 
result in a $514,000 decrease or increase in the reported fair value as of December 31, 2024, with an offsetting adjustment to our accumulated 
other comprehensive income. A 25 basis-point increase or decrease in the discount rate used to calculate the fair value of our junior 
subordinated debentures would result in a $1.3 million decrease or increase in the reported fair value as of December 31, 2024, with an 
offsetting adjustment to our accumulated other comprehensive income. 
Comparison of Financial Condition at December 31, 2024 and 2023 
General.  Total assets increased to $16.20 billion at December 31, 2024, compared to $15.67 billion at December 31, 2023. The increase in 
assets was primarily due to loan growth and an increase in interest-bearing deposits, partially offset by the decrease in the securities portfolio 
in 2024. 
Total loans receivable (gross loans less deferred fees and discounts and excluding loans held for sale) increased $544.2 million, or 5%, to 
$11.35 billion at December 31, 2024, from $10.81 billion at December 31, 2023. The increase in total loans receivable primarily reflects 
growth in multifamily real estate, commercial business, commercial real estate and one- to four-family residential loan balances. 
The aggregate of securities and interest-bearing deposits decreased $73.1 million, or 2%, to $3.40 billion at December 31, 2024, compared to 
$3.48 billion a year earlier, primarily due to a decrease in securities, partially offset by an increase in interest-bearing deposits. Securities 
decreased to $3.11 billion at December 31, 2024, from $3.43 billion at December 31, 2023, primarily due to normal security portfolio cash 
flows. Fair value adjustments for securities designated as available-for-sale reflected a decrease of $5.0 million for the year ended 
December 31, 2024, which was included net of the associated tax benefit as a component of other comprehensive income. The average 
effective duration of our securities portfolio was approximately 6.6 years at December 31, 2024, compared to 6.5 years at December 31, 2023. 
Deposits increased $484.9 million, or 4%, to $13.51 billion at December 31, 2024, from $13.03 billion at December 31, 2023, with core 
deposits increasing $462.7 million and certificates of deposit increasing $22.2 million. The increase in core deposits reflects increases in 
interest-bearing transaction and savings accounts. Core deposits were 89% of total deposits at both December 31, 2024 and 2023. Non-
interest-bearing deposits decreased by $200.8 million, or 4%, to $4.59 billion from $4.79 billion at December 31, 2023, while interest-bearing 
transaction and savings accounts increased by $663.5 million, or 10%, to $7.42 billion at December 31, 2024, from $6.76 billion at 
December 31, 2023. Certificates of deposit increased $22.2 million, or 2%, to $1.50 billion at December 31, 2024, from $1.48 billion at 
December 31, 2023, primarily due to clients moving funds from core deposit accounts to higher yielding certificates of deposit, partially 
offset by a $57.7 million decrease in brokered deposits. We had $50.3 million of brokered deposits at December 31, 2024, compared to 
$108.1 million at December 31, 2023. 
We had $290.0 million and $323.0 million of FHLB advances at December 31, 2024 and 2023, respectively. Other borrowings, consisting of 
retail repurchase agreements primarily related to client cash management accounts, decreased $57.6 million to $125.3 million at 
December 31, 2024, compared to $182.9 million at December 31, 2023. 
Junior subordinated debentures totaled $67.5 million at 
December 31, 2024, compared to $66.4 million at December 31, 2023. Subordinated notes, net of issuance costs, were $80.3 million at 
December 31, 2024, compared to $92.9 million at December 31, 2023. The decrease was due to the Bank’s purchase of $13.0 million of 
Banner’s outstanding subordinated debt during 2024. 
Total shareholders’ equity increased $121.6 million, to $1.77 billion at December 31, 2024, compared to $1.65 billion at December 31, 2023.  
The increase in shareholders’ equity primarily reflects $168.9 million of net income and an $11.9 million increase in AOCI. This increase 
was partially offset by $67.0 million of cash dividends paid or accrued to common shareholders. There were no shares of common stock 
repurchased during the year ended December 31, 2024. 
Common shareholder’s equity to total assets was 10.95% and 10.55% at 
December 31, 2024 and 2023, respectively. Tangible common shareholders’ equity (a non-GAAP financial measure), which excludes 
goodwill and other intangible assets was $1.40 billion, or 8.84% of tangible assets at December 31, 2024, compared to $1.27 billion, or 8.33% 
at December 31, 2023. The increase in tangible common shareholders’ equity as a percentage of tangible assets was primarily due to the 
previously mentioned increase in AOCI and an increase in retained earnings. The Company’s book value per share was $51.49 at 
December 31, 2024, compared to $48.12 per share a year ago, and its tangible book value per share (a non-GAAP financial measure) was 
$40.57 at December 31, 2024, compared to $37.09 per share a year ago. See, “Executive Overview - Non-GAAP Financial Measures” above 
for a reconciliation of these non-GAAP financial measures to the most directly comparable GAAP financial measures. 
Table of Contents 
39 

Investments. At December 31, 2024, our securities portfolio totaled $3.11 billion, consisting principally of mortgage-backed and mortgage-
related securities. Our investment levels may be increased or decreased depending upon Management’s projections as to the demand for 
funds to be used in our loan origination, deposit and other activities, and upon yields available on investment alternatives. During the year 
ended December 31, 2024, our aggregate investment in securities decreased $326.8 million, primarily due to normal security portfolio cash 
flows and the sale of securities. Mortgage-backed securities decreased $219.4 million and U.S. Government and agency obligations 
decreased $26.3 million, while municipal bonds decreased $6.8 million, corporate debt obligations decreased $23.1 million and asset-backed 
securities decreased $50.1 million. 
U.S. Government and Agency Obligations: Our portfolio of U.S. Government and agency obligations had a carrying value of $8.2 million 
(with an amortized cost of $8.8 million) at December 31, 2024, a weighted average contractual maturity of 13 years and a weighted average 
coupon rate of 4.11%. Many of the U.S. Government and agency obligations we own include call features which allow the issuing agency the 
right to call the securities at various dates prior to the final maturity. 
Mortgage-Backed Obligations:  At December 31, 2024, our mortgage-backed and mortgage-related securities had a carrying value of $2.24 
billion ($2.56 billion at amortized cost, with a net unrealized loss adjustment of $319.0 million). The weighted average coupon rate of these 
securities was 2.60% and the weighted average contractual maturity was 26 years, although we receive principal payments on these securities 
each month resulting in a much shorter expected average life. As of December 31, 2024, 97% of the mortgage-backed and mortgage-related 
securities pay interest at a fixed rate. 
Municipal Bonds:  The carrying value of our tax-exempt bonds at December 31, 2024 was $493.5 million ($512.3 million at amortized cost), 
comprised of general obligation bonds (i.e., backed by the general credit of the issuer) and, to a lesser extent, revenue bonds (i.e., backed by 
revenues from the specific project being financed) issued by cities and counties and various housing authorities, and hospital, school, water 
and sanitation districts. We also had taxable bonds in our municipal bond portfolio, which at December 31, 2024 had a carrying value of 
$68.5 million ($79.9 million at amortized cost). Many of our qualifying municipal bonds are not rated by a nationally recognized credit rating 
agency due to the smaller size of the total issuance and a portion of these bonds have been acquired through direct private placement by the 
issuers. We have not experienced any defaults or payment deferrals on our current portfolio of municipal bonds. Our combined municipal 
bond portfolio is geographically diverse, with the majority within the states of Washington, Oregon, Texas and California. At December 31, 
2024, our municipal bond portfolio, including taxable and tax-exempt, had a weighted average maturity of approximately 22 years and a 
weighted average coupon rate of 3.13%. 
Corporate Bonds: Our corporate bond portfolio had a carrying value of $127.5 million ($134.0 million at amortized cost) at December 31, 
2024.  At December 31, 2024, the portfolio had a weighted average maturity of 11.0 years and a weighted average coupon rate of 4.82%. 
Asset-Backed Securities:  At December 31, 2024, our asset-backed securities portfolio had a carrying value of $170.8 million (with an 
amortized cost of $170.6 million), and was comprised of collateralized loan obligations. The weighted average coupon rate of these securities 
was 6.51% and the weighted average contractual maturity was 14 years. At December 31, 2024, 100% of these securities had adjustable 
interest rates tied to three-month SOFR. 
Table of Contents 
40 

The following tables set forth certain information regarding carrying values and percentage of total carrying values of our portfolio of 
securities—trading and securities—available-for-sale, both carried at estimated fair market value, and securities—held-to-maturity, carried at 
amortized cost, net of the allowance for credit losses - securities, as of December 31, 2024, 2023 and 2022 (dollars in thousands): 
Table 1: Securities 
December 31 
2024 
2023 
2022 
Carrying 
Value 
Percent of 
Total 
Carrying 
Value 
Percent of 
Total 
Carrying 
Value 
Percent of 
Total 
Trading 
Corporate bonds (1) 
$ 
— 
n/a $ 
— 
n/a $ 
28,694 
100 % 
Total securities—trading 
$ 
— 
n/a $ 
— 
n/a $ 
28,694 
100 % 
Available-for-Sale 
U.S. Government and agency obligations 
$ 
7,933 
— % $ 
34,189 
1 % $ 
55,108 
2 % 
Municipal bonds 
123,982 
6 
132,905 
6 
261,209 
9 
Corporate bonds 
124,990 
6 
119,123 
5 
121,853 
4 
Mortgage-backed or related securities 
1,676,848 
80 
1,866,714 
79 
2,139,336 
77 
Asset-backed securities 
170,758 
8 
220,852 
9 
211,525 
8 
Total securities—available-for-sale 
$ 2,104,511 
100 % $ 2,373,783 
100 % $ 2,789,031 
100 % 
Held-to-Maturity 
U.S. Government and agency obligations 
$ 
302 
— % $ 
307 
— % $ 
312 
— % 
Municipal bonds 
438,053 
44 
465,875 
44 
503,117 
45 
Corporate bonds 
2,504 
— 
2,606 
— 
2,961 
— 
Mortgage-backed or related securities 
560,705 
56 
590,267 
56 
611,577 
55 
Total securities—held-to-maturity 
$ 1,001,564 
100 % $ 1,059,055 
100 % $ 1,117,967 
100 % 
Estimated market value 
$ 
825,528 
$ 
907,514 
$ 
942,180 
(1) In the fourth quarter of 2023, our corporate bonds classified as trading were transferred to available-for-sale. 
Table of Contents 
41 

The following table shows the maturity or period to repricing of our available-for-sale and held-to-maturity securities as of December 31, 2024 (dollars in thousands): 
Table 2: Securities Available-for-Sale and Held-to-Maturity—Maturity/Repricing and Rates 
December 31, 2024 
One Year or Less 
After One to Five Years 
After Five to Ten Years 
After Ten Years 
Total 
Carrying 
Value 
Weighted 
Average 
Yield 
Carrying 
Value 
Weighted 
Average 
Yield 
Carrying 
Value 
Weighted 
Average 
Yield 
Carrying 
Value 
Weighted 
Average 
Yield 
Carrying 
Value 
Weighted 
Average 
Yield 
U.S. Government and agency obligations 
$ 
372 
2.70 % $ 
1,666 
5.81 % $ 
2,653 
2.32 % $ 
3,544 
2.85 % $ 
8,235 
3.27 % 
Municipal bonds: 
Taxable 
2,558 
4.15 % 
7,232 
3.88 % 
2,893 
2.18 % 
55,858 
2.81 % 
68,541 
2.95 % 
Tax exempt (1) 
842 
4.89 % 
5,553 
2.87 % 
29,397 
3.67 % 
457,702 
3.57 % 
493,494 
3.57 % 
3,400 
4.34 % 
12,785 
3.44 % 
32,290 
3.53 % 
513,560 
3.49 % 
562,035 
3.49 % 
Corporate bonds 
5,813 
4.40 % 
20,411 
4.53 % 
74,477 
3.81 % 
26,793 
9.77 % 
127,494 
5.21 % 
Mortgage-backed or related securities 
17,197 
3.46 % 
112,564 
3.24 % 
171,943 
2.23 % 
1,935,849 
2.65 % 
2,237,553 
2.65 % 
Asset-backed securities 
— 
— % 
— 
— % 
141,258 
6.71 % 
29,500 
6.74 % 
170,758 
6.71 % 
Total securities—available-for-sale and held-to-
maturity - carrying value 
$ 
26,782 
3.77 % $ 147,426 
3.46 % $ 422,621 
4.11 % $ 2,509,246 
2.94 % $ 3,106,075 
3.13 % 
Total securities—available-for-sale and held-to-
maturity - estimated market value 
$ 
26,777 
$ 146,905 
$ 420,152 
$ 2,336,205 
$ 2,930,039 
(1) 
Tax-exempt weighted average yield is calculated on a tax equivalent basis using a federal tax rate of 21% and a tax disallowance of 10%. 
Table of Contents 
42 

Loans and Lending. Loans are our most significant and generally highest yielding earning assets. We attempt to maintain a portfolio of 
loans to total deposits ratio at a level designed to enhance our revenues, while adhering to sound underwriting practices and appropriate 
diversification guidelines in order to maintain a moderate risk profile. Our loan-to-deposit ratio at December 31, 2024, was 84%. We offer a 
wide range of loan products to meet the demands of our clients. Our lending activities are primarily directed toward the origination of 
commercial real estate and business loans. While we originate a variety of loans, our ability to originate each type of loan depends upon the 
relative client demand and competition in each market we serve. We continue to implement strategies designed to capture more market share 
and achieve increases in targeted loans. New loan originations and portfolio balances will continue to be significantly affected by economic 
activity and changes in interest rates. 
The following table shows loan origination activity (excluding loans held for sale) for the years ended December 31, 2024, 2023 and 2022 (in 
thousands): 
Table 3: Loan Originations 
Years Ended 
Dec 31, 2024 
Dec 31, 2023 
Dec 31, 2022 
Commercial real estate 
$ 
408,546 
$ 
309,022 
$ 
418,635 
Multifamily real estate 
6,593 
57,046 
37,612 
Construction, land and land development 
1,759,799 
1,541,383 
1,935,476 
Commercial business 
752,269 
585,047 
1,034,950 
Agricultural business 
79,715 
84,072 
89,655 
One- to four-family residential 
106,085 
167,951 
358,976 
Consumer 
356,543 
300,913 
545,254 
Total loan originations (excluding loans held for sale) 
$ 
3,469,550 
$ 
3,045,434 
$ 
4,420,558 
Table of Contents 
43 
One- to Four-Family Residential Lending:  At December 31, 2024, $1.59 billion, or 14% of our loan portfolio, consisted of permanent loans 
on one- to four-family residences. We are active originators of one- to four-family residential loans in the communities we serve. Our 
balance of loans for one- to four-family residences increased by $73.2 million in 2024, compared to the prior year. The increase in one- to 
four-family residential loans during 2024 was primarily the result of a higher percentage of one- to four-family construction loans converting 
to one- to four-family residential loans and a larger percentage of new production being held in portfolio. 
Construction, Land and Land Development Lending:  Our construction loan originations have been relatively strong in recent years as 
builders have expanded production and experienced strong home sales in many markets where we operate. At December 31, 2024, 
construction, land and land development loans totaled $1.52 billion, or 14% of total loans. The largest shifts in this portfolio occurred in 
commercial construction and land and land development loans. Commercial construction loans decreased $47.6 million, or 28%, to $122.4 
million at December 31, 2024, primarily due to the conversion of commercial construction loans to the commercial real estate portfolio upon 
the completion of the construction phase, partially offset by new loan production. Commercial construction loans represented approximately 
1% of our total loan portfolio at December 31, 2024, comprised primarily of retail property construction projects. Land and land development 
loans increased $33.0 million, or 10%, to $369.7 million at December 31, 2024. 
Land and land development loans represented 
approximately 3% of our total loan portfolio at December 31, 2024 and was comprised of residential properties for personal use and 
development. Multifamily construction loans increased $9.7 million, or 2%, to $513.7 million at December 31, 2024. Multifamily 
construction loans represented approximately 5% of our total loan portfolio at December 31, 2024 and was comprised of affordable housing 
projects and, to a lesser extent, market rate multifamily projects across our footprint. One- to four-family construction loans decreased $12.2 
million, or 2%, to $514.2 million at December 31, 2024. One- to four-family construction loans represented approximately 5% of our total 
loan portfolio at December 31, 2024, and included speculative construction loans, as well as “all-in-one” construction loans made to owner 
occupants that convert to permanent loans upon completion of the homes that, depending on market conditions, may be subsequently sold into 
the secondary market. 
Commercial and Multifamily Real Estate Lending:  We originate loans secured by commercial and multifamily real estate. These loans 
include both fixed- and adjustable-rate loans with intermediate terms of generally five to 10 years. At December 31, 2024, our loan portfolio 
included $3.86 billion of commercial real estate loans, or 34% of the total loan portfolio, and $894.4 million of multifamily real estate loans, 
or 8% of the total loan portfolio. The increase in commercial real estate loans was primarily the result of new loan production and the 
conversion of commercial construction loans to commercial real estate loans upon the completion of the construction phase. Our commercial 
real estate portfolio consists of loans on a variety of property types with no significant concentrations by property type, borrowers or 
locations. Approximately 12% of our commercial real estate portfolio was secured by retail property at December 31, 2024. Within this 
portfolio, we have limited exposure to the office sector, with only 6% of total loans secured by office properties, nearly 55% of which are 
owner-occupied. The increase in multifamily real estate loans was the result of the conversion of multifamily construction loans to 
multifamily real estate loans upon the completion of the construction phase. 

Commercial Business Lending:  Our commercial business lending is directed toward meeting the credit and related deposit needs of various 
small-to-medium-sized business and agribusiness borrowers operating in our primary market areas. In addition to providing earning assets, 
this type of lending has helped increase our deposit base. At December 31, 2024, commercial business loans, including small business 
scored, totaled $2.42 billion, or 21% of total loans. Our commercial business loan portfolio at December 31, 2024 reflects an increase of 6% 
from December 31, 2023. Our commercial business lending, to a lesser extent, includes participation in certain syndicated loans, including 
shared national credits which totaled $227.4 million, or 2% of our loan portfolio, at December 31, 2024. 
Agricultural Lending:  Agriculture is a major industry in our footprint. While agricultural loans are not a large part of our portfolio, we 
routinely make agricultural loans to borrowers with a strong capital base, sufficient management depth, proven ability to operate through 
agricultural cycles, reliable cash flows and adequate financial reporting. Payments on agricultural loans depend, to a large degree, on the 
results of operation of the related farm entity. The repayment is also subject to other economic and weather conditions as well as market 
prices for agricultural products, which can be highly volatile at times. At December 31, 2024, agricultural loans totaled $340.3 million, or 3% 
of the loan portfolio. 
Consumer and Other Lending:  Consumer lending has traditionally been a modest part of our business with loans made primarily to 
accommodate our existing client base. At December 31, 2024, our consumer loans increased $22.0 million to $721.4 million, or 6% of our 
loan portfolio, compared to December 31, 2023. As of December 31, 2024, 87% of our consumer loans were secured by one- to four-family 
residences through home equity lines of credit.  Credit card balances totaled $45.2 million at December 31, 2024. 
Loan Servicing Portfolio:  
Table of Contents 
44 
At December 31, 2024, we were servicing $3.18 billion of loans for others and held $12.7 million in escrow for our 
portfolio of loans serviced for others. The loan servicing portfolio at December 31, 2024 was comprised of $1.36 billion of Freddie Mac 
residential mortgage loans, $1.00 billion of Fannie Mae residential mortgage loans, $430.7 million of Oregon Housing residential mortgage 
loans, $65.5 million of SBA loans and $314.5 million of other loans serviced for a variety of investors. The portfolio included loans secured 
by property located primarily in the states of Washington, Oregon, Idaho and California. For the years ended December 31, 2024 and 2023, 
we recognized $8.2 million and $7.8 million of loan servicing income in our results of operations, respectively. 

The following table sets forth the composition of the Company’s loan portfolio, net of discounts and deferred fees and costs, by type of loan as of the dates indicated (dollars in thousands): 
Table 4: Loan Portfolio Analysis 
December 31, 2024 
December 31, 2023 
December 31, 2022 
Amount 
Percent of Total 
Amount 
Percent of Total 
Amount 
Percent of Total 
Commercial real estate: 
Owner-occupied 
$ 
1,027,426 
9 % $ 
915,897 
8 % $ 
845,320 
8 % 
Investment properties 
1,623,672 
14 
1,541,344 
14 
1,589,975 
16 
Small balance CRE 
1,213,792 
11 
1,178,500 
11 
1,200,251 
12 
Total commercial real estate 
3,864,890 
34 
3,635,741 
33 
3,635,546 
36 
Multifamily real estate 
894,425 
8 
811,232 
8 
645,071 
6 
Construction, land and land development: 
Commercial construction 
122,362 
1 
170,011 
2 
184,876 
2 
Multifamily construction 
513,706 
5 
503,993 
5 
325,816 
3 
One- to four-family construction 
514,220 
5 
526,432 
5 
647,329 
6 
Land and land development 
369,663 
3 
336,639 
3 
328,475 
3 
Total construction, land and land development 
1,519,951 
14 
1,537,075 
15 
1,486,496 
14 
Commercial business: 
Commercial business 
1,316,321 
11 
1,252,088 
12 
1,275,813 
13 
SBA PPP 
2,012 
— 
3,646 
— 
7,594 
— 
Small business scored 
1,104,117 
10 
1,022,154 
9 
947,092 
9 
Total commercial business 
2,422,450 
21 
2,277,888 
21 
2,230,499 
22 
Agricultural business, including secured by farmland: 
Agricultural business, including secured by farmland 
340,280 
3 
331,089 
3 
294,743 
3 
SBA PPP 
— 
— 
— 
— 
334 
— 
Total agricultural business, including secured by farmland 
340,280 
3 
331,089 
3 
295,077 
3 
One- to four-family residential 
1,591,260 
14 
1,518,046 
14 
1,173,112 
12 
Consumer: 
Consumer—home equity revolving lines of credit 
625,680 
5 
588,703 
5 
566,291 
6 
Consumer—other 
95,720 
1 
110,681 
1 
114,632 
1 
Total consumer 
721,400 
6 
699,384 
6 
680,923 
7 
Total loans 
11,354,656 
100 % 
10,810,455 
100 % 
10,146,724 
100 % 
Less allowance for credit losses – loans 
(155,521) 
(149,643) 
(141,465) 
Net loans 
$ 
11,199,135 
$ 
10,660,812 
$ 
10,005,259 
Table of Contents 
45 

The following table sets forth the Company’s loans by geographic concentration at December 31, 2024, 2023 and 2022 (dollars in thousands): 
Table 5: Loans by Geographic Concentration 
December 31, 2024 
December 31, 2023 
December 31, 2022 
Amount 
Percent 
Amount 
Percent 
Amount 
Percent 
Washington 
$ 
5,245,886 
46 % $ 
5,095,602 
47 % $ 
4,777,546 
47 % 
California 
2,861,435 
25 
2,670,923 
25 
2,484,980 
25 
Oregon 
2,113,229 
19 
1,974,001 
18 
1,826,743 
18 
Idaho 
665,158 
6 
610,064 
5 
565,586 
5 
Utah 
82,459 
1 
68,931 
1 
75,967 
1 
Other 
386,489 
3 
390,934 
4 
415,902 
4 
Total 
$ 11,354,656 
100 % $ 10,810,455 
100 % $ 10,146,724 
100 % 
The geographic concentration of our commercial real estate portfolio, as of December 31, 2024, was 48% in Washington and 26% in 
California. 
The following table sets forth certain information at December 31, 2024 regarding the dollar amount of loans maturing in our portfolio based 
on their contractual terms to maturity, but does not include scheduled payments or potential prepayments. Demand loans, loans having no 
stated schedule of repayments and no stated maturity, and overdrafts are reported as due in one year or less. Loan balances are net of 
unamortized premiums and discounts and exclude loans held for sale (in thousands): 
Table 6: Loans by Maturity 
Maturing in 
One Year or 
Less 
Maturing 
After One to 
Five Years 
Maturing 
After Five to 
Fifteen Years 
Maturing 
After Fifteen 
Years 
Total 
Commercial real estate: 
Owner-occupied 
$ 
69,859 
$ 
176,780 
$ 
755,526 
$ 
25,261 
$ 1,027,426 
Investment properties 
105,984 
536,474 
807,897 
173,317 
1,623,672 
Small balance CRE 
78,392 
389,344 
675,611 
70,445 
1,213,792 
Total commercial real estate 
254,235 
1,102,598 
2,239,034 
269,023 
3,864,890 
Multifamily real estate 
144,129 
158,174 
314,610 
277,512 
894,425 
Construction, land and land development: 
Commercial construction 
89,666 
27,585 
5,111 
— 
122,362 
Multifamily construction 
343,050 
159,017 
— 
11,639 
513,706 
One- to four-family construction 
441,956 
72,264 
— 
— 
514,220 
Land and land development 
119,963 
93,845 
153,110 
2,745 
369,663 
Total construction, land and land development 
994,635 
352,711 
158,221 
14,384 
1,519,951 
Commercial business: 
Commercial business 
475,066 
271,265 
463,989 
108,013 
1,318,333 
Small business scored 
72,670 
211,566 
320,235 
499,646 
1,104,117 
Total commercial business 
547,736 
482,831 
784,224 
607,659 
2,422,450 
Agricultural business, including secured by farmland 
120,217 
90,006 
128,857 
1,200 
340,280 
One- to four-family residential 
3,865 
17,402 
69,225 
1,500,768 
1,591,260 
Consumer: 
Consumer—home equity revolving lines of credit 
5,836 
10,995 
3,045 
605,804 
625,680 
Consumer—other 
31,195 
10,936 
27,854 
25,735 
95,720 
Total consumer 
37,031 
21,931 
30,899 
631,539 
721,400 
Total loans 
$ 2,101,848 
$ 2,225,653 
$ 3,725,070 
$ 3,302,085 
$ 11,354,656 
Table of Contents 
46 
Contractual maturities of loans do not necessarily reflect the actual life of such assets. The average life of loans typically is substantially less 
than their contractual maturities because of principal repayments and prepayments. In addition, due-on-sale clauses on certain mortgage loans 
generally give us the right to declare loans immediately due and payable in the event that the borrower sells the real property subject to the 
mortgage and the loan is not repaid. The average life of mortgage loans tends to increase, however, when current mortgage loan market rates 
are substantially higher than rates on existing mortgage loans and, conversely, decreases when rates on existing mortgage loans are 
substantially higher than current mortgage loan market rates. 

The following table sets forth the dollar amount of all loans maturing after December 31, 2025 which have fixed interest rates and floating or 
adjustable interest rates (in thousands): 
Table 7: Loans Maturing after One Year 
Fixed Rates 
Floating or 
Adjustable Rates 
Total 
Commercial real estate: 
Owner-occupied 
$ 
252,143 
$ 
705,424 
$ 
957,567 
Investment properties 
403,802 
1,113,886 
1,517,688 
Small balance CRE 
277,791 
857,609 
1,135,400 
Total commercial real estate 
933,736 
2,676,919 
3,610,655 
Multifamily real estate 
485,892 
264,404 
750,296 
Construction, land and land development: 
Commercial construction 
16,834 
15,862 
32,696 
Multifamily construction 
47,792 
122,864 
170,656 
One- to four-family construction 
1,492 
70,772 
72,264 
Land and land development 
72,820 
176,880 
249,700 
Total construction, land and land development 
138,938 
386,378 
525,316 
Commercial business: 
Commercial business 
573,054 
270,213 
843,267 
Small business scored 
160,694 
870,753 
1,031,447 
Total commercial business 
733,748 
1,140,966 
1,874,714 
Agricultural business, including secured by farmland 
66,357 
153,706 
220,063 
One- to four-family residential 
1,094,636 
492,759 
1,587,395 
Consumer: 
Consumer—home equity revolving lines of credit 
286 
619,558 
619,844 
Consumer—other 
62,054 
2,471 
64,525 
Total consumer 
62,340 
622,029 
684,369 
Total loans maturing after one year 
$ 
3,515,647 
$ 
5,737,161 
$ 
9,252,808 
Table of Contents 
47 
Deposits. We compete with other financial institutions and financial intermediaries in attracting deposits and we generally attract deposits 
within our primary market areas. Much of the focus of our expansion and current marketing efforts have been directed toward attracting 
additional deposit client relationships and balances. 
One of our key strategies is to strengthen our franchise by emphasizing core deposit activity in non-interest-bearing and other transaction and 
savings accounts with less reliance on higher cost certificates of deposit. This strategy is intended to help control our cost of funds and 
increase the opportunity for deposit fee revenues, while stabilizing our funding base. Total deposits increased $484.9 million, or 4%, to 
$13.51 billion at December 31, 2024 from $13.03 billion at December 31, 2023.  The increase in deposits during the year ended December 31, 
2024 was due to an increase in core deposits, primarily interest-bearing transaction and savings accounts. Core deposits were 89% of total 
deposits at both December 31, 2024 and 2023. 

The following table sets forth the balances of deposits in the various types of accounts offered by the Bank at the dates indicated (dollars in thousands): 
Table 8: Deposits 
December 31 
2024 
2023 
2022 
Amount 
Percent of 
Total 
Increase 
(Decrease) 
Amount 
Percent of 
Total 
Increase 
(Decrease) 
Amount 
Percent of 
Total 
Non-interest-bearing checking 
$ 4,591,543 
34 % $ 
(200,826) $ 4,792,369 
37 % $ (1,384,629) $ 6,176,998 
45 % 
Interest-bearing checking 
2,393,864 
18 
295,338 
2,098,526 
16 
287,373 
1,811,153 
14 
Regular savings 
3,478,423 
26 
497,893 
2,980,530 
23 
270,440 
2,710,090 
20 
Money market 
1,550,896 
11 
(129,709) 
1,680,605 
13 
(517,683) 
2,198,288 
16 
Total interest-bearing transaction and savings 
accounts 
7,423,183 
55 
663,522 
6,759,661 
52 
40,130 
6,719,531 
50 
Certificates maturing: 
Within one year 
1,448,449 
11 
48,576 
1,399,873 
11 
868,230 
531,643 
4 
After one year, but within two years 
31,053 
— 
(18,526) 
49,579 
— 
(93,414) 
142,993 
1 
After two years, but within five years 
19,571 
— 
(7,749) 
27,320 
— 
(20,195) 
47,515 
— 
After five years 
599 
— 
(96) 
695 
— 
(684) 
1,379 
— 
Total certificate accounts 
1,499,672 
11 
22,205 
1,477,467 
11 
753,937 
723,530 
5 
Total deposits 
$ 13,514,398 
100 % $ 
484,901 
$ 13,029,497 
100 % $ 
(590,562) $ 13,620,059 
100 % 
Included in Total Deposits: 
Public transaction accounts 
$ 
414,413 
3 % $ 
57,798 
$ 
356,615 
3 % $ 
(36,244) $ 
392,859 
3 % 
Public interest-bearing certificates 
25,423 
— 
(26,625) 
52,048 
— 
25,238 
26,810 
— 
Total public deposits 
$ 
439,836 
3 % $ 
31,173 
$ 
408,663 
3 % $ 
(11,006) $ 
419,669 
3 % 
Total deposits in excess of the FDIC insurance limit 
$ 4,379,488 
32 % $ 
296,273 
$ 4,083,215 
31 % $ 
(761,482) $ 4,844,697 
36 % 
Table of Contents 
48 

The following table indicates the amount of the Bank’s certificates of deposit with balances in excess of the FDIC insurance limit by time 
remaining until maturity as of December 31, 2024 (in thousands): 
Table 9: Maturity Period—Certificates of Deposit in excess of the FDIC insurance limit 
Certificates of Deposit in Excess of FDIC Insurance Limit 
Maturing in three months or less 
$ 
177,912 
Maturing after three months through six months 
199,954 
Maturing after six months through 12 months 
81,596 
Maturing after 12 months 
6,552 
Total 
$ 
466,014 
The following table provides additional detail on geographic concentrations of our deposits at December 31, 2024, 2023 and 2022 (in 
thousands): 
Table 10: Geographic Concentration of Deposits 
December 31, 2024 
December 31, 2023 
December 31, 2022 
Amount 
Percent 
Amount 
Percent 
Amount 
Percent 
Washington 
$ 
7,441,413 
55 % $ 
7,247,392 
56 % $ 
7,563,056 
56 % 
Oregon 
2,981,327 
22 
2,852,677 
22 
2,998,572 
22 
California 
2,392,573 
18 
2,269,557 
17 
2,331,524 
17 
Idaho 
699,085 
5 
659,871 
5 
726,907 
5 
Total deposits 
$ 13,514,398 
100 % $ 13,029,497 
100 % $ 13,620,059 
100 % 
Table of Contents 
49 
Borrowings. We had $290.0 million in FHLB advances at December 31, 2024. At that date, based on pledged collateral, the Bank had 
$2.95 billion of available credit capacity with the FHLB. At December 31, 2024, based upon our available unencumbered collateral, the Bank 
was eligible to borrow $1.52 billion from the Federal Reserve Bank, however, at that date we had no funds borrowed under this arrangement. 
Other borrowings, consisting of retail repurchase agreements, which are primarily associated with client sweep account arrangements, 
decreased $57.6 million to $125.3 million at December 31, 2024 from $182.9 million at December 31, 2023. At December 31, 2024, retail 
repurchase agreements had a weighted average rate of 1.98% and were secured by pledges of certain mortgage-backed securities and agency 
securities.  We had no borrowings under wholesale repurchase agreements at December 31, 2024. 
At December 31, 2024, we had an aggregate of $86.5 million of junior subordinated debentures. This includes $75.0 million issued by us and 
$11.5 million acquired in our bank acquisitions. The junior subordinated debentures are carried at their estimated fair value of $67.5 million 
at December 31, 2024. At December 31, 2024, the junior subordinated debentures had a weighted average rate of 6.32%. Subordinated 
notes, net of issuance costs, were $80.3 million at December 31, 2024, compared to $92.9 million at December 31, 2023, and a weighted 
average interest rate of 5.00%.  The decrease was due to the Bank’s purchase of $13.0 million of Banner’s outstanding subordinated debt from 
third parties during the year ended December 31, 2024. 
Asset Quality. 
Maintaining a moderate risk profile by employing appropriate underwriting standards, avoiding excessive asset 
concentrations and aggressively managing troubled assets has been and will continue to be a primary focus for us. 
Non-performing assets increased to $39.6 million, or 0.24% of total assets, at December 31, 2024, from $30.1 million, or 0.19% of total 
assets, at December 31, 2023. At December 31, 2024, our allowance for credit losses - loans was $155.5 million, or 421% of non-performing 
loans, compared to $149.6 million, or 506% of non-performing loans, at December 31, 2023. 

The following table sets forth information with respect to our non-performing assets at the dates indicated (dollars in thousands): 
Table 11: Non-Performing Assets 
December 31 
2024 
2023 
2022 
Nonaccrual loans: 
Secured by real estate: 
Commercial 
$ 
2,186 
$ 
2,677 
$ 
3,683 
Construction/land 
3,963 
3,105 
181 
One- to four-family 
10,016 
5,702 
5,236 
Commercial business 
7,067 
9,002 
9,886 
Agricultural business, including secured by farmland 
8,485 
3,167 
594 
Consumer 
4,835 
3,204 
2,126 
36,552 
26,857 
21,706 
Loans more than 90 days delinquent, still on accrual: 
Secured by real estate: 
Construction/land 
— 
1,138 
— 
One- to four-family 
369 
1,205 
1,023 
Commercial business 
— 
1 
— 
Consumer 
35 
401 
264 
404 
2,745 
1,287 
Total non-performing loans 
36,956 
29,602 
22,993 
REO assets held for sale, net 
2,367 
526 
340 
Other repossessed assets held for sale, net 
300 
— 
17 
Total non-performing assets 
$ 39,623 
$ 30,128 
$ 23,350 
Total non-performing assets to total assets 
0.24 % 
0.19 % 
0.15 % 
Total nonaccrual loans to net loans before allowance for credit losses 
0.32 % 
0.25 % 
0.21 % 
Loans 30-89 days past due and on accrual 
$ 26,824 
$ 19,744 
$ 17,186 
The increase in total non-performing loans was primarily due to increases in nonaccrual loans in the one- to four-family and agricultural 
business loan categories consisting of various borrowers with no meaningful concentrations. The increases in these categories reflect loans 
transferred to nonaccrual, partially offset by payoffs of nonaccrual loans during 2024. 
For the year ended December 31, 2024, interest income was reduced by $2.0 million as a result of nonaccrual loan activity, which includes the 
reversal of $826,000 of accrued interest as of the date the loans were placed on nonaccrual. For the year ended December 31, 2023, interest 
income was reduced by $1.6 million as a result of nonaccrual loan activity, which includes the reversal of $569,000 of accrued interest as of 
the date the loans were placed on nonaccrual. For the year ended December 31, 2022, interest income was reduced by $725,000 as a result of 
nonaccrual loan activity, which includes the reversal of $322,000 of accrued interest as of the date the loan was placed on nonaccrual. There 
was no interest income recognized on nonaccrual loans during the years ended December 31, 2024, 2023 and 2022. 
The following table presents the Company’s portfolio of risk-rated loans and non-risk-rated loans by grade at the dates indicated (in 
thousands): 
Table 12: Loans by Grade 
December 31 
2024 
2023 
2022 
Pass 
$ 
11,118,744 
$ 
10,671,281 $ 
10,000,493 
Special Mention 
43,451 
13,732 
9,081 
Substandard 
192,461 
125,442 
137,150 
Total 
$ 
11,354,656 
$ 
10,810,455 $ 
10,146,724 
Table of Contents 
50 
The increase in substandard loans during the year ended December 31, 2024 was primarily due to increases in adversely classified loans, 
primarily in the commercial business and agricultural loan segments, partially offset by payoffs and paydowns.  As of December 31, 2024, 
total substandard loans primarily consisted of loans within the commercial business, owner-occupied commercial real estate and agricultural 
loan segments. 

Comparison of Results of Operations for the Years Ended December 31, 2024 and 2023 
General. For the year ended December 31, 2024, net income was $168.9 million, or $4.88 per diluted share, compared to net income of 
$183.6 million, or $5.33 per diluted share for the year ended December 31, 2023. Current year results included a decrease in net interest 
income and an increase in non-interest expense, partially offset by an increase in non-interest income and a decrease in the provision for credit 
losses. 
Our operating results depend largely on net interest income which decreased $34.3 million to $541.7 million for the year ended December 31, 
2024, compared to the prior year, primarily reflecting increased funding costs, partially offset by increased yields on loans due to new loans 
being originated at higher interest rates and adjustable rate loans repricing higher, as well as higher average loan balances. Revenues (net 
interest income and non-interest income) decreased $11.8 million, or 2%, to $608.6 million for the year ended December 31, 2024, compared 
to the year ended December 31, 2023, primarily due to increased funding costs, partially offset by increased interest income on loans and a 
decrease in the net loss on the sale of securities during the year ended December 31, 2024. 
We recorded a $7.6 million provision for credit losses for the year ended December 31, 2024, compared to a $10.8 million provision for credit 
losses for the year ended December 31, 2023. The provision for credit losses for the year ended December 31, 2024, reflects risk rating 
downgrades, as well as growth in loan balances. 
Total non-interest income for the year ended December 31, 2024 increased to $66.9 million compared to $44.4 million for the year ended 
December 31, 2023, primarily due to a decrease in the net loss on the sale of securities. 
Total non-interest expense increased to $391.5 million for the year ended December 31, 2024, compared to $382.5 million for the year ended 
December 31, 2023, largely as a result of increases in salary and employee benefits and payment and card processing services expense, 
partially offset by decreases in professional and legal expense and the amortization of core deposit intangibles. 
Net Interest Income.  Net interest income decreased $34.3 million, or 6%, to $541.7 million for the year ended December 31, 2024, 
compared to $576.0 million for the year ended December 31, 2023, primarily reflecting increased funding costs, partially offset by increased 
yields on loans due to new loans being originated at higher interest rates and adjustable rate loans repricing higher, as well as higher average 
loan balances. The higher average yield on interest-earning assets, compared to the same period in the prior year, reflects the overall higher 
interest rate environment during 2024, despite the Federal Reserve reducing rates in late 2024. While interest rate cuts during the year led to 
lower funding costs and yields on interest-earning assets in the fourth quarter, the overall results for the year were largely shaped by the 
elevated interest rates during most of 2024. 
The net interest margin on a tax equivalent basis of 3.75% for the year ended December 31, 2024, was 26 basis points lower than the prior 
year. The decrease in net interest margin reflects a 72 basis-point increase in the cost of funding liabilities, partially offset by a 39 basis-point 
increase in yields on average interest-earning assets. The increase in the overall cost of funding liabilities was primarily due to the increase in 
rates across all deposit and borrowing categories due to higher market rates. The higher funding costs was also impacted by a shift in the 
average balance of non-interest-bearing deposits to higher costing interest-bearing checking accounts, savings accounts and certificates of 
deposit. The increase in average yields on interest-earning assets during the current year reflects the benefit of variable rate interest-earning 
assets repricing higher due to rising interest rates, as well as new loans being originated at higher interest rates. 
Interest Income.  Interest income for the year ended December 31, 2024 was $766.1 million, compared to $701.6 million for the prior year, 
an increase of $64.5 million. This increase was a result of yields on interest-earning assets increasing 39 basis points to 5.26%, as well as the 
average balance of interest-earning assets increasing $157.8 million to $14.81 billion. The increased yield on interest-earning assets primarily 
reflects increases in the average yields on loans. 
Interest income on loans increased $77.7 million from the prior year to $655.6 million for the year ended December 31, 2024. The increase 
was primarily due to the average loan yields increasing 39 basis points to 5.97%, reflecting the impact of higher interest rates. Average loans 
receivable increased $639.9 million to $11.12 billion, primarily reflecting increases in the average balances of one- to four-family residential, 
construction, land and land development, and multifamily real estate loans. 
Interest and dividend income on investment securities decreased $13.5 million for the year ended December 31, 2024 due to a decline in the 
average balance of the investment securities portfolio. The combined average balance of total investment securities decreased $482.2 million 
to $3.68 billion (excluding the effect of fair value adjustments). The average yield on the combined portfolio increased to 3.11%, reflecting a 
three basis-point increase in the average yield on mortgage-backed securities and a 19 basis-point increase in the yield on other securities.  
Interest Expense.  
Table of Contents 
51 
Interest expense for the year ended December 31, 2024 was $224.4 million, compared to $125.6 million for the prior year, 
an increase of $98.8 million, or 79%.  The increase occurred as a result of a 72 basis-point increase in the average cost of all funding liabilities 
to 1.63% as well as the average balance of funding liabilities increasing $27.9 million to $13.76 billion. The increase in the average cost of 
our funding liabilities increased due to increases in the rates paid on our interest rate deposits to remain competitive in the elevated interest 
rate environment. The increase in the average balance of funding liabilities reflects increases in interest-bearing transaction and savings 
accounts and certificates of deposit, partially offset by lower average balances of money market accounts and non-interest bearing deposits. 

Deposit interest expense increased $99.3 million to $199.5 million for the year ended December 31, 2024, compared to the prior year, as a 
result of the average cost of total deposits increasing 74 basis points to 1.50% and the average balance of interest-bearing deposits increasing 
by $897.8 million. The increase in the average cost of deposits between the periods was primarily due to the average cost of interest-bearing 
deposits increasing 102 basis points to 2.32% for the year ended December 31, 2024, compared to 1.30% in the prior year. The increase in 
the average cost of interest-bearing deposits was primarily the result of a 79 basis-point increase in the cost of interest-bearing checking 
accounts, a 116 basis-point increase in the cost of savings accounts, a 90 basis-point increase in the cost money market accounts and a 107 
basis-point increase in the cost of certificates of deposit. The increase in the average balance of total interest-bearing deposits was primarily 
due to increases in the average balances of interest-bearing transaction and savings accounts and certificates of deposit, partially offset by 
lower average balances of money market accounts. 
The average rate paid on total borrowings increased 60 basis points to 4.97%, reflecting a 24 basis-point increase in the average cost of FHLB 
advances, 92 basis-point increase in the average cost of other borrowings, and 38 basis-point increase in the average cost of our subordinated 
debt. The decrease in the average balance of total borrowings was largely due to a $36.9 million decrease in the average balance of FHLB 
advances and a $34.7 million decrease in the average balance of other borrowings. 
Table 13, Analysis of Net Interest Spread, presents, for the periods indicated, our condensed average balance sheet information, together with 
interest income and yields earned on average interest-earning assets and interest expense and rates paid on average interest-bearing 
liabilities.  Average balances are computed using daily average balances. 
Table of Contents 
52 

The following table provides an analysis of our net interest spread for the last three years (dollars in thousands): 
Table 13: Analysis of Net Interest Spread 
Year Ended December 31, 2024 
Year Ended December 31, 2023 
Year Ended December 31, 2022 
Average 
Balance 
Interest and 
Dividends 
Yield/ 
Cost (3) 
Average 
Balance 
Interest and 
Dividends 
Yield/ 
Cost (3) 
Average 
Balance 
Interest and 
Dividends 
Yield/ 
Cost (3) 
Interest-earning assets: 
Held for sale loans 
$ 
27,627 
$ 
1,875 
6.79 % $ 
49,106 
$ 
2,621 
5.34 % $ 
82,030 
$ 
2,973 
3.62 % 
Mortgage loans 
9,094,276 
526,842 
5.79 % 
8,513,487 
460,664 
5.41 % 
7,731,195 
364,499 
4.71 % 
Commercial/agricultural loans 
1,871,024 
127,028 
6.79 % 
1,782,141 
113,250 
6.35 % 
1,658,358 
81,986 
4.94 % 
Consumer and other loans 
129,929 
8,584 
6.61 % 
138,196 
8,715 
6.31 % 
123,667 
7,332 
5.93 % 
Total loans (1) 
11,122,856 
664,329 
5.97 % 
10,482,930 
585,250 
5.58 % 
9,595,250 
456,790 
4.76 % 
Mortgage-backed securities 
2,650,010 
66,652 
2.52 % 
2,927,650 
72,927 
2.49 % 
3,130,124 
68,148 
2.18 % 
Other securities 
951,515 
44,083 
4.63 % 
1,173,637 
52,148 
4.44 % 
1,625,250 
48,278 
2.97 % 
Interest-bearing deposits with banks 
65,650 
2,573 
3.92 % 
46,815 
2,200 
4.70 % 
969,952 
9,633 
0.99 % 
FHLB stock 
16,658 
1,302 
7.82 % 
17,903 
847 
4.73 % 
10,628 
357 
3.36 % 
Total investment securities 
3,683,833 
114,610 
3.11 % 
4,166,005 
128,122 
3.08 % 
5,735,954 
126,416 
2.20 % 
Total interest-earning assets 
14,806,689 
778,939 
5.26 % 
14,648,935 
713,372 
4.87 % 
15,331,204 
583,206 
3.80 % 
Non-interest-earning assets 
967,122 
917,018 
1,169,271 
Total assets 
$ 15,773,811 
$ 15,565,953 
$ 16,500,475 
Deposits: 
Interest-bearing checking accounts 
$ 
2,233,902 
$ 
33,113 
1.48 % $ 
1,921,326 
$ 
13,334 
0.69 % $ 
1,890,917 
$ 
1,557 
0.08 % 
Savings accounts 
3,231,631 
71,225 
2.20 % 
2,674,936 
27,739 
1.04 % 
2,810,264 
2,053 
0.07 % 
Money market accounts 
1,632,092 
35,206 
2.16 % 
1,908,983 
24,089 
1.26 % 
2,364,122 
3,143 
0.13 % 
Certificates of deposit 
1,514,726 
59,921 
3.96 % 
1,209,261 
34,964 
2.89 % 
764,255 
3,371 
0.44 % 
Total interest-bearing deposits 
8,612,351 
199,465 
2.32 % 
7,714,506 
100,126 
1.30 % 
7,829,558 
10,124 
0.13 % 
Non-interest-bearing deposits 
4,647,100 
— 
— % 
5,436,953 
— 
— % 
6,434,670 
— 
— % 
Total deposits 
13,259,451 
199,465 
1.50 % 
13,151,459 
100,126 
0.76 % 
14,264,228 
10,124 
0.07 % 
Other interest-bearing liabilities: 
FHLB advances 
159,954 
8,941 
5.59 % 
196,819 
10,524 
5.35 % 
15,285 
489 
3.20 % 
Other borrowings 
164,613 
4,299 
2.61 % 
199,291 
3,376 
1.69 % 
249,681 
377 
0.15 % 
Subordinated debt 
177,361 
11,682 
6.59 % 
185,883 
11,541 
6.21 % 
189,870 
8,400 
4.42 % 
Total borrowings 
501,928 
24,922 
4.97 % 
581,993 
25,441 
4.37 % 
454,836 
9,266 
2.04 % 
Total funding liabilities 
13,761,379 
224,387 
1.63 % 
13,733,452 
125,567 
0.91 % 
14,719,064 
19,390 
0.13 % 
Other non-interest-bearing liabilities (2) 
308,667 
295,098 
253,983 
Total liabilities 
14,070,046 
14,028,550 
14,973,047 
Shareholders’ equity 
1,703,765 
1,537,403 
1,527,428 
Total liabilities and shareholders’ equity 
$ 15,773,811 
$ 15,565,953 
$ 16,500,475 
Net interest income/rate spread (tax equivalent) 
$ 
554,552 
3.63 % 
$ 
587,805 
3.96 % 
$ 
563,816 
3.67 % 
Net interest margin (tax equivalent) 
3.75 % 
4.01 % 
3.68 % 
Reconciliation to reported net interest income: 
Adjustments for taxable equivalent basis 
(12,836) 
(11,800) 
(10,637) 
Net interest income and margin, as reported 
$ 
541,716 
3.66 % 
$ 
576,005 
3.93 % 
$ 
553,179 
3.61 % 
Average interest-earning assets / average interest-bearing liabilities 
162.46 % 
176.57 % 
185.06 % 
Average interest-earning assets / average funding liabilities 
107.60 % 
106.67 % 
104.16 % 
Table of Contents 
53 
(footnotes follow) 

(1) 
Average balances include loans accounted for on a nonaccrual basis and loans 90 days or more past due.  Amortization of net deferred 
loan fees/costs is included with interest on loans. 
(2) 
Average other non-interest-bearing liabilities include fair value adjustments related to junior subordinated debentures. 
(3) 
Tax-exempt income is calculated on a tax equivalent basis.  The tax equivalent yield adjustment to interest earned on loans was $8.7 
million, $7.4 million and $5.9 million for the years ended December 31, 2024, 2023 and 2022, respectively.  The tax equivalent yield 
adjustment to interest earned on tax exempt securities was $4.1 million, $4.4 million and $4.8 million for the years ended 
December 31, 2024, 2023 and 2022, respectively. 
The following table sets forth the effects of changing rates and volumes on our net interest income during the periods shown (in 
thousands).  Information is provided with respect to (i) effects on interest income attributable to changes in volume (changes in volume 
multiplied by prior rate) and (ii) effects on interest income attributable to changes in rate (changes in rate multiplied by prior volume).  Effects 
on interest income attributable to changes in rate and volume (changes in rate multiplied by changes in volume) have been allocated between 
changes in rate and changes in volume (in thousands): 
Table 14: Rate/Volume Analysis 
Year Ended December 31, 2024 
Compared to Year Ended December 31, 2023 
Increase (Decrease) in Income/Expense Due to 
Year Ended December 31, 2023 
Compared to Year Ended December 31, 2022 
Increase (Decrease) in Income/Expense Due to 
Rate 
Volume 
Net 
Rate 
Volume 
Net 
Interest-earning assets: 
Held for sale loans 
$ 
592 
$ 
(1,338) $ 
(746) $ 
1,100 
$ 
(1,452) $ 
(352) 
Mortgage loans 
33,661 
32,517 
66,178 
57,068 
39,097 
96,165 
Commercial/agricultural loans 
7,967 
5,811 
13,778 
24,782 
6,482 
31,264 
Consumer and other loans 
404 
(535) 
(131) 
486 
897 
1,383 
Total loans 
42,624 
36,455 
79,079 
83,436 
45,024 
128,460 
Mortgage-backed securities 
702 
(6,977) 
(6,275) 
9,384 
(4,605) 
4,779 
Other securities 
2,148 
(10,213) 
(8,065) 
19,674 
(15,804) 
3,870 
Interest-bearing deposits with banks 
(408) 
781 
373 
8,688 
(16,121) 
(7,433) 
FHLB stock 
518 
(63) 
455 
183 
307 
490 
Total investment securities 
2,960 
(16,472) 
(13,512) 
37,929 
(36,223) 
1,706 
Total net change in interest income on 
interest-earning assets 
45,584 
19,983 
65,567 
121,365 
8,801 
130,166 
Interest-bearing liabilities: 
Interest-bearing checking accounts 
17,301 
2,478 
19,779 
11,752 
25 
11,777 
Savings accounts 
36,699 
6,787 
43,486 
25,790 
(104) 
25,686 
Money market accounts 
15,032 
(3,915) 
11,117 
21,665 
(719) 
20,946 
Certificates of deposit 
14,802 
10,155 
24,957 
28,596 
2,997 
31,593 
Total interest-bearing deposits 
83,834 
15,505 
99,339 
87,803 
2,199 
90,002 
FHLB advances 
460 
(2,043) 
(1,583) 
537 
9,498 
10,035 
Other borrowings 
1,588 
(665) 
923 
3,090 
(91) 
2,999 
Subordinated debt 
684 
(543) 
141 
3,321 
(180) 
3,141 
Total borrowings 
2,732 
(3,251) 
(519) 
6,948 
9,227 
16,175 
Total net change in interest expense on 
interest-bearing liabilities 
86,566 
12,254 
98,820 
94,751 
11,426 
106,177 
Net change in net interest income (tax 
equivalent) 
$ 
(40,982) $ 
7,729 
$ 
(33,253) $ 
26,614 
$ 
(2,625) $ 
23,989 
Table of Contents 
54 
Provision and Allowance for Credit Losses.  We recorded an $8.6 million provision for credit losses - loans in the year ended December 31, 
2024, compared to an $11.1 million provision for credit losses - loans in 2023. 
The provision for credit losses - loans reflects the amount required to maintain the allowance for credit losses - loans at an appropriate level 
based upon Management’s evaluation of the adequacy of collective and individual loss reserves.  The provision for credit losses - loans for the 
current year reflects an increase in our substandard loans in addition to growth in the loan portfolio.  The prior year provision for credit losses 
- loans primarily reflected loan growth and a deterioration in forecasted economic conditions and indicators utilized to estimate credit losses, 
as well as increased charge-offs for the prior year.  Future assessments of the expected credit losses will not only be impacted by changes to 
the reasonable and supportable forecast, but will also include an updated assessment of qualitative factors, as well as consideration of any 
required changes in the reasonable and supportable forecast reversion period. 

The following table sets forth an analysis of our allowance for credit losses - loans for the periods indicated (dollars in thousands): 
Table 15: Changes in Allowance for Credit Losses - Loans 
Years Ended December 31 
2024 
2023 
2022 
Balance, beginning of period 
$ 149,643 
$ 141,465 
$ 132,099 
Provision for credit losses – loans 
8,563 
11,097 
8,158 
Recoveries of loans previously charged off: 
Commercial real estate 
2,767 
557 
392 
Construction and land 
— 
29 
384 
One- to four-family residential 
171 
230 
181 
Commercial business 
1,963 
1,283 
1,923 
Agricultural business, including secured by farmland 
304 
146 
475 
Consumer 
476 
543 
566 
Total recoveries 
5,681 
2,788 
3,921 
Loans charged off: 
Commercial real estate 
(351) 
— 
(2) 
Construction and land 
(150) 
(1,089) 
(30) 
One- to four-family residential 
— 
(42) 
— 
Commercial business 
(5,955) 
(2,650) 
(1,699) 
Agricultural business, including secured by farmland 
— 
(564) 
(42) 
Consumer 
(1,910) 
(1,362) 
(940) 
Total charge-offs 
(8,366) 
(5,707) 
(2,713) 
Net (charge-offs) recoveries 
(2,685) 
(2,919) 
1,208 
Balance, end of period 
$ 155,521 
$ 149,643 
$ 141,465 
Total loans 
$11,354,656 
$10,810,455 
$10,146,724 
Average outstanding loans 
$11,095,229 
$10,433,824 
$ 9,513,220 
Total nonaccrual loans 
$ 
36,552 
$ 
26,857 
$ 
21,706 
Allowance for credit losses - loans as a percent of total loans 
1.37 % 
1.38 % 
1.39 % 
Allowance for credit losses - loans as a percent of nonaccrual loans 
425 % 
557 % 
652 % 
Table of Contents 
55 

The following table sets forth the breakdown of the allowance for credit losses - loans by loan category at the dates indicated (dollars in thousands): 
Table 16: Allocation of Allowance for Credit Losses - Loans 
December 31 
2024 
2023 
2022 
Amount 
Percent of 
Loans in 
Each 
Category to 
Total Loans 
Percent of 
Allowance 
to Loans in 
Each 
Category 
Amount 
Percent of 
Loans in 
Each 
Category to 
Total Loans 
Percent of 
Allowance 
to Loans in 
Each 
Category 
Amount 
Percent of 
Loans in 
Each 
Category to 
Total Loans 
Percent of 
Allowance 
to Loans in 
Each 
Category 
Allowance for credit losses - loans: 
Commercial real estate 
$ 
40,830 
34 % 
1.06 % $ 
44,384 
34 % 
1.22 % $ 
44,086
36 % 
1.21 % 
Multifamily real estate 
10,308 
8 
1.15 
9,326 
8 
1.15 
7,734 
6 
1.20 
Construction and land 
29,038 
14 
1.91 
28,095 
14 
1.83 
29,171 
14 
1.96 
One- to four-family real estate 
20,807 
14 
1.31 
19,271 
14 
1.27 
14,729 
12 
1.26 
Commercial business 
38,611 
21 
1.59 
35,464 
21 
1.56 
33,299 
22 
1.49 
Agricultural business, including secured by farmland 
5,727 
3 
1.68 
3,865 
3 
1.17 
3,475 
3 
1.18 
Consumer 
10,200 
6 
1.41 
9,238 
6 
1.32 
8,971 
7 
1.32 
Total allowance for credit losses - loans 
$ 155,521 
100 % 
1.37 % $ 149,643 
100 % 
1.38 % $ 141,465 
100 % 
1.39 % 
The allowance for credit losses - unfunded loan commitments was $13.6 million at December 31, 2024 compared to $14.5 million at December 31, 2023.  The decrease in the allowance for 
credit losses - unfunded loan commitments reflects a decrease in unfunded loan commitments. 
The following table sets forth an analysis of our allowance for credit losses - unfunded loan commitments for the periods indicated (dollars in thousands): 
Table 17: Changes in Allowance for Credit Losses - Unfunded Loan Commitments 
Years Ended, December 31, 
2024 
2023 
2022 
Balance, beginning of period 
$ 
14,484 
$ 
14,721 $ 
12,432
(Recapture) provision for credit losses - unfunded loan commitments 
(922) 
(237) 
2,289 
Balance, end of period 
$ 
13,562 
$ 
14,484 $ 
14,721 
Table of Contents 
56 

Non-interest Income.  The following table presents the key components of non-interest income for the years ended December 31, 2024, 2023 
and 2022 (dollars in thousands): 
Table 18: Non-interest Income 
2024 compared to 2023 
2023 compared to 2022 
2024 
2023 
Change 
Amount 
Change 
Percent 
2023 
2022 
Change 
Amount 
Change 
Percent 
Deposit fees and other service 
charges 
$ 43,371 
$ 41,638 
$ 
1,733 
4 % $ 41,638 
$ 44,459 
$ 
(2,821) 
(6)% 
Mortgage banking operations 
12,207 
11,817 
390 
3 % 
11,817 
10,834 
983 
9 % 
Bank-owned life insurance 
9,193 
9,245 
(52) 
(1)% 
9,245 
7,794 
1,451 
19 % 
Miscellaneous 
8,289 
5,169 
3,120 
60 % 
5,169 
6,805 
(1,636) 
(24)% 
73,060 
67,869 
5,191 
8 % 
67,869 
69,892 
(2,023) 
(3)% 
Net (loss) gain on sale of 
securities 
(5,190) 
(19,242) 
14,052 
(73)% 
(19,242) 
(3,248) 
(15,994) 
492 % 
Net change in valuation of 
financial instruments carried at 
fair value 
(982) 
(4,218) 
3,236 
(77)% 
(4,218) 
807 
(5,025) 
(623)% 
Gain on sale of branches, 
including related deposits 
— 
— 
— 
— % 
— 
7,804 
(7,804) 
(100)% 
Total non-interest income 
$ 66,888 
$ 44,409 
$ 22,479 
51 % $ 44,409 
$ 75,255 
$ (30,846) 
(41)% 
Table of Contents 
57 
Non-interest income increased for the year ended December 31, 2024, compared to the year ended December 31, 2023.  The increase was 
primarily due to decreases in the net loss recognized on the sale of securities and the net loss recognized on the valuation of financial 
instruments carried at fair value, as well as increases in miscellaneous income and deposit fees and other service charges. 
Income from deposit fees and other service charges increased primarily as a result of an increase in fees related to overdrafts during the 
current year. 
Revenue from mortgage banking operations, including gains from one- to four-family and multifamily loan sales and loan servicing fees, 
increased for the year ended December 31, 2024, compared to the prior year.  The volume of one- to four-family loans sold during the year 
ended December 31, 2024 increased compared to the prior year, although overall volumes remained low due to reduced refinancing and 
purchase activity in the current rate environment.  We sold $408.9 million of one- to four-family loans held for sale for the year ended 
December 31, 2024, compared to $256.0 million for the year ended December 31, 2023.  The increase was also impacted by increases in the 
pricing on the one- to four-family loans sold during the current year.  Sales of one- to four-family loans held for sale for the year ended 
December 31, 2024, resulted in gains of $8.0 million, compared to $5.1 million for the year ended December 31, 2023.  The prior year period 
also reflected a downward lower of cost or market adjustment on multifamily loans held for sale.  In 2023, the Bank discontinued the 
origination of multifamily loans for sale into the secondary market.  All of the multifamily loans held for sale were transferred to the held for 
investment loan portfolio and the related lower of cost or market adjustment was reversed in the fourth quarter of 2023.  
Miscellaneous income increased for the year ended December 31, 2024, compared to the year ended December 31, 2023 primarily as a result 
of an increase in the gain on sale of SBA loans and a gain recognized on the sale of a non-performing loan during the fourth quarter of 2024. 
The net loss on sale of securities during the year ended December 31, 2024, reflects strategic sales of securities, mostly in the first quarter of 
2024, to minimize the impact of increasing rates on our securities portfolio.  The net loss on the valuation of financial instruments carried at 
fair value were due to declines during 2024 in the market valuation of investment securities carried at fair value. 

Non-interest Expense.  The following table represents key elements of non-interest expense for the years ended December 31, 2024, 2023 
and 2022 (dollars in thousands). 
Table 19: Non-interest Expense 
2024 compared to 2023 
2023 compared to 2022 
2024 
2023 
Change 
Amount 
Change 
Percent 
2023 
2022 
Change 
Amount 
Change 
Percent 
Salary and employee benefits 
$ 250,555 
$ 244,563 
$ 
5,992 
2 % $ 244,563 
$ 242,266 
$ 
2,297 
1 % 
Less capitalized loan origination 
costs 
(16,857) 
(16,257) 
(600) 
4 % 
(16,257) 
(24,313) 
8,056 
(33)% 
Occupancy and equipment 
48,771 
47,886 
885 
2 % 
47,886 
52,018 
(4,132) 
(8)% 
Information and computer data 
services 
29,165 
28,445 
720 
3 % 
28,445 
25,986 
2,459 
9 % 
Payment and card processing 
services 
22,518 
20,547 
1,971 
10 % 
20,547 
21,195 
(648) 
(3)% 
Professional and legal expenses 
7,858 
9,830 
(1,972) 
(20)% 
9,830 
14,005 
(4,175) 
(30)% 
Advertising and marketing 
5,149 
4,794 
355 
7 % 
4,794 
3,959 
835 
21 % 
Deposit insurance 
11,398 
10,529 
869 
8 % 
10,529 
6,649 
3,880 
58 % 
State and municipal business and 
use taxes 
5,648 
5,260 
388 
7 % 
5,260 
4,693 
567 
12 % 
Real estate operations, net 
293 
(538) 
831 
(154)% 
(538) 
(104) 
(434) 
417 % 
Amortization of core deposit 
intangibles 
2,626 
3,756 
(1,130) 
(30)% 
3,756 
5,279 
(1,523) 
(29)% 
Loss on extinguishment of debt 
— 
— 
— 
— % 
— 
793 
(793) 
(100)% 
Miscellaneous 
24,414 
23,723 
691 
3 % 
23,723 
24,869 
(1,146) 
(5)% 
Total non-interest expense 
$ 391,538 
$ 382,538 
$ 
9,000 
2 % $ 382,538 
$ 377,295 
$ 
5,243 
1 % 
Table of Contents 
58 
Non-interest expense for the year ended December 31, 2024, increased compared to the same period in 2023.  The increase was primarily due 
to increases in salary and employee benefits and payment and card processing services, partially offset by a decrease in professional and legal 
expenses. 
Salary and employee benefits increased for the year ended December 31, 2024, compared to the prior year, primarily as a result of normal 
annual salary and wage increases and an increase in loan production related commission expense, partially offset by lower medical expenses. 
Payment and card processing services increased for the year ended December 31, 2024, compared to the prior year, primarily reflecting an 
increase in online banking costs and fraud losses. 
Professional and legal expenses decreased for the year ended December 31, 2024, from the year ended December 31, 2023, primarily due to a 
reduction in legal and consulting expenses as well as a one-time reduction in litigation settlement costs. 
Income Taxes.  For the year ended December 31, 2024, we recognized $40.6 million in income tax expense for an effective rate of 19.4%, 
which reflects our statutory tax rate reduced by the effect of tax-exempt income, certain tax credits, and tax benefits related to restricted stock 
vesting.  Our blended federal and state statutory income tax rate is 23.7%, representing a blend of the statutory federal income tax rate of 
21.0% and apportioned effects of the state and local jurisdictions where we do business.  For the year ended December 31, 2023, we 
recognized $43.5 million in income tax expense for an effective tax rate of 19.1%. 
Comparison of Results of Operations for the Years Ended December 31, 2023 and 2022 
See Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations in our Annual Report on Form 10-K for the 
year ended December 31, 2023, previously filed with the SEC. 
Market Risk and Asset/Liability Management 
Our financial condition and operations are influenced significantly by general economic conditions, including the absolute level of interest 
rates as well as changes in interest rates and the slope of the yield curve.  Our profitability is dependent, to a large extent, on our net interest 
income, which is the difference between the interest received from our interest-earning assets and the interest expense incurred on our 
interest-bearing liabilities. 

Our activities, like those of all financial institutions, inherently involve the assumption of interest rate risk.  Interest rate risk is the risk that 
fluctuations in market interest rates will have an adverse impact on the institution’s earnings and underlying economic value.  Interest rate risk 
is determined by the maturity and repricing characteristics of an institution’s assets, liabilities and off-balance-sheet contracts.  Interest rate 
risk is measured by the variability of financial performance and economic value, resulting from changes in interest rates.  Interest rate risk is 
the primary market risk affecting our financial performance. 
Our greatest source of interest rate risk results from the mismatch of maturities or repricing intervals for rate sensitive assets, liabilities and 
off-balance-sheet contracts.  This mismatch or gap is generally characterized by a substantially shorter maturity structure for interest-bearing 
liabilities than interest-earning assets, although our floating-rate assets tend to be more immediately responsive to changes in market rates 
than most deposit liabilities.  Additional interest rate risk results from mismatched repricing indices and formula (basis risk and yield curve 
risk), and product caps and floors and early repayment or withdrawal provisions (option risk), which may be contractual or market driven, that 
are generally more favorable to clients than to us.  An exception to this generalization is the beneficial effect of interest rate floors on a 
portion of our performing floating-rate loans, which help us maintain higher loan yields in periods when market interest rates decline 
significantly.  However, in a declining interest rate environment as loans with floors are repaid, they generally are replaced with new loans 
which have lower interest rate floors.  As of December 31, 2024, our loans with interest rate floors totaled $5.19 billion and had a weighted 
average floor rate of 4.77% compared to a current average note rate of 6.45%.  As of December 31, 2024, our loans with interest rates at their 
floors totaled $1.34 billion and had a weighted average note rate of 4.48%.  The Company actively manages its exposure to interest rate risk 
through ongoing adjustments to the mix of interest-earning assets and funding sources that affect the repricing speeds of loans, investments, 
interest-bearing deposits and borrowings. 
The principal objectives of asset/liability management are: to evaluate the interest rate risk exposure; to determine the appropriate level of risk 
given our operating environment, business plan strategies, performance objectives, capital and liquidity constraints, and asset and liability 
allocation alternatives; and to manage our interest rate risk consistent with regulatory guidelines and policies approved by the Board of 
Directors.  Through such management, we seek to reduce the vulnerability of our earnings and capital position to changes in the level of 
interest rates.  Our actions in this regard are taken under the guidance of the Asset/Liability Management Committee, which is comprised of 
members of our senior management.  The Committee closely monitors our interest sensitivity exposure, asset and liability allocation 
decisions, liquidity and capital positions, and local and national economic conditions, and attempts to structure the loan and investment 
portfolios and funding sources to maximize earnings within acceptable risk tolerances. 
Sensitivity Analysis 
Our primary monitoring tool for assessing interest rate risk is asset/liability simulation modeling, which is designed to capture the dynamics 
of balance sheet, interest rate and spread movements, and to quantify variations in net interest income resulting from those movements under 
different rate environments.  The sensitivity of net interest income to changes in the modeled interest rate environments provides a 
measurement of interest rate risk.  We also utilize economic value analysis, which addresses changes in estimated net economic value of 
equity arising from changes in the level of interest rates.  The net economic value of equity is estimated by separately valuing our assets and 
liabilities under varying interest rate environments.  The extent to which assets gain or lose value in relation to the gains or losses of liability 
values under the various interest rate assumptions determines the sensitivity of net economic value to changes in interest rates and provides an 
additional measure of interest rate risk. 
The interest rate sensitivity analysis performed by us incorporates beginning-of-the-period rate, balance and maturity data, using various 
levels of aggregation of that data, as well as certain assumptions concerning the maturity, repricing, amortization and prepayment 
characteristics of loans and other interest-earning assets and the repricing and withdrawal of deposits and other interest-bearing liabilities into 
an asset/liability simulation model.  We update and prepare simulation modeling at least quarterly for review by senior management and 
oversight by the directors.  We believe the data and assumptions are realistic representations of our portfolio and possible outcomes under the 
various interest rate scenarios.  Nonetheless, the interest rate sensitivity of our net interest income and net economic value of equity could 
vary substantially if different assumptions were used or if actual experience differs from the assumptions used. 
Table of Contents 
59 

The following tables set forth, as of December 31, 2024, the estimated changes in our net interest income over one-year and two-year time 
horizons for our rate ramp and rate shock interest rate sensitivity scenarios, and the estimated changes in economic value of equity for our rate 
shock interest rate sensitivity scenario based on the indicated interest rate environments (dollars in thousands): 
Table 20: Interest Rate Risk Indicators - Rate Ramp 
December 31, 2024 
Estimated Increase (Decrease) in 
Change (in Basis Points) in Interest Rates (1) 
Net Interest Income Next 12 Months 
Net Interest Income Next 24 Months 
+300 
$ 
(1) 
— % $ 
12,773 
1.0 % 
+200 
3,330 
0.6 
23,088 
1.9 
+100 
3,850 
0.7 
19,828 
1.6 
0 
— 
— 
— 
— 
-100 
(8,730) 
(1.5) 
(36,698) 
(3.0) 
-200 
(16,597) 
(2.8) 
(72,787) 
(5.9) 
-300 
(23,556) 
(4.0) 
(105,400) 
(8.5) 
(1) 
Assumes a gradual change in market interest rates at all maturities during the first year; however, no rates are allowed to go below 
zero.  The targeted Federal Funds Rate was between 4.25% and 4.50% at December 31, 2024. 
Table 21: Interest Rate Risk Indicators - Rate Shock 
December 31, 2024 
Estimated Increase (Decrease) in 
Change (in Basis Points) in Interest Rates (1) 
Net Interest Income 
Next 12 Months 
Net Interest Income 
Next 24 Months 
Economic Value of 
Equity 
+300 
$ 
(7,265) 
(1.2)% $ 21,097 
1.7 % $ (439,565) 
(16.0)% 
+200 
5,472 
0.9 
36,395 
3.0 
(259,123) 
(9.5) 
+100 
7,847 
1.3 
29,027 
2.4 
(107,181) 
(3.9) 
0 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
-100 
(20,771) 
(3.5) 
(55,988) 
(4.5) 
54,480 
2.0 
-200 
(39,748) 
(6.7) 
(111,825) 
(9.1) 
71,903 
2.6 
-300 
(57,153) 
(9.6) 
(166,993) 
(13.5) 
30,183 
1.1 
(1) 
Assumes an instantaneous and sustained uniform change in market interest rates at all maturities; however, no rates are allowed to go 
below zero.  The targeted Federal Funds Rate was between 4.25% and 4.50% at December 31, 2024. 
Another monitoring tool for assessing interest rate risk is gap analysis.  The matching of the repricing characteristics of assets and liabilities 
may be analyzed by examining the extent to which assets and liabilities are interest sensitive and by monitoring an institution’s interest 
sensitivity gap.  An asset or liability is said to be interest sensitive within a specific time period if it will mature or reprice within that time 
period.  The interest rate sensitivity gap is defined as the difference between the amount of interest-earning assets anticipated, based upon 
certain assumptions, to mature or reprice within a specific time period and the amount of interest-bearing liabilities anticipated to mature or 
reprice, based upon certain assumptions, within that same time period.  A gap is considered positive when the amount of interest-sensitive 
assets exceeds the amount of interest-sensitive liabilities.  A gap is considered negative when the amount of interest-sensitive liabilities 
exceeds the amount of interest-sensitive assets.  Generally, during a period of rising rates, a negative gap would tend to adversely affect net 
interest income, while a positive gap would tend to result in an increase in net interest income.  During a period of falling interest rates, a 
negative gap would tend to result in an increase in net interest income, while a positive gap would tend to adversely affect net interest income. 
Certain shortcomings are inherent in gap analysis.  For example, although certain assets and liabilities may have similar maturities or periods 
of repricing, they may react in different degrees to changes in market rates.  Also, the interest rates on certain types of assets and liabilities 
may fluctuate in advance of changes in market rates, while interest rates on other types may lag behind changes in market rates.  Additionally, 
certain assets, such as ARM loans, have features that restrict changes in interest rates on a short-term basis and over the life of the 
asset.  Further, in the event of a change in interest rates, prepayment and early withdrawal levels would likely deviate significantly from those 
assumed in calculating the table.  Finally, the ability of some borrowers to service their debt may decrease in the event of a severe change in 
market rates. 
Table of Contents 
60 

Table 22, Interest Sensitivity Gap, presents our interest sensitivity gap between interest-earning assets and interest-bearing liabilities at 
December 31, 2024.  The following table sets forth the amounts of interest-earning assets and interest-bearing liabilities which are anticipated 
by us, based upon certain assumptions, to reprice or mature in each of the future periods shown.  At December 31, 2024, total interest-earning 
assets maturing or repricing within one year exceeded total interest-bearing liabilities maturing or repricing in the same time period by $2.17 
billion, representing a one-year cumulative gap to total assets ratio of 13.37%.  The interest rate risk indicators and interest sensitivity gaps as 
of December 31, 2024, are within our internal policy guidelines and Management considers that our current level of interest rate risk is 
reasonable. 
Table of Contents 
61 

The following table provides a GAP analysis as of December 31, 2024 (dollars in thousands): 
Table 22: Interest Sensitivity Gap 
December 31, 2024 
Within 6 
Months 
After 6 
Months 
Within 1 Year 
After 1 Year 
Within 3 
Years 
After 3 Years 
Within 5 
Years 
After 5 Years 
Within 10 
Years 
Over 10 
Years 
Total 
Interest-earning assets: (1) 
Construction loans 
$ 1,071,788 
$ 137,984 
$ 
89,189 
$ 
7,672 
$ 
1,226 
$ 
2,411 
$ 1,310,270 
Fixed-rate mortgage loans 
267,770 
220,285 
660,265 
582,171 
768,817 
425,161 
2,924,469 
Adjustable-rate mortgage loans 
1,175,977 
396,089 
1,623,455 
860,468 
445,501 
1,565 
4,503,055 
Fixed-rate mortgage-backed securities 
88,259 
104,631 
345,187 
390,372 
810,355 
788,035 
2,526,839 
Adjustable-rate mortgage-backed securities 
211,551 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
211,551 
Fixed-rate commercial/agricultural loans 
113,581 
89,249 
252,820 
133,312 
146,002 
21,751 
756,715 
Adjustable-rate commercial/agricultural loans 
982,382 
33,540 
91,438 
52,418 
1,129 
— 
1,160,907 
Consumer and other loans 
560,320 
35,465 
54,742 
18,695 
20,136 
39,323 
728,681 
Investment securities and interest-earning deposits 
353,056 
20,552 
19,770 
44,410 
95,093 
528,689 
1,061,570 
Total rate sensitive assets 
4,824,684 
1,037,795 
3,136,866 
2,089,518 
2,288,259 
1,806,935 
15,184,057 
Interest-bearing liabilities: (2) 
Interest-bearing checking accounts 
687,978 
138,174 
472,656 
369,652 
626,421 
1,183,542 
3,478,423 
Regular savings 
412,000 
118,291 
401,766 
309,020 
501,271 
651,516 
2,393,864 
Money market deposit accounts 
196,305 
109,863 
355,438 
251,539 
354,030 
283,702 
1,550,877 
Certificates of deposit 
1,184,775 
263,693 
44,275 
6,349 
599 
— 
1,499,691 
FHLB advances 
290,000 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
290,000 
Subordinated notes 
80,500 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
80,500 
Junior subordinated debentures 
89,178 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
89,178 
Retail repurchase agreements 
125,257 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
125,257 
Total rate sensitive liabilities 
3,065,993 
630,021 
1,274,135 
936,560 
1,482,321 
2,118,760 
9,507,790 
Excess (deficiency) of interest-sensitive assets over interest-sensitive 
liabilities 
$ 1,758,691 
$ 407,774 
$ 1,862,731 
$ 1,152,958 
$ 805,938 
$ (311,825) 
$ 5,676,267 
Cumulative excess of interest-sensitive assets 
$ 1,758,691 
$ 2,166,465 
$ 4,029,196 
$ 5,182,154 
$ 5,988,092 
$ 5,676,267 
$ 5,676,267 
Cumulative ratio of interest-earning assets to interest-bearing liabilities 
157.36 % 
158.62 % 
181.07 % 
187.73 % 
181.04 % 
159.70 % 
159.70 % 
Interest sensitivity gap to total assets 
10.86 % 
2.52 % 
11.50 % 
7.12 % 
4.97 % 
(1.92)% 
35.04 % 
Ratio of cumulative gap to total assets 
10.86 % 
13.37 % 
24.87 % 
31.99 % 
36.96 % 
35.04 % 
35.04 % 
(footnotes follow) 
Table of Contents 
62 

(1) 
Adjustable-rate assets are included in the period in which interest rates are next scheduled to adjust rather than in the period in which 
they are due to mature, and fixed-rate assets are included in the period in which they are scheduled to be repaid based upon scheduled 
amortization, in each case adjusted to take into account estimated prepayments. Mortgage loans and other loans are not reduced for 
allowances for credit losses and non-performing loans. Mortgage loans, mortgage-backed securities, other loans and investment 
securities are not adjusted for deferred fees and unamortized acquisition premiums and discounts. 
(2) 
Adjustable-rate liabilities are included in the period in which interest rates are next scheduled to adjust rather than in the period they 
are due to mature. Although regular savings, demand, interest-bearing checking, and money market deposit accounts are subject to 
immediate withdrawal, based on historical experience, Management considers a substantial amount of such accounts to be core 
deposits having significantly longer maturities. For the purpose of the gap analysis, these accounts have been assigned decay rates to 
reflect their longer effective maturities. If these accounts had been assumed to be short-term, the one-year cumulative gap of interest-
sensitive assets would have been a negative $3.59 billion, or negative 22.19% of total assets at December 31, 2024. Interest-bearing 
liabilities for this table exclude certain non-interest-bearing deposits that are included in the average balance calculations. 
Management is aware of the sources of interest rate risk and actively monitors and manages it to the extent possible. The Bank’s objectives in 
using interest rate derivatives are to reduce volatility in net interest income and to manage its exposure to interest rate movements. To 
accomplish this objective, the Bank uses interest rate swaps as part of its interest rate risk management strategy. The Bank enters into interest 
rate swaps with certain qualifying commercial loan clients. 
The Bank simultaneously enters into interest rate swaps with dealer 
counterparties, with identical notional amounts and terms. The net result of these interest rate swaps is that the client pays a fixed rate of 
interest and the Bank receives a floating rate. 
Based on our analysis of the interest rate risk scenarios and our strategies for managing our risk, Management believes our current level of 
interest rate risk is reasonable. 
Liquidity and Capital Resources 
Our primary sources of funds are deposits, borrowings, proceeds from loan principal and interest payments and sales of loans, and the 
maturity of and interest income on mortgage-backed and investment securities. While maturities and scheduled amortization of loans and 
mortgage-backed securities are a predictable source of funds, deposit flows and mortgage prepayments are greatly influenced by market 
interest rates, economic conditions, competition and our pricing strategies. 
Our primary investing activity is the origination of loans and, in certain periods, the purchase of securities or loans. During the years ended 
December 31, 2024 and 2023, our loan originations, including originations of loans held for sale, exceeded our loan repayments by $984.7 
million and $886.8 million, respectively. There were $4.7 million of loans purchased during the year ended December 31, 2024, and no loans 
purchased during the year ended December 31, 2023. During the years ended December 31, 2024 and 2023, we received proceeds of $435.3 
million and $280.6 million, respectively, from the sale of loans. Securities purchased during the years ended December 31, 2024 and 2023 
totaled $63.2 million and $58.2 million, respectively, and securities repayments, maturities and sales in those same periods were $369.9 
million and $600.4 million, respectively. 
Our primary funding source is deposits. Total deposits increased by $484.9 million during the year ended December 31, 2024, with core 
deposits increasing $462.7 million and certificates of deposit increasing $22.2 million.  At December 31, 2024, core deposits totaled $12.01 
billion, or 89%, of total deposits, compared with $11.55 billion, or 89% of total deposits at December 31, 2023. The increase in core deposits 
compared to the prior year quarter primarily reflects increases in interest-bearing transaction and savings accounts. Certificates of deposit are 
generally more vulnerable to competition and more price sensitive than other retail deposits and our pricing of those deposits varies 
significantly based upon our liquidity management strategies at any point in time. At December 31, 2024, certificates of deposit totaled $1.50 
billion, or 11% of our total deposits, including $1.45 billion which were scheduled to mature within one year. Certificates of deposit totaled 
11% of our total deposits at December 31, 2023. 
We had $290.0 million of FHLB advances at December 31, 2024, compared to $323.0 million at December 31, 2023. Other borrowings at 
December 31, 2024 decreased $57.6 million to $125.3 million from December 31, 2023. Both the FHLB advances and other borrowings 
outstanding at December 31, 2024 mature during 2025. 
We must maintain an adequate level of liquidity to ensure the availability of sufficient funds to accommodate deposit withdrawals, support 
loan growth, satisfy financial commitments and take advantage of investment opportunities. We use our sources of funds primarily to fund 
loan growth and deposit outflows. At December 31, 2024, we had outstanding loan commitments totaling $3.97 billion, primarily relating to 
undisbursed loans in process and unused credit lines. While representing potential growth in the loan portfolio and lending activities, this 
level of commitments is proportionally consistent with our historical experience and does not represent a departure from normal operations.  
For the year ending December 31, 2025, we have $18.9 million of purchase obligations under contracts with our key vendors to provide 
services, mainly information technology related contracts. In addition, at December 31, 2024, we had $14.1 million of commitments under 
operating lease agreements. 
Table of Contents 
63 

We generally maintain sufficient cash and readily marketable securities to meet short-term liquidity needs; however, our primary liquidity 
management practice to supplement deposits is to increase or decrease short-term borrowings, including FHLB advances and Federal Reserve 
Bank of San Francisco (FRBSF) borrowings. We maintain credit facilities with the FHLB, subject to collateral requirements and a sufficient 
level of ownership of FHLB stock. At December 31, 2024, under these credit facilities based on pledged collateral, the Bank had 
$2.95 billion of available credit capacity. Advances under these credit facilities totaled $290.0 million at December 31, 2024. In addition, the 
Bank has been approved for participation in the FRBSF’s Borrower-In-Custody program. Under this program, based on pledged collateral, 
the Bank had available lines of credit of approximately $1.52 billion as of December 31, 2024, subject to certain collateral requirements, 
namely the collateral type and risk rating of eligible pledged loans. We had no funds borrowed from the FRBSF at December 31, 2024 or 
2023. At December 31, 2024, the Bank also had uncommitted federal funds line of credit agreements with other financial institutions totaling 
$125.0 million. No balances were outstanding under these agreements as of December 31, 2024 or 2023. Availability of lines is subject to 
federal funds balances available for loan and continued borrower eligibility. These lines are intended to support short-term liquidity needs 
and the agreements may restrict consecutive day usage. Management believes it has adequate resources and funding potential to meet our 
foreseeable liquidity requirements. 
Banner is a separate legal entity from the Bank and, on a stand-alone level, must provide for its own liquidity and pay its own operating 
expenses and cash dividends. During 2024, Banner and the Bank entered into an intercompany loan agreement for $50.0 million, which 
reduced Banner’s cash balance while maintaining liquidity with the note receivable from the Bank. The note has a term of one year, 
automatically renewable each quarter.  The note eliminates upon consolidation. 
Banner’s primary sources of funds consist of capital raised through dividends or capital distributions from the Bank, although there are 
regulatory restrictions on the ability of the Bank to pay dividends. We currently expect to continue our current practice of paying quarterly 
cash dividends on our common stock, subject to our Board of Directors’ discretion to modify or terminate this practice at any time and for any 
reason without prior notice. Our current quarterly common stock dividend rate is $0.48 per share, as approved by our Board of Directors, 
which we believe is a dividend rate per share which enables us to balance our multiple objectives of managing and investing in the Bank, and 
returning a substantial portion of our cash to our shareholders. Assuming continued dividend payments during 2025 at this rate of $0.48 per 
share, our average total dividend paid each quarter would be approximately $16.5 million based on the number of outstanding shares at 
December 31, 2024.  At December 31, 2024, Banner (on an unconsolidated basis) had liquid assets of $75.7 million. 
During the year ended December 31, 2024, total shareholders’ equity increased $121.6 million to $1.77 billion. At December 31, 2024, 
tangible common shareholders’ equity, a non-GAAP financial measure which excludes goodwill and other intangible assets, was $1.40 
billion, or 8.84% of tangible assets. See “Executive Overview - Non-GAAP Financial Measures” above for a reconciliation of total 
shareholders’ equity to tangible common shareholders’ equity. 
Capital Requirements 
Banner is a bank holding company registered with the Federal Reserve.  Bank holding companies are subject to capital adequacy requirements 
of the Federal Reserve under the Bank Holding Company Act of 1956, as amended, and the regulations of the Federal Reserve. The Bank, as 
a state-chartered, federally insured commercial bank, is subject to the capital requirements established by the FDIC. 
The capital adequacy requirements are quantitative measures established by regulation that require Banner and the Bank to maintain 
minimum amounts and ratios of capital. The Federal Reserve requires Banner to maintain capital adequacy that generally parallels the FDIC 
requirements. The FDIC requires the Bank to maintain minimum capital ratios of total capital, tier 1 capital, and common equity tier 1 capital 
to risk-weighted assets as well as tier 1 leverage capital to average assets. In addition to the minimum capital ratios, the Bank must maintain a 
capital conservation buffer consisting of additional common equity tier 1 capital greater than 2.5% of risk-weighted assets above the required 
minimum levels in order to avoid limitations on paying dividends, engaging in share repurchases, and paying discretionary bonuses. At 
December 31, 2024, Banner and the Bank each exceeded all current regulatory capital requirements to be “well capitalized” and the fully 
phased-in capital conservation buffer requirement. 
The following table shows the regulatory capital ratios for Banner and the Bank as of December 31, 2024. 
Table 23: Regulatory Capital Ratios 
Capital Ratios 
Banner Corporation 
Banner Bank 
Total capital to risk-weighted assets 
15.04 % 
14.03 % 
Tier 1 capital to risk-weighted assets 
13.08 
12.82 
Tier 1 capital to average leverage assets 
11.05 
10.83 
Tier 1 common equity to risk-weighted assets 
12.44 
12.82 
ITEM 7A – Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures about Market Risk 
See pages 58–63 of Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations. 
Table of Contents 
64 

ITEM 8 – Financial Statements and Supplementary Data 
For financial statements, see index on page 72. 
ITEM 9 – Changes in and Disagreements with Accountants on Accounting and Financial Disclosure 
Not applicable. 
ITEM 9A – Controls and Procedures 
The Management of Banner is responsible for establishing and maintaining adequate internal control over financial reporting, as such term is 
defined in Rule 13a-15(f) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 (Exchange Act). A control procedure, no matter how well conceived and 
operated, can provide only reasonable, not absolute, assurance that its objectives are met. Also, because of the inherent limitations in all 
control procedures, no evaluation of controls can provide absolute assurance that all control issues and instances of fraud, if any, within the 
Company have been detected. Additionally, in designing disclosure controls and procedures, our Management was necessarily required to 
apply its judgment in evaluating the cost-benefit relationship of possible disclosure controls and procedures. The design of any disclosure 
controls and procedures is also based, in part, upon certain assumptions about the likelihood of future events, and there can be no assurance 
that any design will succeed in achieving its stated goals under all potential future conditions. As a result of these inherent limitations, 
internal control over financial reporting may not prevent or detect misstatements. Further, projections of any evaluation of effectiveness to 
future periods are subject to risk that controls may become inadequate because of changes in conditions or that the degree of compliance with 
the policies or procedures may deteriorate. 
(a) Evaluation of Disclosure Controls and Procedures:  An evaluation of our disclosure controls and procedures (as defined in Rule 
13a-15(e) of the Exchange Act) was carried out under the supervision and with the participation of our Chief Executive Officer, Chief 
Financial Officer and several other members of our senior management as of the end of the period covered by this report. Based on their 
evaluation, our Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer concluded that, as of December 31, 2024, our disclosure controls and 
procedures were effective in ensuring that the information required to be disclosed by us in the reports we file or submit under the Exchange 
Act is (i) accumulated and communicated to our management (including the Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer) in a timely 
manner, and (ii) recorded, processed, summarized and reported within the time periods specified in the SEC’s rules and forms. 
(b) Changes in Internal Controls Over Financial Reporting:  There was no change in our internal control over financial reporting during the 
fourth quarter of the period covered by this Form 10-K that has materially affected, or is reasonably likely to materially affect, our internal 
control over financial reporting. 
Management’s Annual Report on Internal Control over Financial Reporting:  Pursuant to Section 404 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002, we 
included a report of Management’s assessment of the effectiveness of its internal controls beginning on page 74 of this Annual Report on 
Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2024. The Company’s independent registered public accounting firm, Moss Adams LLP, which 
audited the consolidated financial statements as of and for the year ended December 31, 2024 (included in Item 8 of this annual report), has 
issued an audit report on the Company’s internal control over financial reporting beginning on page 75 of this Annual Report on Form 10-K. 
ITEM 9B – Other Information 
(a) None. 
(b) During the year ended December 31, 2023, there were no Rule 10b5-1 trading arrangements (as defined in Item 408(a) of Regulation S-K) 
or non-Rule 10b5-1 trading arrangements (as defined in Item 408(c) of Regulation S-K) adopted or terminated by any director or officer (as 
defined in Rule 16a-1(f) under the Exchange Act) of the Company. 
ITEM 9C-Disclosure Regarding Foreign Jurisdictions that Prevent Inspections 
Not applicable. 
Table of Contents 
65 

PART III 
ITEM 10 – Directors, Executive Officers and Corporate Governance 
The information required by this item is incorporated herein by reference to the sections captioned “Proposal 1– Election of Directors,” 
“Corporate Governance” and “Shareholder Proposals” in the Company’s 2025 Proxy Statement for the Annual Meeting of Shareholders (the 
Proxy Statement), which will be filed with the SEC no later than 120 days after the end of our fiscal year. 
Information regarding the executive officers of the Registrant is incorporated herein by reference to the section captioned “Information about 
our Executive Officers” in the Proxy Statement. 
The information regarding our Audit Committee and Financial Expert is incorporated herein by reference to the sections captioned “Corporate 
Governance” and “Audit Committee Matters” in the Proxy Statement. 
There have been no material changes to the procedures by which stockholders may recommend nominees to our board of directors since last 
disclosed to stockholders. 
Banner has adopted Policies and Procedures Governing Trading in Securities and Confidentiality of Insider Information for Directors, 
Officers and Employees (“Insider Trading Policy”). The Insider Trading Policy governs the purchase, sale and/or other disposition of our 
securities by directors, officers and employees and is reasonably designed to promote compliance with insider trading laws, rules and 
regulations and Nasdaq listing standards.  A copy of our Insider Trading Policy is files as Exhibit 19 to this report. 
Information regarding our policies and practices relating to equity awards is incorporated herein by reference to the section captioned 
“Compensation Discussion and Analysis” in the Proxy Statement. 
Code of Ethics 
The Board of Directors has adopted a Code of Ethics and Business Conduct for our directors, officers (including its senior financial officers) 
and employees. The Code of Ethics and Business Conduct is reviewed by the Board on an annual basis and was most recently approved by 
the Board of Directors on July 23, 2024. A copy of the Code of Ethics and Business Conduct in substantially its current form was filed as an 
exhibit with Form 8-K on September 18, 2023 and is available without charge, upon request to Investor Relations, Banner Corporation, P.O. 
Box 907, Walla Walla, WA 99362.  The Code of Ethics is also available on the Company’s website at www.bannerbank.com. 
We subscribe to the Ethicspoint reporting system and encourage employees, clients and vendors to call the Ethicspoint hotline at 1-866-
ETHICSP (384-4277) or visit its website at www.Ethicspoint.com to report any concerns regarding financial statement disclosures, 
accounting, internal controls, or auditing matters. We will not retaliate against any of our officers or employees who raise legitimate concerns 
or questions about an ethics matter or a suspected accounting, internal control, financial reporting, or auditing discrepancy or otherwise assists 
in investigations regarding conduct that the employee reasonably believes to be a violation of federal securities laws or any rule or regulation 
of the SEC, federal securities laws relating to fraud against shareholders or violations of applicable banking laws. Non-retaliation against 
employees is fundamental to our Code of Ethics and there are strong legal protections for those who, in good faith, raise an ethical concern or 
a complaint about their employer. 
ITEM 11 – Executive Compensation 
Information required by this item regarding management compensation and employment contracts, director compensation, and compensation 
committee interlocks and insider participation is incorporated by reference to the sections captioned “Executive Compensation,” “Directors’ 
Compensation,” and “Compensation Discussion and Analysis - Compensation and Human Capital Committee Interlocks and Insider 
Participation,” respectively, in the Proxy Statement. 
ITEM 12 – Security Ownership of Certain Beneficial Owners and Management and Related Stockholder Matters 
(a) Security Ownership of Certain Beneficial Owners and Management 
Information required by this item is incorporated herein by reference to the section captioned “Security Ownership of Certain Beneficial 
Owners and Management” in the Proxy Statement. 
(b) Security Ownership of Management 
Information required by this item is incorporated herein by reference to the section captioned “Security Ownership of Certain Beneficial 
Owners and Management” in the Proxy Statement. 
(c) Change in Control 
Banner is not aware of any arrangements, including any pledge by any person of securities of Banner, the operation of which may at a 
subsequent date result in a change in control of Banner. 
Table of Contents 
66 

(d) Equity Compensation Plan Information 
The following table sets forth information about equity compensation plans that were in effect at December 31, 2024: 
Plan category 
(A) 
Number of securities 
to be issued upon 
exercise of 
outstanding options, 
warrants and rights (1) 
(B) 
Weighted average 
exercise price of 
outstanding options, 
warrants and rights (1) 
(C) 
Number of securities 
remaining available 
for future issuance 
under equity 
compensation plans (2) 
Equity compensation plans approved by security holders 
443,882 
n/a 
721,693 
Equity compensation plans not approved by security holders 
— 
— 
— 
Total 
443,882 
721,693 
(1) 
Represents shares that are issuable pursuant to awards of restricted stock units for which there is no applicable exercise price. 
(2) 
All the securities remaining available for future issuance under the equity compensation plans approved by security holders are available 
for issuance as stock awards. 
ITEM 13 – Certain Relationships and Related Transactions, and Director Independence 
The information required by this item is incorporated herein by reference to the sections captioned “Related Party Transactions” and “Director 
Independence” in the Proxy Statement. 
ITEM 14 – Principal Accountant Fees and Services 
The information required by this item is incorporated herein by reference to the section captioned “Proposal 4– Ratification of Selection of 
Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm” in the Proxy Statement. 
Table of Contents 
67 

PART IV 
ITEM 15 – Exhibits and Financial Statement Schedules 
(1) 
Financial Statements 
See Index to Consolidated Financial Statements on page 72. 
(2) 
Financial Statement Schedules 
All financial statement schedules are omitted because they are not applicable or not required, or because the required information is 
included in the Consolidated Financial Statements or the Notes thereto or in Part 1, Item 1. 
(3) 
The exhibits filed as part of this Annual Report on Form 10-K and incorporated herein by reference to other documents are listed on 
the Index of Exhibits to this Annual Report on Form 10-K, immediately before the signatures. 
Table of Contents 
68 

Item 16 - Form 10-K Summary. 
None. 
BANNER CORPORATION 
Exhibit 
Index of Exhibits 
3{a} 
Restated Articles of Incorporation of Banner Corporation [incorporated by reference to Exhibit 3.1 (b) to the Registrant’s 
Current Report on Form 8-K filed on May 24, 2022 (File No. 000-26584)]. 
3{b} 
Amended and Restated Bylaws of Banner Corporation [incorporated by reference to Exhibit 3.2 to the Registrant’s Current 
Report on Form 8-K filed with the SEC on May 24, 2022 (File No. 000-26584)]. 
4.2 
Description of Capital Stock. 
4.3 
Issuance of base indenture, first supplemental indenture and subordinated note [incorporated by reference to the exhibits filed 
with Form 8-K on June 30, 2020 (File No. 000-26584)]. 
10{a}* 
Amended and Restated Employment Agreement, with Mark J. Grescovich [incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 to the 
Current Report on Form 8-K filed on June 4, 2013 (File No. 000-26584]. 
10{b}* 
Form of Supplemental Executive Retirement Program Agreement with Gary Sirmon, Michael K. Larsen, Lloyd W. Baker, 
Cynthia D. Purcell and Richard B. Barton [incorporated by reference to exhibits filed with the Annual Report on Form 10-K for 
the year ended December 31, 2001 and the exhibits filed with the Form 8-K on May 6, 2008 (File No. 000-26584)]. 
10{c}* 
Form of Employment Contract entered into with Peter J. Conner, Cynthia D. Purcell and Judith A. Steiner [incorporated by 
reference to exhibits filed with the Form 8-K on June 25, 2014 (File No. 000-26584)]. 
10{d}* 
2005 Executive Officer and Director Stock Account Deferred Compensation Plan [incorporated by reference to exhibits filed 
with the Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2008 (File No. 000-26584)]. 
10{e}* 
Entry into an Indemnification Agreement with each of the Registrant’s Directors [incorporated by reference to exhibits filed with 
the Form 8-K on January 29, 2010 (File No. 000-26584)]. 
10{f}* 
2014 Omnibus Incentive Plan [incorporated by reference as Appendix C to the Registrant’s Definitive Proxy Statement on 
Schedule 14A filed on March 24, 2014 (File No. 000-26584)] and amendments [incorporated by reference to the Form 8-K filed 
on March 25, 2015 (File No. 000-26584)]. 
10{g}* 
Forms of Equity-Based Award Agreements: Incentive Stock Option Award Agreement, Non-Qualified Stock Option Award 
Agreement, Restricted Stock Award Agreement, Restricted Stock Unit Award Agreement, Stock Appreciation Right Award 
Agreement, and Performance Unit Award Agreement [incorporated by reference to Exhibits 10.2 - 10.7 included in the 
Registration Statement on Form S-8 dated May 9, 2014 (File No. 333-195835)]. 
10{h}* 
2018 Omnibus Incentive Plan [incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 included in the Registration Statement on Form S-8 
dated May 4, 2018 (File No. 333-224693)]. 
10{i}* 
Amended and Restated Executive Severance and Change in Control Plan and Summary Plan Description (Amended and 
Restated effective as of July 1, 2023) [incorporated by reference to exhibit 10{j} included in the Form 10-Q dated June 30, 2023 
(File No. 000-26584)]. 
10{j}* 
2023 Omnibus Incentive Plan [incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 included in the Registration Statement on Form S-8 
dated August 30, 2023 (File No. 333-274273)]. 
10{k}* 
Form of Director Restricted Stock Award Agreement under the Banner Corporation 2023 Omnibus Incentive Plan [incorporated 
by reference to Exhibit 10.2 included in the Registration Statement on Form S-8 dated August 30, 2023 (File No. 333-274273)]. 
10{l}* 
Form of Director Restricted Stock Unit Award Agreement under the Banner Corporation 2023 Omnibus Incentive Plan 
[incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.3 included in the Registration Statement on Form S-8 dated August 30, 2023 (File No. 
333-274273)]. 
10{m}* 
Form of Employee Restricted Stock Unit Award Agreement under the Banner Corporation 2023 Omnibus Incentive Plan 
[incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.4 included in the Registration Statement on Form S-8 dated August 30, 2023 (File No. 
333-274273)]. 
10{n}* 
Form of Executive Restricted Stock Unit Performance Award Agreement under the Banner Corporation 2023 Omnibus Incentive 
Plan [incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.5 included in the Registration Statement on Form S-8 dated August 30, 2023 (File 
No. 333-274273)]. 
10{o}* 
2020 Banner Corporation Amended and Restated Deferred Compensation Plan [incorporated by reference to exhibits filed with 
the Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2023 (File No. 000-26584)]. 
14 
Code of Ethics [Registrant elects to satisfy Regulation S-K §229.406(c) by posting its Code of Ethics on its website at https:// 
investor.bannerbank.com/ in the section titled Corporate Overview: Governance Documents]. 
19 
Insider Trading Policies and Procedures. 
21 
Subsidiaries of the Registrant. 
Table of Contents 
69 

23.1 
Consent of Registered Independent Public Accounting Firm – Moss Adams LLP. 
31.1 
Certification of Chief Executive Officer pursuant to the Securities Exchange Act Rules 13a-14(a) and 15d-14(a) as adopted 
pursuant to Section 302 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002. 
31.2 
Certification of Chief Financial Officer pursuant to the Securities Exchange Act Rules 13a-14(a) and 15d-14(a) as adopted 
pursuant to Section 302 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002. 
32 
Certificate of Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer pursuant to Section 906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002. 
97 
Policy Relating to Recovery of Erroneously Awarded Compensation. [incorporated by reference to exhibits filed with the 
Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2023 (File No. 000-26584)] 
101.INS 
Inline XBRL Instance Document - The instance document does not appear in the interactive data file because XBRL tags are 
embedded within the XBRL document. 
101.SCH Inline XBRL Taxonomy Extension Schema Document. 
101.CAL Inline XBRL Taxonomy Extension Calculation Linkbase Document. 
101.DEF Inline XBRL Taxonomy Extension Definition Linkbase Document. 
101.LAB Inline XBRL Taxonomy Extension Label Linkbase Document. 
101.PRE Inline XBRL Taxonomy Extension Presentation Linkbase Document. 
104 
The cover page from the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2024, formatted in Inline 
XBRL (included in Exhibit 101). 
* Compensatory plan or arrangement. 
Table of Contents 
70 

Signatures 
Pursuant to the requirements of Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, the registrant has duly caused this report to be 
signed on its behalf by the undersigned, thereunto duly authorized. 
Banner Corporation 
Date:  February 26, 2025 
/s/ Mark J. Grescovich 
Mark J. Grescovich 
President and Chief Executive Officer 
(Principal Executive Officer) 
Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, this report has been signed below by the following persons on behalf 
of the registrant and in the capacities and on the dates indicated. 
/s/ Mark J. Grescovich 
Mark J. Grescovich 
President and Chief Executive Officer; Director 
(Principal Executive Officer) 
Date:  February 26, 2025 
/s/ John R. Layman 
John R. Layman 
Director 
Date:  February 26, 2025 
/s/ Connie R. Collingsworth 
Connie R. Collingsworth 
Director 
Date:  February 26, 2025 
/s/ Margot J. Copeland 
Margot J. Copeland 
Director 
Date:  February 26, 2025 
/s/ Terry Schwakopf 
Terry Schwakopf 
Director 
Date:  February 26, 2025 
/s/ Roberto R. Herencia 
Roberto R. Herencia 
Chairman of the Board 
Date:  February 26, 2025 
/s/ Robert G. Butterfield 
Robert G. Butterfield 
Executive Vice President, Treasurer and Chief Financial 
Officer 
(Principal Financial and Accounting Officer) 
Date:  February 26, 2025 
/s/ Paul J. Walsh 
Paul J. Walsh 
Director 
Date:  February 26, 2025 
/s/ Ellen R.M. Boyer 
Ellen R.M. Boyer 
Director 
Date:  February 26, 2025 
/s/ David A. Klaue 
David A. Klaue 
Director 
Date:  February 26, 2025 
/s/ Kevin F. Riordan 
Kevin F. Riordan 
Director 
Date:  February 26, 2025 
/s/ John Pedersen 
John Pedersen 
Director 
Date:  February 26, 2025 
Table of Contents 
71 

INDEX TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 
BANNER CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES 
(Item 8 and Item 15(a)(1)) 
Page 
Report of Management  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 
73 
Management Report on Internal Control Over Financial Reporting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 
74 
Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm (Moss Adams LLP, Portland, Oregon, PCAOB ID: 659) . . . . . . . . . . . 
75 
Consolidated Statements of Financial Condition  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 
77 
Consolidated Statements of Operations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 
78 
Consolidated Statements of Comprehensive Income (Loss) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 
79 
Consolidated Statements of Changes in Shareholders’ Equity  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 
80 
Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 
81 
Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 
83 
Table of Contents 
72 

February 26, 2025 
Report of Management 
To the Shareholders: 
The management of Banner Corporation (the Company) is responsible for the preparation, integrity, and fair presentation of its published 
financial statements and all other information presented in this annual report. The financial statements have been prepared in accordance with 
accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America and, as such, include amounts based on informed judgments and 
estimates made by Management. In the opinion of Management, the financial statements and other information herein present fairly the 
financial condition and operations of the Company at the dates indicated in conformity with accounting principles generally accepted in the 
United States of America. 
Management is responsible for establishing and maintaining an effective system of internal control over financial reporting. The internal 
control system is augmented by written policies and procedures and by audits performed by an internal audit staff (assisted in certain 
instances by contracted external audit resources other than the independent registered public accounting firm), which reports to the Audit 
Committee of the Board of Directors.  Internal auditors monitor the operation of the internal and external control system and report findings to 
Management and the Audit Committee. When appropriate, corrective actions are taken to address identified control deficiencies and other 
opportunities for improving the system. The Audit Committee provides oversight to the financial reporting process. There are inherent 
limitations in the effectiveness of any system of internal control, including the possibility of human error and circumvention or overriding of 
controls. Accordingly, even an effective internal control system can provide only reasonable assurance with respect to financial statement 
preparation.  Further, because of changes in conditions, the effectiveness of an internal control system may vary over time. 
The Audit Committee of the Board of Directors is comprised entirely of outside directors who are independent of the Company’s 
management. The Audit Committee is responsible for the selection of the independent auditors. It meets periodically with Management, the 
independent auditors and the internal auditors to ensure that they are carrying out their responsibilities. The Committee is also responsible for 
performing an oversight role by reviewing and monitoring the financial, accounting, and auditing procedures of the Company in addition to 
reviewing the Company’s financial reports. The independent auditors and the internal auditors have full and free access to the Audit 
Committee, with or without the presence of Management, to discuss the adequacy of the internal control structure for financial reporting and 
any other matters which they believe should be brought to the attention of the Committee. 
Mark J. Grescovich, Chief Executive Officer 
Robert G. Butterfield, Chief Financial Officer 
Table of Contents 
73 

Management Report on Internal Control over Financial Reporting 
February 26, 2025 
The management of Banner Corporation is responsible for establishing and maintaining adequate internal control over financial reporting as 
defined in Rule 13a-15(f) under the Securities Exchange Act of 1934. The Company’s internal control system is designed to provide 
reasonable assurance to our Management and Board of Directors regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of 
financial statements for external purposes in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles. The Company’s internal control over 
financial reporting includes those policies and procedures that: 
Pertain to the maintenance of records that, in reasonable detail, accurately and fairly reflect the transactions and dispositions of the 
Company’s assets; 
Provide reasonable assurance that transactions are recorded as necessary to permit preparation of financial statements in accordance 
with generally accepted accounting principles, and that receipts and expenditures of the Company are being made only in 
accordance with the authorizations of Management and directors of the Company; and 
Provide reasonable assurance regarding prevention or timely detection of unauthorized acquisition, use or disposition of the 
Company’s assets that could have a material effect on the financial statements. 
Because of its inherent limitations, including the possibility of human error and circumvention or overriding of controls, internal control over 
financial reporting may not prevent or detect misstatements. Also, projections of any evaluation of effectiveness to future periods are subject 
to the risk that controls may become inadequate because of changes in conditions, or that the degree of compliance with the policies or 
procedures may deteriorate. 
Management assessed the effectiveness of the Company’s internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2024. This assessment 
was based on the criteria set forth by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission in Internal Control - 
Integrated Framework (2013). Based on this assessment and those criteria, Management believes that, as of December 31, 2024, the 
Company maintained effective internal control over financial reporting. 
The Company’s independent registered public accounting firm has audited the Company’s Consolidated Financial Statements that are 
included in this annual report and the effectiveness of our internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2024, and issued their 
Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm, appearing under Item 8. The audit report expresses an unqualified opinion on the 
effectiveness of the Company’s internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2024. 
Table of Contents 
74 

Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm 
To the Shareholders and the Board of Directors of 
Banner Corporation and Subsidiaries 
Opinions on the Financial Statements and Internal Control over Financial Reporting 
We have audited the accompanying consolidated statements of financial condition of Banner Corporation and subsidiaries (the “Company”) 
as of December 31, 2024 and 2023, the related consolidated statements of operations, comprehensive income (loss), changes in shareholders’ 
equity and cash flows for each of the three years in the period ended December 31, 2024, and the related notes (collectively referred to as the 
“consolidated financial statements”). We also have audited the Company’s internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2024, 
based on criteria established in Internal Control - Integrated Framework (2013) issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the 
Treadway Commission (COSO). 
In our opinion, the consolidated financial statements referred to above present fairly, in all material respects, the consolidated financial 
position of the Company as of December 31, 2024 and 2023, and the consolidated results of its operations and its cash flows for each of the 
three years in the period ended December 31, 2024, in conformity with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of 
America. Also in our opinion, the Company maintained, in all material respects, effective internal control over financial reporting as of 
December 31, 2024, based on criteria established in Internal Control - Integrated Framework (2013) issued by COSO. 
Basis for Opinions 
The Company’s management is responsible for these consolidated financial statements, for maintaining effective internal control over 
financial reporting, and for its assessment of the effectiveness of internal control over financial reporting, included in the accompanying 
Management Report on Internal Control over Financial Reporting. Our responsibility is to express an opinion on the Company’s consolidated 
financial statements and an opinion on the Company’s internal control over financial reporting based on our audits. We are a public 
accounting firm registered with the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States) (“PCAOB”) and are required to be 
independent with respect to the Company in accordance with the U.S. federal securities laws and the applicable rules and regulations of the 
Securities and Exchange Commission and the PCAOB. 
We conducted our audits in accordance with the standards of the PCAOB. Those standards require that we plan and perform the audits to 
obtain reasonable assurance about whether the consolidated financial statements are free of material misstatement, whether due to error or 
fraud, and whether effective internal control over financial reporting was maintained in all material respects. 
Our audits of the consolidated financial statements included performing procedures to assess the risks of material misstatement of the 
consolidated financial statements, whether due to error or fraud, and performing procedures to respond to those risks. Such procedures 
included examining, on a test basis, evidence regarding the amounts and disclosures in the consolidated financial statements. Our audits also 
included evaluating the accounting principles used and significant estimates made by management, as well as evaluating the overall 
presentation of the consolidated financial statements. Our audit of internal control over financial reporting included obtaining an 
understanding of internal control over financial reporting, assessing the risk that a material weakness exists, and testing and evaluating the 
design and operating effectiveness of internal control based on the assessed risk. Our audits also included performing such other procedures as 
we considered necessary in the circumstances. We believe that our audits provide a reasonable basis for our opinions. 
Definition and Limitations of Internal Control Over Financial Reporting 
A company’s internal control over financial reporting is a process designed to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of 
financial reporting and the preparation of financial statements for external purposes in accordance with generally accepted accounting 
principles. A company’s internal control over financial reporting includes those policies and procedures that (1) pertain to the maintenance of 
records that, in reasonable detail, accurately and fairly reflect the transactions and dispositions of the assets of the company; (2) provide 
reasonable assurance that transactions are recorded as necessary to permit preparation of financial statements in accordance with generally 
accepted accounting principles, and that receipts and expenditures of the company are being made only in accordance with authorizations of 
management and directors of the company; and (3) provide reasonable assurance regarding prevention or timely detection of unauthorized 
acquisition, use, or disposition of the company’s assets that could have a material effect on the financial statements. 
Because of its inherent limitations, internal control over financial reporting may not prevent or detect misstatements. Also, projections of any 
evaluation of effectiveness to future periods are subject to the risk that controls may become inadequate because of changes in conditions, or 
that the degree of compliance with the policies or procedures may deteriorate. 
Table of Contents 
75 

Critical Audit Matter 
As described in Notes 1 and 4 to the consolidated financial statements, the balance of the Company’s consolidated allowance for credit losses 
– loans, was $155.5 million at December 31, 2024. The allowance for credit losses – loans is a valuation account that is deducted from the 
amortized cost basis of loans held for investment to present the net carrying value at the amount expected to be collected on such financial 
assets. The measurement of expected credit losses is based on relevant information about past events, current conditions, and reasonable and 
supportable forecasts. The allowance for credit losses – loans is maintained at a level sufficient to provide for expected credit losses based on 
evaluating historical credit loss experience and making adjustments to historical loss information for differences in the specific risk 
characteristics in the current loan portfolio. Management considers qualitative and environmental factors for each loan category to adjust for 
differences between the historical periods used to calculate historical loss rates and expected conditions over the remaining lives of the loans 
in the portfolio. These factors include, among others, changes in the size and composition of the loan portfolio, differences in underwriting 
standards, delinquency rates, and economic conditions.  
We identified the estimation of qualitative and environmental factors used in the allowance for credit losses – loans as a critical audit matter. 
The qualitative and environmental factors are used to estimate credit losses related to matters that are not captured in the historical loss rates 
and are based on management’s evaluation of available internal and external data. Auditing management’s judgments regarding the 
qualitative and environmental factors applied to the allowance for credit losses - loans involved especially challenging and subjective auditor 
judgment when performing audit procedures and evaluating the results of those procedures. 
Addressing the matter involved performing procedures and evaluating audit evidence in connection with forming our overall opinion on the 
consolidated financial statements. Our audit procedures related to the critical audit matter included the following, among others: 
•
Testing the design, implementation, and operating effectiveness of controls relating to management’s calculation of the allowance 
for credit losses – loans, including controls over the identification and assessment of the qualitative and environmental factors used. 
•
Obtaining management’s analysis and supporting documentation related to the qualitative and environmental factors and testing 
whether the environmental and qualitative factors used in the calculation of the allowance for credit losses – loans are supported by 
the analysis provided by management. 
•
Testing the appropriateness of the methodology and assumptions used in the calculation of the allowance for credit losses – loans, 
testing completeness and accuracy of the data used in the calculation, testing estimation and application of the environmental and 
qualitative factors determined by management and used in the calculation, and recalculating the balance of allowance for credit 
losses – loans. 
/s/ Moss Adams LLP 
Portland, Oregon 
February 26, 2025 
We have served as the Company’s auditor since 2004. 
Table of Contents 
76 

BANNER CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES 
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF FINANCIAL CONDITION 
(in thousands, except shares and per share amounts) 
December 31, 2024 and 2023 
ASSETS 
December 31, 
2024 
December 31, 
2023 
Cash and due from banks 
$ 
203,402 
$ 
209,634 
Interest-bearing deposits 
298,456 
44,830 
Total cash and cash equivalents 
501,858 
254,464 
Securities—available-for-sale; amortized cost $2,460,262 and $2,729,980, respectively 
2,104,511 
2,373,783 
Securities—held-to-maturity, net of allowance for credit losses of $297 and $332, respectively 
1,001,564 
1,059,055 
Total securities 
3,106,075 
3,432,838 
Federal Home Loan Bank (FHLB) stock 
22,451 
24,028 
Loans held for sale (includes $26,185 and $9,105, at fair value, respectively) 
32,021 
11,170 
Loans receivable 
11,354,656 
10,810,455 
Allowance for credit losses – loans 
(155,521) 
(149,643) 
Net loans receivable 
11,199,135 
10,660,812 
Accrued interest receivable 
60,885 
63,100 
Property and equipment, net 
124,589 
132,231 
Goodwill 
373,121 
373,121 
Other intangibles, net 
3,058 
5,684 
Bank-owned life insurance (BOLI) 
312,549 
304,366 
Deferred tax assets, net 
148,858 
153,365 
Operating lease right-of-use assets 
39,998 
43,731 
Other assets 
275,439 
211,481 
Total assets 
$ 
16,200,037 
$ 
15,670,391 
LIABILITIES 
Deposits: 
Non-interest-bearing 
$ 
4,591,543 
$ 
4,792,369 
Interest-bearing transaction and savings accounts 
7,423,183 
6,759,661 
Interest-bearing certificates 
1,499,672 
1,477,467 
Total deposits 
13,514,398 
13,029,497 
Advances from FHLB 
290,000 
323,000 
Other borrowings 
125,257 
182,877 
Subordinated notes, net 
80,278 
92,851 
Junior subordinated debentures at fair value (issued in connection with Trust Preferred Securities) 
67,477 
66,413 
Operating lease liabilities 
43,472 
48,659 
Accrued expenses and other liabilities 
258,070 
228,428 
Deferred compensation 
46,759 
45,975 
Total liabilities 
14,425,711 
14,017,700 
COMMITMENTS AND CONTINGENCIES (Note 18) 
SHAREHOLDERS’ EQUITY 
Preferred stock - $0.01 par value per share, 500,000 shares authorized; no shares outstanding at December 31, 
2024 and December 31, 2023 
— 
— 
Common stock and paid in capital - $0.01 par value per share, 50,000,000 shares authorized; 34,459,832 
shares issued and outstanding at December 31, 2024; 34,348,369 shares issued and outstanding at 
December 31, 2023 
1,307,509 
1,299,651 
Common stock (non-voting) and paid in capital - $0.01 par value per share, 5,000,000 shares authorized; no 
shares issued and outstanding at December 31, 2024 and December 31, 2023 
— 
— 
Retained earnings 
744,091 
642,175 
Carrying value of shares held in trust for stock-based compensation plans 
(6,194) 
(6,563) 
Liability for common stock issued to stock related compensation plans 
6,194 
6,563 
Accumulated other comprehensive loss 
(277,274) 
(289,135) 
Total shareholders’ equity 
1,774,326 
1,652,691 
Total liabilities and shareholders’ equity 
$ 
16,200,037 
$ 
15,670,391 
Table of Contents 
77 
See Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements 

BANNER CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES 
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF OPERATIONS 
(in thousands except for shares and per share amounts) 
For the Years Ended December 31, 2024, 2023 and 2022 
2024 
2023 
2022 
INTEREST INCOME: 
Loans receivable 
$ 
655,590 
$ 
577,891 
$ 
450,916 
Mortgage-backed securities 
66,085 
72,352 
67,585 
Securities and cash equivalents 
44,428 
51,329 
54,068 
Total interest income 
766,103 
701,572 
572,569 
INTEREST EXPENSE: 
Deposits 
199,465 
100,126 
10,124 
FHLB advances 
8,941 
10,524 
489 
Other borrowings 
4,299 
3,376 
377 
Subordinated debt 
11,682 
11,541 
8,400 
Total interest expense 
224,387 
125,567 
19,390 
Net interest income 
541,716 
576,005 
553,179 
PROVISION FOR CREDIT LOSSES 
7,581 
10,789 
10,364 
Net interest income after provision for credit losses 
534,135 
565,216 
542,815 
NON-INTEREST INCOME 
Deposit fees and other service charges 
43,371 
41,638 
44,459 
Mortgage banking operations 
12,207 
11,817 
10,834 
BOLI 
9,193 
9,245 
7,794 
Miscellaneous 
8,289 
5,169 
6,805 
73,060 
67,869 
69,892 
Net loss on sale of securities 
(5,190) 
(19,242) 
(3,248) 
Net change in valuation of financial instruments carried at fair value 
(982) 
(4,218) 
807 
Gain on sale of branches, including related deposits 
— 
— 
7,804 
Total non-interest income 
66,888 
44,409 
75,255 
NON-INTEREST EXPENSE: 
Salary and employee benefits 
250,555 
244,563 
242,266 
Less capitalized loan origination costs 
(16,857) 
(16,257) 
(24,313) 
Occupancy and equipment 
48,771 
47,886 
52,018 
Information and computer data services 
29,165 
28,445 
25,986 
Payment and card processing services 
22,518 
20,547 
21,195 
Professional and legal expenses 
7,858 
9,830 
14,005 
Advertising and marketing 
5,149 
4,794 
3,959 
Deposit insurance 
11,398 
10,529 
6,649 
State and municipal business and use taxes 
5,648 
5,260 
4,693 
Real estate operations, net 
293 
(538) 
(104) 
Amortization of core deposit intangibles 
2,626 
3,756 
5,279 
Loss on extinguishment of debt 
— 
— 
793 
Miscellaneous 
24,414 
23,723 
24,869 
Total non-interest expense 
391,538 
382,538 
377,295 
Income before provision for income taxes 
209,485 
227,087 
240,775 
PROVISION FOR INCOME TAXES 
40,587 
43,463 
45,397 
NET INCOME 
$ 
168,898 
$ 
183,624 
$ 
195,378 
Earnings per common share: 
Basic 
$ 
4.90 
$ 
5.35 
$ 
5.70 
Diluted 
$ 
4.88 
$ 
5.33 
$ 
5.67 
Cumulative dividends declared per common share 
$ 
1.92 
$ 
1.92 
$ 
1.76 
Weighted average number of common shares outstanding: 
Basic 
34,470,057 
34,344,142 
34,264,322 
Diluted 
34,628,710 
34,450,412 
34,459,922 
Table of Contents 
78 
See Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements 

BANNER CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES 
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF COMPREHENSIVE INCOME (LOSS) 
(in thousands) 
For the Years Ended December 31, 2024, 2023 and 2022 
2024 
2023 
2022 
NET INCOME 
$ 
168,898 
$ 
183,624 
$ 
195,378 
OTHER COMPREHENSIVE INCOME (LOSS), NET OF INCOME TAXES: 
Unrealized holding (loss) gain on securities—available-for-sale arising during the 
period 
(5,047) 
54,307 
(418,827) 
Income tax benefit (expense) related to securities—available-for-sale unrealized 
holding losses 
1,211 
(13,034) 
100,518 
Reclassification for net loss on securities—available-for-sale realized in earnings 
5,493 
19,242 
3,248 
Income tax benefit related to securities—available-for-sale realized in earnings 
(1,318) 
(4,618) 
(780) 
Unrealized loss on securities transferred from available-for-sale to held-to-maturity 
— 
— 
(34,596) 
Income tax benefit related to securities transferred from available-for-sale to held-
to-maturity 
— 
— 
8,303 
Amortization of unrealized loss on securities transferred from available-for-sale to 
held-to-maturity 
2,296 
2,338 
2,625 
Income tax benefit related to amortization of unrealized loss on securities 
transferred from available-for-sale to held-to-maturity 
(551) 
(561) 
(630) 
Net unrealized gain (loss) on interest rate swaps used in cash flow hedges 
13,929 
12,557 
(25,223) 
Income tax (expense) benefit related to interest rate swaps used in cash flow 
hedges 
(3,343) 
(3,014) 
6,054 
Changes in fair value of junior subordinated debentures related to instrument 
specific credit risk 
(1,064) 
8,444 
(5,560) 
Income tax benefit (expense) related to junior subordinated debentures 
255 
(2,027) 
1,334 
Reclassification of fair value of junior subordinated debentures redeemed 
— 
— 
765 
Income tax expense related to junior subordinated debentures redeemed 
— 
— 
(184) 
Other comprehensive income (loss) 
11,861 
73,634 
(362,953) 
COMPREHENSIVE INCOME (LOSS) 
$ 
180,759 
$ 
257,258 
$ 
(167,575) 
Table of Contents 
79 
See Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements 

BANNER CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES 
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF CHANGES IN SHAREHOLDERS’ EQUITY 
(in thousands, except shares and per share amounts) 
For the Years Ended December 31, 2024, 2023 and 2022 
Common Stock and Paid in Capital 
Retained 
Earnings 
Accumulated 
Other 
Comprehensive 
Income (Loss) 
Total 
Shareholders’ 
Equity
Shares 
Amount 
Balance, January 1, 2022 
34,252,632 
$ 
1,299,381 
$ 
390,762 
$ 
184 
$ 
1,690,327 
Net income 
195,378 
195,378 
Other comprehensive loss, net of income tax 
(362,953) 
(362,953) 
Accrual of dividends on common stock ($1.76/share-cumulative) 
(60,898) 
(60,898) 
Repurchase of common stock 
(200,000) 
(10,960) 
(10,960) 
Amortization of stock-based compensation related to restricted stock grants, net of shares 
surrendered 
141,386 
5,538 
5,538 
Balance, December 31, 2022 
34,194,018 
$ 
1,293,959 
$ 
525,242 
$ 
(362,769) $ 
1,456,432 
Balance, January 1, 2023 
34,194,018 
$ 
1,293,959 
$ 
525,242 
$ 
(362,769) $ 
1,456,432 
Net income 
183,624 
183,624 
Other comprehensive income, net of income tax 
73,634 
73,634 
Accrual of dividends on common stock ($1.92/share-cumulative) 
(66,691) 
(66,691) 
Amortization of stock-based compensation related to restricted stock grants, net of shares 
surrendered 
154,351 
5,692 
5,692 
Balance, December 31, 2023 
34,348,369 
$ 
1,299,651 
$ 
642,175 
$ 
(289,135) $ 
1,652,691 
Balance, January 1, 2024 
34,348,369 
$ 
1,299,651 
$ 
642,175 
$ 
(289,135) $ 
1,652,691 
Net income 
168,898 
168,898 
Other comprehensive income, net of income tax 
11,861 
11,861 
Accrual of dividends on common stock ($1.92/share-cumulative) 
(66,982) 
(66,982) 
Amortization of stock-based compensation related to restricted stock grants, net of shares 
surrendered 
111,463 
7,858 
7,858 
Balance, December 31, 2024 
34,459,832 
$ 
1,307,509 
$ 
744,091 
$ 
(277,274) $ 
1,774,326 
See Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements 
Table of Contents 
80 

BANNER CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES 
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF CASH FLOWS 
(in thousands) 
For the Years Ended December 31, 2024, 2023 and 2022 
2024 
2023 
2022 
OPERATING ACTIVITIES: 
Net income 
$ 
168,898 
$ 
183,624 
$ 
195,378 
Adjustments to reconcile net income to net cash provided from operating activities: 
Depreciation 
18,076 
17,873 
16,933 
Deferred income and expense, net of amortization 
(7,999) 
(4,194) 
(3,757) 
Capitalized loan servicing rights, net of amortization 
1,372 
1,830 
1,326 
Amortization of core deposit intangibles 
2,626 
3,756 
5,279 
Loss on sale of securities, net 
5,190 
19,242 
3,248 
Net change in valuation of financial instruments carried at fair value 
982 
4,218 
(807) 
Gain on sale of branches, including related deposits 
— 
— 
(7,804) 
Decrease in deferred taxes 
762 
1,514 
7,624 
Increase (decrease) in current taxes payable 
6,297 
(3,170) 
8,250 
Stock-based compensation 
10,031 
9,169 
8,870 
Net change in cash surrender value of BOLI 
(9,032) 
(8,742) 
(7,100) 
Gain on sale of loans, excluding capitalized servicing rights 
(6,180) 
(6,151) 
(4,556) 
(Gain) loss on disposal of real estate held for sale and property and equipment, net 
(318) 
(352) 
102 
Provision for credit losses 
7,581 
10,789 
10,364 
Loss on extinguishment of debt 
— 
— 
765 
Origination of loans held for sale 
(298,184) 
(242,844) 
(406,915) 
Proceeds from sales of loans held for sale 
414,807 
266,540 
415,635 
Net change in: 
Other assets 
(35,288) 
(8,968) 
(39,028) 
Other liabilities 
13,566 
13,065 
34,244 
Net cash provided from operating activities 
293,187 
257,199 
238,051 
INVESTING ACTIVITIES: 
Purchases of securities—available-for-sale 
(63,170) 
(58,173) 
(659,905) 
Principal repayments and maturities of securities—available-for-sale 
241,427 
173,055 
368,996 
Proceeds from sales of securities—available-for-sale 
70,777 
368,945 
214,335 
Purchases of securities—held-to-maturity 
— 
— 
(190,645) 
Principal repayments and maturities of securities—held-to-maturity 
57,656 
58,406 
56,056 
Loan (originations) repayments, net 
(686,508) 
(643,959) 
(897,505) 
Purchases of loans and participating interest in loans 
(4,666) 
— 
(126,556) 
Proceeds from sales of other loans 
20,522 
14,038 
14,034 
Net cash paid related to branch divestiture 
— 
— 
(168,137) 
Purchases of property and equipment 
(13,747) 
(14,651) 
(14,724) 
Proceeds from sale of real estate held for sale and sale of other property 
4,323 
4,669 
6,088 
Proceeds from FHLB stock repurchase program 
146,162 
153,397 
15,080 
Purchase of FHLB stock 
(144,585) 
(165,425) 
(15,080) 
Proceeds from maturity of securities purchased under agreements to resell 
— 
300,000 
— 
Investment in bank-owned life insurance 
(47) 
(66) 
(50,053) 
Other 
686 
1,693 
3,459 
Net cash (used by) provided from investing activities 
(371,170) 
191,929 
(1,444,557) 
(Continued on next page) 
Table of Contents 
81 

BANNER CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES 
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF CASH FLOWS 
(continued) (in thousands) 
For the Years Ended December 31, 2024, 2023 and 2022 
2024 
2023 
2022 
FINANCING ACTIVITIES: 
Increase (decrease) in deposits, net 
484,901 
(590,562) 
(528,672) 
Repayment of long term FHLB borrowing 
— 
— 
(50,000) 
(Repayment) advances of overnight and short-term FHLB borrowings, net 
(33,000) 
273,000 
50,000 
Decrease in other borrowings, net 
(57,619) 
(49,923) 
(31,690) 
Repayment of junior subordinated debentures 
— 
— 
(50,518) 
Proceeds from redemption of trust preferred securities related to junior subordinated 
debentures 
— 
— 
1,518 
Cash dividends paid 
(66,733) 
(66,765) 
(61,078) 
Cash paid for repurchase of common stock 
— 
— 
(10,960) 
Taxes paid related to net share settlement of equity awards 
(2,172) 
(3,476) 
(3,332) 
Net cash provided from (used by) financing activities 
325,377 
(437,726) 
(684,732) 
NET CHANGE IN CASH AND CASH EQUIVALENTS 
247,394 
11,402 
(1,891,238) 
CASH AND CASH EQUIVALENTS, BEGINNING OF YEAR 
254,464 
243,062 
2,134,300 
CASH AND CASH EQUIVALENTS, END OF YEAR 
$ 
501,858 
$ 
254,464 
$ 
243,062 
2024 
2023 
2022 
SUPPLEMENTAL DISCLOSURES OF CASH FLOW INFORMATION: 
Interest paid in cash 
$ 
224,808 
$ 
110,845 
$ 
18,583 
Taxes paid 
24,194 
38,671 
24,885 
NON-CASH INVESTING AND FINANCING TRANSACTIONS: 
Transfer of loans to real estate owned and other repossessed assets 
2,832 
1,185 
— 
Dividends accrued but not paid until after period end 
1,334 
1,084 
1,158 
Loans, held for sale, transferred (from) to portfolio 
(131,294) 
27,929 
35,466 
Securities, held-for-trading, transferred to available-for-sale 
— 
25,298 
— 
Securities, available-for-sale, transferred to held-to-maturity 
— 
— 
462,159 
DISPOSITIONS: 
Assets divested 
— 
— 
(1,539) 
Liabilities divested 
— 
— 
(178,209) 
See Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements 
Table of Contents 
82 

BANNER CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 
Note 1: BASIS OF PRESENTATION AND SUMMARY OF SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES 
  
Nature of Business: Banner Corporation (Banner or the Company) is a bank holding company incorporated in the State of Washington. The 
Company is primarily engaged in the business of planning, directing and coordinating the business activities of its wholly-owned subsidiary, 
Banner Bank (the Bank). The Bank is a Washington-chartered commercial bank that conducts business from its headquarters in Walla Walla, 
Washington and its 135 branch offices located in Washington, Oregon, California and Idaho. The Bank also has 13 loan production offices 
located in Washington, Oregon, California, Idaho and Utah. Banner is subject to regulation by the Board of Governors of the Federal Reserve 
System (the Federal Reserve Board). The Bank is subject to regulation by the Washington State Department of Financial Institutions, 
Division of Banks (the DFI) and the Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation (the FDIC). 
  
Basis of Presentation and Principles of Consolidation: The consolidated financial statements include the accounts of the Company and its 
wholly-owned subsidiary. All material intercompany transactions, profits and balances have been eliminated. The consolidated financial 
statements of the Company have been prepared in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles in the United States (GAAP) and 
under the rules and regulations of the U.S. Securities and Exchange Commission (the SEC). At December 31, 2024, the Company had five 
wholly-owned subsidiary grantor trusts (the Trusts), each of which issued trust preferred securities (TPS) and common securities. The Trusts 
are not consolidated in the Company’s consolidated financial statements. 
  
Operating Segments: The Company’s operations are managed, and financial performance is evaluated, by our chief operating decision 
maker on a Company-wide basis. The Bank’s primary business is that of a traditional banking institution, gathering deposits and originating 
loans for portfolio in its primary market areas. The Bank offers a wide variety of deposit products to its consumer and commercial 
clients. Lending activities include the origination of real estate, commercial/agriculture business and consumer loans. The performance of 
the Company is reviewed monthly by the Company’s executive management and Board of Directors. As resource allocation and performance 
decisions are not made based on discrete financial information of individual lines of business, the Company considers its current business and 
operations as a single reportable operating segment. 
  
Subsequent Events: The Company has evaluated events and transactions subsequent to December 31, 2024 through the date that the 
consolidated financial statements were issued for potential recognition or disclosure. 
  
Cash and Cash Equivalents: Cash and cash equivalents include cash and due from banks and temporary investments which are federal funds 
sold and interest bearing balances due from other banks. Cash and cash equivalents generally have maturities of three months or less at the 
date of purchase. 
Business Combinations: Business combinations are accounted for using the acquisition method of accounting and, accordingly, assets 
acquired and liabilities assumed, both tangible and intangible, and consideration exchanged are recorded at acquisition date fair values. The 
excess purchase consideration over fair value of net assets acquired is recorded as goodwill. In the event that the fair value of net assets 
acquired exceeds the purchase price, including fair value of liabilities assumed, a bargain purchase gain is recorded on that acquisition.  
Expenses incurred in connection with a business combination are expensed as incurred, except for those items permitted to be capitalized.  
Changes in deferred tax asset valuation allowances related to acquired tax uncertainties are recognized in net income after the measurement 
period. 
  
Use of Estimates: 
In the opinion of Management, the accompanying Consolidated Statements of Financial Condition and related 
Consolidated Statements of Operations, Comprehensive Income (Loss), Changes in Shareholders’ Equity and Cash Flows reflect all 
adjustments (which include reclassification and normal recurring adjustments) that are necessary for a fair presentation in conformity with 
GAAP. The preparation of financial statements in conformity with GAAP requires Management to make estimates and assumptions that 
affect amounts reported in the financial statements. 
Various elements of the Company’s accounting policies, by their nature, are inherently subject to estimation techniques, valuation 
assumptions and other subjective assessments. Management has identified several accounting policies that, due to the judgments, estimates 
and assumptions inherent in those policies, are critical to an understanding of Banner’s Consolidated Financial Statements. These policies 
relate to (i) determination of the provision and allowance for credit losses, (ii) the valuation of financial assets and liabilities recorded at fair 
value, and (iii) the valuation or recognition of deferred tax assets and liabilities. Management believes that the judgments, estimates and 
assumptions used in the preparation of the consolidated financial statements are appropriate based on the factual circumstances at the 
time. However, given the sensitivity of the Consolidated Financial Statements to these critical accounting estimates, the use of judgments, 
estimates and assumptions could result in material differences in the Company’s results of operations or financial condition. Further, 
subsequent changes in economic or market conditions could have a material impact on these estimates and the Company’s financial condition 
and operating results in future periods. 
Table of Contents 
83 

Securities: Debt securities are classified as held-to-maturity when the Company has the ability and positive intent to hold them to 
maturity. 
Debt securities classified as available-for-sale are available for future liquidity requirements and may be sold prior to 
maturity. Debt securities classified as trading are also available for future liquidity requirements and may be sold prior to maturity. Purchase 
premiums and discounts are recognized in interest income using the interest method over the terms of the securities. Debt securities classified 
as held-to-maturity are carried at cost, net of the allowance for credit losses - securities, adjusted for amortization of premiums to the earliest 
callable date and accretion of discounts to maturity. Debt securities classified as available-for-sale are measured at fair value. Unrealized 
holding gains and losses on debt securities classified as available-for-sale are excluded from earnings and are reported net of tax as 
accumulated other comprehensive income (AOCI), a component of shareholders’ equity, until realized. Debt securities classified as trading 
are also measured at fair value. Unrealized holding gains and losses on securities classified as trading are included in earnings. Realized 
gains and losses on sale are computed on the specific identification method and are included in earnings on the trade date sold. Equity 
securities are measured at fair value with changes in the fair value recognized through net income. 
  
Allowance for Credit Losses - Securities: Management measures expected credit losses on held-to-maturity debt securities on a collective 
basis by major security type. The Company’s held-to maturity portfolio contains mortgage-backed securities issued by U.S. government 
entities and agencies. These securities are either explicitly or implicitly guaranteed by the U.S. government and have a long history of no 
credit losses. The Company’s held-to-maturity portfolio also contains municipal bonds that are typically rated by major rating agencies as Aa 
or better. The Company has never incurred a loss on a municipal bond, therefore the expectation of credit losses on these securities is 
insignificant. The Company uses industry historical credit loss information adjusted for current conditions to establish the allowance for 
credit losses on the municipal bond portfolio. The expected credit losses on these bonds are similar to Banner’s commercial business loan 
portfolio. Therefore, the Company uses the commercial business loan portfolio loss rates to establish the allowance for credit losses on the 
collateralized bonds and its own loss history to establish a loss rate on bonds that are not collateralized. 
For available-for-sale debt securities in an unrealized loss position, the Company first assesses whether it intends to sell, or is more likely than 
not that it will be required to sell the security before recovery of its amortized cost basis. If the Company intends to sell the security or it is 
more likely than not that the Company will be required to sell the security before recovering its cost basis, the entire impairment loss would 
be recognized in earnings. If the Company does not intend to sell the security and it is not more likely than not that the Company will be 
required to sell the security, the Company evaluates whether the decline in fair value has resulted from credit losses or other factors. In 
making this assessment, Management considers the extent to which fair value is less than amortized costs, any changes to the rating of the 
security by a rating agency and adverse conditions specifically related to the security, among other factors. If this assessment indicates that a 
credit loss exists, the present value of cash flows expected to be collected from the security are compared to the amortized cost basis of the 
security. Projected cash flows are discounted by the current effective interest rate. If the present value of cash flows expected to be collected 
is less than the amortized cost basis, a credit loss exists and an allowance for credit losses is recorded for the credit loss, limited by the amount 
that the fair value is less than the amortized cost basis. The remaining impairment related to all other factors, the difference between the 
present value of the cash flows expected to be collected and fair value, is recognized in AOCI. 
Changes in the allowance for credit losses are recorded as provision (recapture) for credit losses. Losses are charged against the allowance 
when Management believes the non-collectability of an available-for-sale or held-to-maturity security is confirmed or when either of the 
criteria regarding intent or requirement to sell is met. 
Investment in FHLB Stock:  FHLB stock does not have a readily determinable fair value.  The Bank’s investment in FHLB stock is carried at 
cost or par value ($100 per share) and evaluated for impairment based on the Bank’s expectations of the ultimate recoverability of the stock’s 
par value. Ownership of FHLB stock is restricted to the FHLB and member institutions and can only be purchased and redeemed at par, 
therefore there has been no observable changes in market prices. As a member of the FHLB system, the Bank is required to maintain a 
minimum level of investment in FHLB stock based on specific percentages of its outstanding FHLB advances. 
Management periodically evaluates FHLB stock for impairment. Management’s determination of whether these investments are impaired is 
based on its assessment of the ultimate recoverability of cost rather than by recognizing temporary declines in value. The determination of 
whether a decline affects the ultimate recoverability of cost is influenced by criteria such as (1) the significance of any decline in net assets of 
the FHLB as compared to the capital stock amount for the FHLB and the length of time this situation has persisted, (2) commitments by the 
FHLB to make payments required by law or regulation and the level of such payments in relation to the operating performance of the FHLB, 
(3) the impact of legislative and regulatory changes on institutions and, accordingly, the client base of the FHLB, and (4) the liquidity position 
of the FHLB.  The Company has determined there is no impairment on the FHLB stock investment as of December 31, 2024 and 2023. 
  
Table of Contents 
84 
Loans Receivable: The Bank originates one- to four-family residential loans for both portfolio investment and sale in the secondary market.  
The Bank also originates construction and land development, multifamily mortgage, commercial real estate, commercial business, agricultural 
and consumer loans for portfolio investment. Loans receivable not designated as held for sale are recorded at amortized cost, net of the 
allowance for credit losses. Amortized cost is the principal amount outstanding, net of deferred fees, discounts and premiums. Accrued 
interest on loans is reported in accrued interest receivable on the Consolidated Statements of Financial Condition. Premiums, discounts and 
deferred loan fees are amortized to maturity using the level-yield methodology. 

  
Loans Held for Sale: One- to four-family residential loans originated with the intent to be sold in the secondary market are considered held 
for sale. One- to four-family residential loans under best effort delivery commitments are carried at the lower of aggregate cost or estimated 
market value. One- to four-family residential loans expected to be delivered under mandatory commitments are carried at fair value to match 
changes in the value of the loans with the value of the related economic hedges on the loans. Fair values for residential mortgage loans held 
for sale are determined by comparing actual loan rates to current secondary market prices for similar loans. Net unrealized losses on loans 
held for sale that are carried at lower of cost or market are recognized through the valuation allowance as charges to income. Non-refundable 
fees and direct loan origination costs related to loans held for sale carried at the lower of cost or market are recognized as part of the cost basis 
of the loan. Gains and losses on sales of loans held for sale are determined using the aggregate method and are recorded in the mortgage 
banking operations component of non-interest income. Non-refundable fees and direct loan origination costs related to loans held for sale 
carried at the lower of cost or market are recognized as part of the cost basis of the loan. 
  
Loans Acquired in Business Combinations: Loans acquired in business combinations are recorded at their fair value at the acquisition date.  
Establishing the fair value of acquired loans involves a significant amount of judgment, including determining the credit discount based upon 
historical data adjusted for current economic conditions and other factors. If any of these assumptions are inaccurate, actual credit losses 
could vary significantly from the credit discount used to calculate the fair value of the acquired loans. Acquired loans are evaluated upon 
acquisition and classified as either purchased credit-deteriorated or purchased non-credit-deteriorated. Purchased credit-deteriorated (PCD) 
loans have experienced more than insignificant credit deterioration since origination. For PCD loans, an allowance for credit losses is 
determined at the acquisition date using the same methodology as other loans held for investment. The initial allowance for credit losses, 
determined on a collective basis, is allocated to individual loans. A loan’s fair value is grossed up for the allowance for credit losses and 
becomes its initial amortized cost basis. The difference between the initial amortized cost basis and the par value of the loan is a noncredit 
discount or premium, which is amortized into interest income over the life of the loan. Subsequent changes to the allowance for credit losses 
are recorded through a provision (recapture) for credit losses. 
For purchased non-credit-deteriorated loans, the difference between the fair value and unpaid principal balance of the loan at the acquisition 
date is amortized or accreted to interest income over the life of the loan. While credit discounts are included in the determination of the fair 
value for non-credit-deteriorated loans, since these discounts are expected to be accreted over the life of the loans, they cannot be used to 
offset the allowance for credit losses that must be recorded at the acquisition date. As a result, an allowance for credit losses is determined at 
the acquisition date using the same methodology as other loans held for investment and is recognized as a provision for credit losses. Any 
subsequent deterioration (improvement) in credit quality is recognized by recording a provision (recapture) for credit losses. 
  
Income Recognition on Nonaccrual Loans and Securities: Interest on loans and securities is accrued as earned unless Management doubts 
the collectability of the asset or the unpaid interest. Interest accruals on loans are generally discontinued when loans become 90 days past due 
for payment of interest or principal and the loans are then placed on nonaccrual status. All previously accrued but uncollected interest is 
deducted from interest income upon transfer to nonaccrual status. For any future payments collected, interest income is recognized only upon 
Management’s assessment that there is a strong likelihood that the full amount of a loan will be repaid or recovered. Management’s 
assessment of the likelihood of full repayment involves judgment, including determining the fair value of the underlying collateral which can 
be impacted by the economic environment. A loan may be put on nonaccrual status sooner than this policy would dictate if, in Management’s 
judgment, the amounts owed, principal or interest may be uncollectable. While less common, similar interest reversal and nonaccrual 
treatment is applied to investment securities if their ultimate collectability becomes questionable. 
  
Table of Contents 
85 
Provision and Allowance for Credit Losses - Loans: The methodology for determining the allowance for credit losses - loans is considered a 
critical accounting estimate by Management because of the high degree of judgment involved, the subjectivity of the assumptions used, and 
the potential for changes in the economic environment that could result in changes to the amount of the recorded allowance for credit losses - 
loans. Among the material estimates required to establish the allowance for credit losses - loans are: a reasonable and supportable forecast; a 
reasonable and supportable forecast period and reversion period; value of collateral; strength of guarantors; the amount and timing of future 
cash flows for loans individually evaluated; and determination of the qualitative loss factors. All of these estimates are susceptible to 
significant change. The allowance for credit losses - loans is a valuation account that is deducted from the amortized cost basis of loans to 
present the net amount expected to be collected on the loans. The Company has elected to exclude accrued interest receivable from the 
amortized cost basis in their estimate of the allowance for credit losses - loans. The provision for credit losses reflects the amount required to 
maintain the allowance for credit losses - loans at an appropriate level based upon Management’s evaluation of the adequacy of collective and 
individual loss reserves. The Company has established systematic methodologies for the determination of the adequacy of the Company’s 
allowance for credit losses - loans. The methodologies are set forth in a formal policy and take into consideration the need for a valuation 
allowance for loans evaluated on a collective (pool) basis which have similar risk characteristics as well as allowances that are tied to 
individual loans that do not share risk characteristics. 
The Company increases its allowance for credit losses - loans by charging the provision for credit losses. Losses related to specific assets are 
applied as a reduction of the carrying value of the assets and charged against the allowance for credit loss reserve when Management believes 
the uncollectibility of a loan balance is confirmed. Recoveries on previously charged off loans are credited to the allowance for credit losses - 
loans. 

Management estimates the allowance for credit losses - loans using relevant information, from internal and external sources, relating to past 
events, current conditions, and reasonable and supportable forecasts. The allowance for credit losses - loans is maintained at a level sufficient 
to provide for expected credit losses over the life of the loan based on evaluating historical credit loss experience and making adjustments to 
historical loss information for differences in the specific risk characteristics in the current loan portfolio. These factors include, among others, 
changes in the size and composition of the loan portfolio, differences in underwriting standards, delinquency rates, actual loss experience and 
current economic conditions. 
The allowance for credit losses - loans is measured on a collective (pool) basis when similar risk characteristics exist. In estimating the 
component of the allowance for credit losses for loans that share common risk characteristics, loans are pooled based on loan type and areas 
of risk concentration. For loans evaluated collectively, the allowance for credit losses is calculated using life of loan historical losses adjusted 
for economic forecasts and current conditions. 
For commercial real estate, multifamily real estate, construction and land and land development, commercial business and agricultural loans 
with risk rating segmentation, historical credit loss assumptions are estimated using a model that categorizes loan pools based on loan type 
and risk rating. For one- to four- family residential loans, consumer loans, home equity lines of credit, small business loans, and small 
balance commercial real estate loans, historical credit loss assumptions are estimated using a model that categorizes loan pools based on loan 
type and delinquency status. These models calculate an expected life-of-loan loss percentage for each loan category by calculating the 
probability of default, based on the migration of loans from performing to loss by risk rating or delinquency categories using historical life-of-
loan analysis and the severity of loss, based on the aggregate net lifetime losses incurred for each loan pool. For credit cards, historical credit 
loss assumptions are estimated using a model that calculates an expected life-of-loan loss percentage for each loan category by considering 
the historical cumulative losses based on the aggregate net lifetime losses incurred for each loan pool. 
For loans evaluated collectively, Management uses economic indicators to adjust the historical loss rates so that they better reflect 
Management’s expectations of future conditions over the remaining lives of the loans in the portfolio based on reasonable and supportable 
forecasts. These economic indicators are selected based on correlation to the Company’s historical credit loss experience and are evaluated 
for each loan category. The economic indicators evaluated include the unemployment rate, gross domestic product, real estate price indices 
and growth, industrial employment, corporate profits, the household consumer debt service ratio, the household mortgage debt service ratio, 
and single family median home price growth. Management considers various economic scenarios and forecasts when evaluating the 
economic indicators and weighs the probability of various scenarios to arrive at the forecast that most reflects Management’s expectations of 
future conditions. The allowance for credit losses is then adjusted for the period in which those forecasts are considered to be reasonable and 
supportable. To the extent the lives of the loans in the portfolio extend beyond the period for which a reasonable and supportable forecast can 
be made, the adjustments discontinue to be applied so that the model reverts back to the historical loss rates using a straight-line reversion 
method. Management selected a reasonable and supportable forecast period of 12 months with a reversion period of 12 months. Both the 
reasonable and supportable forecast period and the reversion period are periodically reviewed by Management. 
Further, for loans evaluated collectively, Management also considers qualitative and environmental factors for each loan category to adjust for 
differences between the historical periods used to calculate historical loss rates and expected conditions over the remaining lives of the loans 
in the portfolio. In determining the aggregate adjustment needed, Management considers the financial condition of the borrowers, the nature 
and volume of the loans, the remaining terms and the extent of prepayments on the loans, the volume and severity of past due and classified 
loans as well as the value of the underlying collateral on loans in which the collateral dependent practical expedient has not been used.  
Management also considers the Company’s lending policies, the quality of the Company’s credit review system, the quality of the Company’s 
management and lending staff, and the regulatory and economic environments in the areas in which the Company’s lending activities are 
concentrated. 
Loans that do not share risk characteristics with other loans in the portfolio are individually evaluated for impairment and are not included in 
the collective evaluation. Factors involved in determining whether a loan should be individually evaluated include, but are not limited to, the 
financial condition of the borrower and the value of the underlying collateral. Expected credit losses for loans evaluated individually are 
primarily measured based on the fair market value of the collateral as of the reporting date, less estimated selling costs, as applicable. Under 
certain circumstances, the Bank may use observable market value of collateral or the present value of the expected future cash flows 
discounted at the loan’s original effective interest rate. As a practical expedient, the Bank measures the expected credit loss for a loan using 
the fair value of the collateral, if repayment is expected to be provided substantially through the operation or sale of the collateral when the 
borrower is experiencing financial difficulty based on the Bank’s assessment as of the reporting date. 
In both cases, if the fair value of the collateral is less than the amortized cost basis of the loan, the Bank will recognize an allowance as the 
difference between the fair value of the collateral, less costs to sell (if applicable) at the reporting date and the amortized cost basis of the 
loan. If the fair value of the collateral exceeds the amortized cost basis of the loan, any expected recovery added to the amortized cost basis 
will be limited to the amount previously charged-off. Subsequent changes in the expected credit losses for loans evaluated individually are 
included within the provision for credit losses in the same manner in which the expected credit loss initially was recognized or as a reduction 
in the provision that would otherwise be reported. 
Table of Contents 
86 

  
Loan Origination and Commitment Fees: Loan origination fees, net of certain specifically defined direct loan origination costs, are deferred 
and recognized as an adjustment of the loans’ interest yield using the level-yield method over the contractual term of each loan adjusted for 
actual loan prepayment experience. Loan commitment fees are deferred until the expiration of the commitment period unless Management 
believes there is a remote likelihood that the underlying commitment will be exercised, in which case the fees are amortized to fee income 
using the straight-line method over the commitment period. If a loan commitment is exercised, the deferred commitment fee is accounted for 
in the same manner as a loan origination fee.  Deferred commitment fees associated with expired commitments are recognized as fee income. 
Allowance for Credit Losses - Unfunded Loan Commitments: An allowance for credit losses - unfunded loan commitments is maintained at 
a level that, in the opinion of Management, is adequate to absorb expected credit losses associated with the contractual life of the Bank’s 
commitments to lend funds under existing agreements such as letters or lines of credit. The Bank uses a methodology for determining the 
allowance for credit losses - unfunded loan commitments that applies the same segmentation and loss rate to each pool as the funded exposure 
adjusted for probability of funding. Draws on unfunded loan commitments that are considered uncollectible at the time funds are advanced 
are charged to the allowance for credit losses on off-balance sheet exposures. Changes in the allowance for credit losses - unfunded loan 
commitments are recognized as provision for (or recapture of) credit loss expense and added to the allowance for credit losses - unfunded loan 
commitments, which is included in other liabilities in the Consolidated Statements of Financial Condition. 
  
Real Estate Owned: Property acquired by foreclosure or deed in-lieu-of foreclosure is recorded at the estimated fair value of the property, 
less expected selling costs. Development and improvement costs relating to the property may be capitalized, while other holding costs are 
expensed. The carrying value of the property is periodically evaluated by Management and, if necessary, allowances are established to reduce 
the carrying value to net realizable value. Gains or losses at the time the property is sold are charged or credited to operations in the period in 
which they are realized. The amounts the Bank will ultimately recover from real estate held for sale may differ substantially from the 
carrying value of the assets because of market factors beyond the Bank’s control or because of changes in the Bank’s strategies for recovering 
the investment. 
  
Property and Equipment: Property and equipment is carried at cost less accumulated depreciation. Depreciation is based upon the straight-
line method applied to individual assets and groups of assets acquired in the same year over the lesser of their estimated useful lives or the 
related lease terms of the assets, which are as follows: 
Buildings and leased improvements 
10–39 years 
Furniture and equipment 
3–10 years 
Routine maintenance, repairs and replacement costs are expensed as incurred. Expenditures which significantly increase values or extend 
useful lives are capitalized. The Company reviews buildings, leasehold improvements and equipment for impairment whenever events or 
changes in circumstances indicate that the undiscounted cash flows for the property are less than its carrying value. If identified, an 
impairment loss is recognized through a charge to earnings based on the fair value of the property. 
Property is classified as held for sale when the Company commits to a plan to sell the property and is actively marketing the property for sale.  
Held for sale property is recorded at the lower of the estimated fair value of the property, less expected selling costs, or the book value at the 
date the property is transferred to held for sale.  Depreciation is not recorded on held for sale property. 
Leases: The Company leases retail, office and storage space, and equipment under operating leases. Most leases require the Company to pay 
real estate taxes, maintenance, insurance and other similar costs in addition to the base rent. Certain leases also contain lease incentives, such 
as tenant improvement allowances and rent abatement. Variable lease payments are recognized as lease expense as they are incurred. We 
record an operating lease right of use (ROU) asset and an operating lease liability (lease liability) for operating leases with a lease term greater 
than 12 months. 
ROU assets represent our right to use an underlying asset for the lease term and lease liabilities represent our obligation to make lease 
payments arising from the lease. ROU assets and lease liabilities are recognized at commencement date based on the present value of lease 
payments over the lease term. Accordingly, ROU assets are reduced by tenant improvement allowances from landlords plus any prepaid rent.  
We do not separate lease and non-lease components of contracts. As most of our leases do not provide an implicit rate, we generally use our 
incremental borrowing rate based on the estimated rate of interest for collateralized borrowing over a similar term of the lease payments at 
commencement date. Many of our leases contain various provisions for increases in rental rates, based either on changes in the published 
Consumer Price Index or a predetermined escalation schedule which are factored into our determination of lease payments when appropriate.  
Substantially, all the leases provide the Company with the option to extend the lease term one or more times following expiration of the initial 
term. The ROU asset and lease liability terms may include options to extend or terminate the lease when it is reasonably certain that we will 
exercise that option.  Lease expense for lease payments is recognized on a straight-line basis over the lease term. 
Table of Contents 
87 

Goodwill:  Goodwill represents the excess of the purchase consideration paid over the fair value of the assets acquired, net of the fair values 
of liabilities assumed in a business combination and is not amortized but is reviewed annually or more frequently as current circumstances 
and conditions warrant, for impairment. The Company completes its annual review of goodwill as of December 31. An assessment of 
qualitative factors is completed to determine if it is more likely than not that the fair value of a reporting unit is less than its carrying amount.  
The qualitative assessment involves judgment by Management on determining whether there have been any triggering events that have 
occurred which would indicate potential impairment. If the qualitative analysis concludes that further analysis is required, then a quantitative 
impairment test would be completed. The quantitative goodwill impairment test is used to identify the existence of impairment and the 
amount of impairment loss and compares the reporting unit’s estimated fair values, including goodwill, to its carrying amount. If the fair 
value exceeds the carrying amount, then goodwill is not considered impaired. If the carrying amount exceeds its fair value, an impairment 
loss would be recognized equal to the amount of excess, limited to the amount of total goodwill allocated to the reporting unit. The 
impairment loss would be recognized as a charge to earnings.  The disposal of a portion of a reporting unit that meets the definition of a 
business requires goodwill to be allocated for purposes of determining the gain or loss on disposal. 
Other Intangible Assets:  Other intangible assets consist primarily of core deposit intangibles (CDI) which are amounts recorded in business 
combinations or deposit purchase transactions related to the value of transaction-related deposits and the value of the client relationships 
associated with the deposits. CDI is being amortized on an accelerated basis over a weighted average estimated useful life of eight to 10 
years. These assets are reviewed at least annually for events or circumstances that could impact their recoverability. These events could 
include loss of the underlying core deposits, increased competition or adverse changes in the economy. To the extent other identifiable 
intangible assets are deemed unrecoverable, impairment losses are recorded in other non-interest expense to reduce the carrying amount of the 
assets. 
Mortgage and Small Business Administration (SBA) Servicing Rights:  Servicing assets are recognized as separate assets when rights are 
acquired through purchase or sale of loans. Generally, purchased servicing rights are capitalized at the cost to acquire the rights. For sales of 
mortgage and SBA loans, the fair value of the servicing right is estimated and capitalized. Fair values are estimated based on an independent 
dealer analysis of discounted cash flows. Capitalized mortgage servicing rights are reported in other assets and are amortized into mortgage 
banking operations in proportion to, and over the period of, the estimated future net servicing income of the underlying financial assets.  
Capitalized SBA servicing rights are reported in other assets and are carried at fair value. Changes in the fair value of SBA servicing rights 
are recognized into miscellaneous non-interest income. 
Mortgage servicing assets are evaluated for impairment based upon the fair value of the rights as compared to amortized cost. Impairment is 
determined by stratifying rights into tranches based on predominant risk characteristics for the underlying loans, such as interest rate, balance 
outstanding, loan type, age and remaining term, and investor type. Impairment is recognized through a valuation allowance for an individual 
tranche, to the extent that fair value is less than the capitalized amount for the tranche. If the Company later determines that all or a portion of 
the impairment no longer exists for a particular tranche, a reduction of the allowance may be recorded as an increase to income. 
Servicing fee income is recorded for fees earned for servicing loans. Servicing fee income is reflected in mortgage banking operations for 
mortgage servicing rights and in miscellaneous non-interest income for SBA servicing rights on the Consolidated Statements of 
Operations. The fees are based on a contractual percentage of the outstanding principal or a fixed amount per loan and are recorded as 
income when earned.  The amortization of mortgage servicing rights is netted against loan servicing fee income. 
Bank-Owned Life Insurance:  The Bank has purchased, or acquired through mergers, life insurance policies in connection with the 
implementation of certain executive supplemental income, salary continuation and deferred compensation retirement plans. These policies 
provide protection against the adverse financial effects that could result from the death of a key employee and provide tax-exempt income to 
offset expenses associated with the plans. It is the Bank’s intent to hold these policies as a long-term investment; however, there may be an 
income tax impact if the Bank chooses to surrender certain policies. Although the lives of individual, current or former management-level 
employees are insured, the Bank is the respective owner and sole or partial beneficiary. BOLI is carried at the cash surrender value (CSV) of 
the underlying insurance contract. Changes in the CSV and any death benefits received in excess of the CSV are recognized as non-interest 
income. 
Derivative Instruments:  Derivatives include “off-balance-sheet” financial products, the value of which is dependent on the value of 
underlying financial assets, such as stock, bonds, foreign currency, or a reference rate or index. Such derivatives include “forwards,” 
“futures,” “options” or “swaps.” The Bank used an interest rate swap program which involves the receipt of fixed-rate amounts from a 
counterparty in exchange for variable-rate payments over the life of the agreements without exchange of the underlying notional amount.  
Such derivatives were used to hedge the variable cash flows associated with existing variable-rate assets. These interest rate swaps qualified 
as cash flow hedging instruments so gains and losses were recorded in AOCI to the extent the hedge was effective. Gains and losses on the 
interest rate swaps were reclassified from AOCI to earnings in the period the hedged transaction affected earnings and were included in 
interest income. Amounts reported in AOCI related to derivatives were reclassified to interest income as interest payments were received on 
the Company’s variable-rate assets. The related cash flows were recognized as cash flows from operating activities on the Consolidated 
Statement of Cash Flows.  These cash flow hedges matured in 2024. 
The Bank offers an interest rate swap program for commercial loan clients that provides the client with a variable-rate loan and enters into an 
interest rate swap allowing them to effectively fix their loan interest rates. These client swaps are matched with third party swaps with 
qualified broker/dealer or banks to offset the risk. The fair value adjustments for these swaps are recorded in either other assets or other 
liabilities, as appropriate. 
Table of Contents 
88 

Further, as a part of its mortgage banking activities, the Company issues “rate lock” commitments to one- to four-family loan borrowers and 
obtains offsetting “best efforts” delivery commitments from purchasers of loans. The Company uses forward contracts for the sale of 
mortgage-backed securities and mandatory delivery commitments for the sale of loans to hedge one- to four-family loan “rate lock” 
commitments and one- to four-family residential loans held for sale. The commitments to originate mortgage loans held for sale and the 
related delivery contracts are considered derivatives. The Company recognizes all derivatives as either assets or liabilities in the balance sheet 
and requires measurement of those instruments at fair value through adjustments to current earnings. None of these residential mortgage loan 
related derivatives are designated as hedging instruments for accounting purposes. Rather, they are accounted for as free-standing derivatives, 
or economic hedges, and the Company reports changes in fair values of its derivatives in current period net income. The fair values for these 
instruments, which generally change as a result of changes in the level of market interest rates, are estimated based on dealer quotes and 
secondary market sources. Assumptions used include rate assumptions based on historical information, current mortgage interest rates, the 
stage of completion of the underlying application and underwriting process, the time remaining until the expiration of the derivative loan 
commitment, and the expected net future cash flows related to the associated servicing of the loan. 
Transfers of Financial Assets:  Transfers of financial assets are accounted for as sales when control over the assets has been 
surrendered. Control over transferred assets is deemed to be surrendered when (1) the assets have been isolated from the Bank, (2) the 
transferee has the right to pledge or exchange the transferred assets beyond a trivial benefit, and (3) the Bank does not maintain effective 
control over the transferred assets through an agreement to repurchase them before their maturity. 
Income Taxes:  The Company files a consolidated income tax return including all of its wholly-owned subsidiaries on a calendar year 
basis. Income taxes are accounted for using the asset and liability method. Under this method, a deferred tax asset or liability is determined 
based on the enacted tax rates which are expected to be in effect when the differences between the financial statement carrying amounts and 
tax basis of existing assets and liabilities are expected to be reported in the Company’s income tax returns. The effect on deferred taxes of a 
change in tax rates is recognized in income in the period of change. A valuation allowance is recognized as a reduction to deferred tax assets 
when Management determines it is more likely than not that deferred tax assets will not be available to offset future income tax liabilities. 
Accounting standards for income taxes prescribe a recognition threshold and measurement process for financial statement recognition and 
measurement of uncertain tax positions taken or expected to be taken in a tax return, and provides guidance on the de-recognition of 
previously recorded benefits and their classification, as well as the proper recording of interest and penalties, accounting in interim periods, 
disclosures and transition. The Company periodically reviews its income tax positions based on tax laws and regulations and financial 
reporting considerations, and records adjustments as appropriate. This review takes into consideration the status of current taxing authorities’ 
examinations of the Company’s tax returns, recent positions taken by the taxing authorities on similar transactions, if any, and the overall tax 
environment. 
Stock-Based Compensation:  Under the Company’s stock-based incentive plans, the Company compensates employees and directors with 
time-based restricted stock and restricted stock unit grants. Some restricted stock awards include performance-based and market-based goals 
that impact the number of shares that ultimately vest based on the level of goal achievement. The Company measures the cost of employee or 
director services received in exchange for an award of equity instruments based on the fair value of the award, which is the intrinsic value on 
the grant date. This cost is recognized as expense in the Consolidated Statements of Operations ratably over the vesting period of the award 
with forfeitures of nonvested awards recognized as they occur. Any tax benefit or deficiency is recorded as income tax benefit or expense in 
the period the shares vest. Excess tax benefits are classified, along with other income tax cash flows, as an operating activity. The Company 
issues restricted stock and restricted stock unit awards which vest over a one- or three-year period during which time, the employee or director 
accrues or receives dividends and may have full voting rights depending on the terms of the grant. 
Earnings Per Share: Earnings per common share is computed under the two-class method. Pursuant to the two-class method, non-vested 
stock-based payment awards that contain non-forfeitable rights to dividends or dividend equivalents are participating securities and are 
included in the computation of earnings per share. The two-class method is an earnings allocation formula that determines earnings per share 
for each class of common stock and participating security according to dividends declared (or accumulated) and participation rights in 
undistributed earnings.  Application of the two-class method resulted in the equivalent earnings per share to the treasury method. 
Basic earnings per common share is computed by dividing net earnings allocated to common shareholders by the weighted average number of 
common shares outstanding during the applicable period, excluding outstanding participating securities. Diluted earnings per common share 
is computed using the weighted average number of shares determined for the basic earnings per common share computation plus the dilutive 
effect of stock compensation, using the treasury stock method. 
Comprehensive Income:  Accounting principles generally require that recognized revenue, expenses, gains and losses be included in net 
income. In addition, certain changes in assets and liabilities, such as unrealized gains and losses on available-for-sale securities, unrealized 
gains and losses on interest rate swaps used in cash flow hedges and changes in fair value of junior subordinated debentures related to 
instrument specific credit risk, are reported as a separate component of the equity section of the Consolidated Statements of Financial 
Condition, and such items, along with net income, are components of comprehensive income which is reported in the Consolidated 
Statements of Comprehensive Income. 
Reclassification: Certain reclassifications have been made to the prior years’ consolidated financial statements and/or schedules to conform 
to the current year’s presentation. These reclassifications may have an impact on certain reported amounts and ratios for the prior periods.  
These reclassifications had no effect on retained earnings or net income as previously presented and the effect of these reclassifications is 
considered immaterial. 
Table of Contents 
89 

Note 2: ACCOUNTING STANDARDS RECENTLY ISSUED OR ADOPTED 
Income Statement—Reporting Comprehensive Income—Expense Disaggregation Disclosures (Subtopic 220-40) 
In November 2024, the Financial Accounting Standards Board (FASB) issued guidance within Accounting Standards Update (ASU) 2024-03, 
Income Statement—Reporting Comprehensive Income—Expense Disaggregation Disclosures (Subtopic 220-40): Disaggregation of Income 
Statement Expenses. The amendments in the ASU require public companies to disclose, in the notes to financial statements, specified 
information about certain costs and expenses at each interim and annual reporting period.  Specifically, they will be required to: 
• 
Disclose the amounts of (a) purchases of inventory; (b) employee compensation; (c) depreciation; (d) intangible asset amortization; 
and (e) depreciation, depletion, and amortization recognized as part of oil- and gas-producing activities (or other amounts of 
depletion expense) included in each relevant expense caption. 
• 
Include certain amounts that are already required to be disclosed under GAAP in the same disclosure as the other disaggregation 
requirements. 
• 
Disclose a qualitative description of the amounts remaining in relevant expense captions that are not separately disaggregated 
quantitatively. 
• 
Disclose the total amount of selling expenses and, in annual reporting periods, an entity’s definition of selling expenses. 
This ASU is effective for annual reporting periods beginning after December 15, 2026, and interim reporting periods beginning after 
December 15, 2027. Early adoption is permitted. The amendments should be applied prospectively. The Company is evaluating the 
adoption of this ASU, but does not expect this ASU to have a material impact on the Company’s consolidated financial statements. 
Compensation—Stock Compensation (Topic 718) 
In March 2024, the FASB issued guidance within ASU 2024-01, Compensation—Stock Compensation (Topic 718): Scope Application of 
Profits Interest and Similar Awards. The amendments in the ASU apply to companies that provide employees and non-employees with 
profits interest and similar awards to align compensation with the company’s operating performance and provide those holders with the 
opportunity to participate in future profits and/or equity appreciation of the company. The purpose of the ASU is to clarify the application of 
the scope guidance in Accounting Standards Codification (ASC) paragraph 718-10-15-3 in determining if a profit interest award should be 
accounted for in accordance with Topic 718: Compensation—Stock Compensation. The amendment in ASC paragraph 718-10-15-3 is solely 
intended to improve the overall clarity and does not change the guidance. 
This ASU does not have a material impact on the Company’s Consolidated Financial Statements, as the Company does not currently provide 
these types of awards. 
Income Taxes (Topic 740) 
In December 2023, the FASB issued guidance within ASU 2023-09, Income Taxes (Topic 740): Improvements to Income Tax Disclosures.  
The amendments in the Update are intended to provide more transparency about income tax information through improvements to income tax 
disclosures, primarily related to the rate reconciliation and income taxes paid information. The ASU requires disclosure in the rate 
reconciliation of specific categories as well as provide additional information for reconciling items that meet a quantitative threshold. 
Those amendments require disclosure of the following information about income taxes paid on an annual basis: 
• 
Income taxes paid (net of refunds received), disaggregated by federal and state taxes and by individual jurisdictions in which 
income taxes paid (net of refunds received) is equal to or greater than five percent of total income taxes paid (net of refunds 
received). 
• 
Income tax expense (or benefit) from continuing operations disaggregated by federal and state jurisdictions. 
The Company early adopted and applied this ASU prospectively and new disclosures have been added as applicable. 
Segment Reporting (Topic 280) 
In November 2023, the FASB issued guidance within ASU 2023-07, Segment Reporting (Topic 280): Improvements to Reportable Segment 
Disclosures. This ASU requires that a public entity that has a single reportable segment provide all the disclosures required by the 
amendments in this ASU and all existing disclosures in Topic 280. The Company has determined that its current business and operations 
consist of a single operating segment and a single reporting unit. 
The amendments in this Update are intended to improve segment disclosure requirements, primarily through enhanced disclosures about 
significant segment expenses.  The key amendments included in this Update: 
• 
Require disclosure on an annual and interim basis, significant segment expenses that are regularly provided to the chief operating 
decision maker (CODM) and are included within each reported measure of segment profit and loss. 
• 
Require disclosure on an annual and interim basis, an amount for other segment items (defined in the ASU) and a description of its 
composition. 
• 
Clarify that if the CODM uses more than one measure of the segment’s profit or loss in assessing performance, one or more of those 
additional measures may be reported. 
Table of Contents 
90 

• 
Require disclosure of the title and position of the CODM and an explanation of how the CODM uses the reported measure(s) of 
segment profit or loss in assessing performance. 
The Company applied this ASU retrospectively and new disclosures have been added as applicable for a single reportable operating segment. 
Note 3: SECURITIES 
The amortized cost, gross unrealized gains and losses, and estimated fair value of securities at December 31, 2024 and 2023, are summarized 
as follows (in thousands): 
December 31, 2024 
Amortized 
Cost 
Gross 
Unrealized 
Gains 
Gross 
Unrealized 
Losses 
Fair Value 
Available-for-Sale: 
U.S. Government and agency obligations 
$ 
8,492 
$ 
— 
$ 
(559) $ 
7,933 
Municipal bonds 
153,982 
453 
(30,453) 
123,982 
Corporate bonds 
131,379 
100 
(6,489) 
124,990 
Mortgage-backed or related securities 
1,995,805 
383 
(319,340) 
1,676,848 
Asset-backed securities 
170,604 
155 
(1) 
170,758 
$ 2,460,262 
$ 
1,091 
$ 
(356,842) $ 2,104,511 
December 31, 2024 
Amortized 
Cost 
Gross 
Unrealized 
Gains 
Gross 
Unrealized 
Losses 
Fair Value 
Allowance 
for Credit 
Losses 
Held-to-Maturity: 
U.S. Government and agency obligations 
$ 
302 
$ 
— 
$ 
(4) $ 
298 
$ 
— 
Municipal bonds 
438,196 
36 
(62,809) 
375,280 
(143) 
Corporate bonds 
2,658 
— 
(6) 
2,498 
(154) 
Mortgage-backed or related securities 
560,705 
— 
(113,253) 
447,452 
— 
$ 1,001,861 
$ 
36 
$ 
(176,072) $ 
825,528 
$ 
(297) 
December 31, 2023 
Amortized 
Cost 
Gross 
Unrealized 
Gains 
Gross 
Unrealized 
Losses 
Fair Value 
Available-for-Sale: 
U.S. Government and agency obligations 
$ 
34,929 
$ 
— 
$ 
(740) $ 
34,189 
Municipal bonds 
161,264 
832 
(29,191) 
132,905 
Corporate bonds 
131,291 
— 
(12,168) 
119,123 
Mortgage-backed or related securities 
2,179,947 
942 
(314,175) 
1,866,714 
Asset-backed securities 
222,549 
300 
(1,997) 
220,852 
$ 2,729,980 
$ 
2,074 
$ 
(358,271) $ 2,373,783 
Table of Contents 
91 

December 31, 2023 
Amortized 
Cost 
Gross 
Unrealized 
Gains 
Gross 
Unrealized 
Losses 
Fair Value 
Allowance 
for Credit 
Losses 
Held-to-Maturity: 
U.S. Government and agency obligations 
$ 
307 
$ 
— 
$ 
(5) $ 
302 $ 
— 
Municipal bonds 
466,032 
687 
(53,563) 
412,999 
(157) 
Corporate bonds 
2,781 
— 
(20) 
2,586 
(175) 
Mortgage-backed or related securities 
590,267 
— 
(98,640) 
491,627 
— 
$ 1,059,387 
$ 
687 
$ 
(152,228) $ 
907,514 $ 
(332) 
Accrued interest receivable on held-to-maturity debt securities was $4.2 million and $4.5 million as of December 31, 2024 and 2023, and was 
$9.0 million and $10.8 million on available-for-sale debt securities at December 31, 2024 and 2023, respectively. Accrued interest receivable 
on securities is reported in accrued interest receivable on the Consolidated Statements of Financial Condition and is excluded from the 
calculation of the allowance for credit losses. 
At December 31, 2024 and 2023, the gross unrealized losses and the fair value for securities—available-for-sale aggregated by the length of 
time that individual securities have been in a continuous unrealized loss position were as follows (in thousands): 
December 31, 2024 
Less Than 12 Months 
12 Months or More 
Total 
Fair Value 
Unrealized
Losses 
 
Fair Value 
Unrealized 
Losses 
Fair Value 
Unrealized 
Losses 
Available-for-Sale: 
U.S. Government and agency obligations 
$ 
— 
$ 
— 
$ 
7,933 
$ 
(559) $ 
7,933 
$ 
(559) 
Municipal bonds 
15,497 
(287) 
91,156 
(30,166) 
106,653 
(30,453) 
Corporate bonds 
2,541 
(59) 
96,763 
(6,430) 
99,304 
(6,489) 
Mortgage-backed or related securities 
44,749 
(524) 
1,552,613 
(318,816) 
1,597,362 
(319,340) 
Asset-backed securities 
20,000 
(1) 
— 
— 
20,000 
(1) 
$ 
82,787 
$ 
(871) $ 1,748,465 
$ (355,971) $ 1,831,252 
$ (356,842) 
December 31, 2023 
Less Than 12 Months 
12 Months or More 
Total 
Fair Value 
Unrealized 
Losses 
Fair Value 
Unrealized 
Losses 
Fair Value 
Unrealized 
Losses 
Available-for-Sale: 
U.S. Government and agency obligations 
$ 
— 
$ 
— 
$ 
34,189 
$ 
(740) $ 
34,189 
$ 
(740) 
Municipal bonds 
6,049 
(7) 
103,511 
(29,184) 
109,560 
(29,191) 
Corporate bonds 
15,720 
(46) 
106,852 
(12,122) 
122,572 
(12,168) 
Mortgage-backed or related securities 
71,150 
(212) 
1,712,125 
(313,963) 
1,783,275 
(314,175) 
Asset-backed securities 
115,162 
(1,212) 
85,840 
(785) 
201,002 
(1,997) 
$ 
208,081 
$ 
(1,477) $ 2,042,517 
$ (356,794) $ 2,250,598 
$ (358,271) 
At December 31, 2024, there were 201 securities—available-for-sale with unrealized losses, compared to 224 at December 31, 
2023. Management does not believe that any individual unrealized loss as of December 31, 2024 or 2023 resulted from credit loss. The 
decline in fair market value of these securities was generally due to changes in interest rates and changes in market-desired spreads 
subsequent to their purchase. 
All securities—trading were transferred to securities—available-for-sale during the fourth quarter of 2023. Net unrealized holding losses of 
$3.4 million were recognized in 2023.  
Table of Contents 
92 

The following table presents gross gains and losses on sales and partial calls of securities—available-for-sale (in thousands): 
For the Year Ended December 31, 
2024 
2023 
2022 
Available-for-Sale: 
Gross Gains 
$ 
36 
$ 
383 $ 
522 
Gross Losses 
(5,529) 
(19,625) 
(3,770) 
Balance, end of the period 
$ 
(5,493) $ 
(19,242) $ 
(3,248) 
There were no securities—available-for-sale in a nonaccrual status at December 31, 2024 and 2023. 
The Company did not sell any held-to-maturity securities during the years ended December 31, 2024, 2023 and 2022. There were no 
securities—held-to-maturity in a nonaccrual status at December 31, 2024 and 2023. 
The following table presents the amortized cost and estimated fair value of securities at December 31, 2024, by contractual maturity and does 
not reflect any required periodic payments (in thousands). Expected maturities will differ from contractual maturities because some securities 
may be called or prepaid with or without call or prepayment penalties. 
December 31, 2024 
Available-for-Sale 
Held-to-Maturity 
Amortized 
Cost 
Fair Value 
Amortized 
Cost 
Fair Value 
Maturing within one year 
$ 
23,515 
$ 
23,286 
$ 
3,651 
$ 
3,492 
Maturing after one year through five years 
135,410 
128,115 
19,325 
18,790 
Maturing after five years through 10 years 
422,962 
388,640 
34,010 
31,511 
Maturing after 10 years 
1,878,375 
1,564,470 
944,875 
771,735 
$ 2,460,262 
$ 2,104,511 
$ 1,001,861 
$ 
825,528 
The following table presents, as of December 31, 2024, investment securities which were pledged to secure borrowings, public deposits or 
other obligations as permitted or required by law (in thousands): 
December 31, 2024 
Carrying Value 
Amortized Cost 
Fair Value 
Purpose or beneficiary: 
State and local governments public deposits 
$ 
281,954 
$ 
296,238 
$ 
250,692 
Interest rate swap counterparties 
959 
959 
769 
Repurchase transaction accounts 
215,610 
215,610 
170,700 
Other 
2,289 
2,289 
2,094 
Total pledged securities 
$ 
500,812 
$ 
515,096 
$ 
424,255 
Table of Contents 
93 

The Company monitors the credit quality of held-to-maturity debt securities using credit ratings which are reviewed and updated quarterly.  
The Company’s non-rated held-to-maturity debt securities are primarily United States government sponsored enterprise debentures carrying 
minimal to no credit risk. The non-rated corporate bonds primarily consist of Community Reinvestment Act related bonds secured by loan 
instruments from low to moderate income borrowers. The remaining non-rated held-to-maturity debt securities balance is comprised of local 
municipal debt from within the Company’s geographic footprint and is monitored through quarterly or annual financial review. This 
municipal debt is predominately essential service or unlimited general obligation backed debt. The following tables summarize the amortized 
cost of held-to-maturity debt securities by credit rating at December 31, 2024 and 2023 (in thousands): 
December 31, 2024 
U.S. Government 
and agency 
obligations 
Municipal bonds 
Corporate bonds 
Mortgage-backed 
or related 
securities 
Total 
AAA/AA/A 
$ 
— 
$ 
430,158 
$ 
500 
$ 
16,218 
$ 
446,876 
Not Rated 
302 
8,038 
2,158 
544,487 
554,985 
$ 
302 
$ 
438,196 
$ 
2,658 
$ 
560,705 
$ 
1,001,861 
December 31, 2023 
U.S. Government 
and agency 
obligations 
Municipal bonds 
Corporate bonds 
Mortgage-backed 
or related 
securities 
Total 
AAA/AA/A 
$ 
— 
$ 
456,999 
$ 
500 
$ 
16,459 
$ 
473,958 
Not Rated 
307 
9,033 
2,281 
573,808 
585,429 
$ 
307 
$ 
466,032 
$ 
2,781 
$ 
590,267 
$ 
1,059,387 
The following tables present the activity in the allowance for credit losses for held-to-maturity debt securities by major type for the year 
ended December 31, 2024 and 2023 (in thousands): 
For the Year Ended December 31, 2024 
Municipal bonds 
Corporate bonds 
Total 
Allowance for credit losses – securities 
Beginning balance 
$ 
157 
$ 
175 
$ 
332 
Recapture of provision for credit losses 
(14) 
(46) 
(60) 
Recoveries 
— 
25 
25 
Ending balance 
$ 
143 
$ 
154 
$ 
297 
For the Year Ended December 31, 2023 
Municipal bonds 
Corporate bonds 
Total 
Allowance for credit losses – securities 
Beginning balance 
$ 
183 
$ 
196 
$ 
379 
Recapture of provision for credit losses 
(26) 
(45) 
(71) 
Recoveries 
— 
24 
24 
Ending balance 
$ 
157 
$ 
175 
$ 
332 
For the Year Ended December 31, 2022 
Municipal bonds 
Corporate bonds 
Total 
Allowance for credit losses – securities 
Beginning balance 
$ 
203 
$ 
230 
$ 
433 
Recapture of provision for credit losses 
(20) 
(63) 
(83) 
Recoveries 
— 
29 
29 
Ending balance 
$ 
183 
$ 
196 
$ 
379 
Table of Contents 
94 

Note 4: LOANS RECEIVABLE AND THE ALLOWANCE FOR CREDIT LOSSES 
The following table presents the loans receivable at December 31, 2024 and 2023, by class (dollars in thousands): 
December 31, 2024 
December 31, 2023 
Amount 
Percent of Total 
Amount 
Percent of Total 
Commercial real estate: 
Owner-occupied 
$ 
1,027,426 
9 % $ 
915,897 
8 % 
Investment properties 
1,623,672 
14 
1,541,344 
14 
Small balance CRE 
1,213,792 
11 
1,178,500 
11 
Multifamily real estate 
894,425 
8 
811,232 
8 
Construction, land and land development: 
Commercial construction 
122,362 
1 
170,011 
2 
Multifamily construction 
513,706 
5 
503,993 
5 
One- to four-family construction 
514,220 
5 
526,432 
5 
Land and land development 
369,663 
3 
336,639 
3 
Commercial business: 
Commercial business 
1,318,333 
11 
1,255,734 
12 
Small business scored 
1,104,117 
10 
1,022,154 
9 
Agricultural business, including secured by farmland 
340,280 
3 
331,089 
3 
One- to four-family residential 
1,591,260 
14 
1,518,046 
14 
Consumer: 
Consumer—home equity revolving lines of credit 
625,680 
5 
588,703 
5 
Consumer—other 
95,720 
1 
110,681 
1 
Total loans 
11,354,656 
100 % 
10,810,455 
100 % 
Less allowance for credit losses – loans 
(155,521) 
(149,643) 
Net loans 
$ 
11,199,135 
$ 
10,660,812 
Loan amounts are net of unearned loan fees in excess of unamortized costs of $15.5 million as of December 31, 2024 and $12.1 million as of 
December 31, 2023. Net loans include net discounts on acquired loans of $3.5 million and $4.6 million as of December 31, 2024 and 2023, 
respectively. Net loans does not include accrued interest receivable. Accrued interest receivable on loans was $47.7 million as of 
December 31, 2024 and $47.8 million as of December 31, 2023 and was reported in accrued interest receivable on the Consolidated 
Statements of Financial Condition. 
At December 31, 2024 and 2023, the Company had pledged $7.9 billion and $7.6 billion of loans as collateral for FHLB and other 
borrowings, respectively. 
The Company’s loans to directors, executive officers and related entities are on substantially the same terms and underwriting as those 
prevailing at the time for comparable transactions with unrelated persons and do not involve more than normal risk of collectability. These 
loans had balances of $682,600 and $708,000 at December 31, 2024 and 2023 respectively. 
Purchased credit-deteriorated and purchased non-credit-deteriorated loans.  Loans purchased or acquired in business combinations are 
recorded at their fair value at the acquisition date. Acquired loans are evaluated upon acquisition and classified as either purchased credit-
deteriorated (PCD) or purchased non-credit-deteriorated.  There were no PCD loans at December 31, 2024 and 2023. 
Table of Contents 
95 

Troubled Loan Modifications.  Occasionally, the Company offers modifications of loans to borrowers experiencing financial difficulty by 
providing principal forgiveness, interest rate reductions, other-than-insignificant payment delays, term extensions or any combination of 
these. When principal forgiveness is provided, the amount of the forgiveness is charged-off against the allowance for credit losses - loans.  
Upon the Company’s determination that a modified loan (or portion of a loan) has subsequently been deemed uncollectible, the loan (or a 
portion of the loan) is charged off. Therefore, the amortized cost basis of the loan is reduced by the uncollectible amount and the allowance 
for credit losses - loans is adjusted by the same amount. The allowance for credit losses on modified loans is measured using similar credit 
loss estimation methods used to determine the allowance for credit losses for all other loans held for investment. These methods incorporate 
the post-modification loan terms, as well as defaults and charge-offs associated with historical modified loans. 
The following tables present the amortized cost basis and financial effect of loans that were experiencing financial difficulty and modified 
during the year ended December 31, 2024 and 2023 (in thousands): 
December 31, 2024 
Payment Delay 
Term Extension 
Total 
Commercial business 
$ 
2,889 $ 
1,480 $ 
4,369 
Total 
$ 
2,889 $ 
1,480 $ 
4,369 
December 31, 2023 
Payment Delay 
Term Extension 
Total 
One- to four-family construction 
$ 
— $ 
4,911 $ 
4,911 
Commercial business 
121 
— 
121 
Agricultural business, including secured by farmland 
1,580 
— 
1,580 
One- to four-family residential 
1,060 
— 
1,060 
Total 
$ 
2,761 $ 
4,911 $ 
7,672 
The Company had no commitments to lend additional amounts to the borrowers included in the previous tables as of December 31, 2024.  
The Company closely monitors the performance of loans that are modified for borrowers experiencing financial difficulty to understand the 
effectiveness of its modification efforts. 
The following tables present the performance at December 31, 2024 and 2023, of loans that had been modified in the previous 12 months (in 
thousands). 
December 31, 2024 
30-59 Days 
Past Due 
60-89 Days 
Past Due 
90 Days or 
More Past Due 
Nonaccrual 
Total 
Commercial business 
$ 
— 
$ 
— 
$ 
— 
$ 
2,889 
$ 
2,889 
Total 
$ 
— 
$ 
— 
$ 
— 
$ 
2,889 
$ 
2,889 
December 31, 2023 
30-59 Days 
Past Due 
60-89 Days 
Past Due 
90 Days or 
More Past Due 
Nonaccrual 
Total 
Commercial business 
$ 
— 
$ 
— 
$ 
— $ 
121 
$ 
121 
Agricultural business, including secured by 
farmland 
— 
— 
— 
1,580 
1,580 
One- to four-family residential 
— 
— 
— 
1,060 
1,060 
Total 
$ 
— 
$ 
— 
$ 
— $ 
2,761 
$ 
2,761 
The following tables present the financial effect of the loan modifications presented above for borrowers experiencing financial difficulty for 
December 31, 2024 and 2023: 
For the Year Ended December 31, 2024 
Weighted Average Payment Delay 
Period 
(in months) 
Weighted Average Term Extension 
(in months) 
Commercial business 
9 
3 
Table of Contents 
96 

For the Year Ended December 31, 2023 
Weighted Average Payment Delay 
Period (in months) 
Weighted-Average Term Extension 
(in months) 
One- to four-family construction 
n/a 
14 
Commercial business 
8 
n/a 
Agricultural business, including secured by farmland 
8 
n/a 
One- to four-family residential 
8 
n/a 
Credit Quality Indicators: To appropriately and effectively manage the ongoing credit quality of the Company’s loan portfolio, Management 
has implemented a risk-rating or loan grading system for its loans. The system is a tool to evaluate portfolio asset quality throughout each 
applicable loan’s life as an asset of the Company. Generally, loans are risk rated on an aggregate borrower/relationship basis with individual 
loans sharing similar ratings. There are some instances when specific situations relating to individual loans will provide the basis for different 
risk ratings within the aggregate relationship. Loans are graded on a scale of 1 to 9. A description of the general characteristics of these 
categories is shown below. 
Overall Risk Rating Definitions: Risk ratings contain both qualitative and quantitative measurements and take into account the financial 
strength of a borrower and the structure of the loan. Consequently, the definitions are to be applied in the context of each lending transaction 
and judgment must also be used to determine the appropriate risk rating, as it is not unusual for a loan to exhibit characteristics of more than 
one risk-rating category. Consideration for the final rating is centered on the borrower’s ability to repay, in a timely fashion, both principal 
and interest. The Company’s risk-rating and loan grading policies are reviewed and approved annually. There were no material changes in 
the risk-rating or loan grading system for the periods presented. 
Risk Ratings 1-5:  Pass 
Credits with risk ratings of 1 to 5 meet the definition of a pass risk rating. The strength of credits varies within the pass risk ratings, ranging 
from a risk rated 1 being an exceptional credit to a risk rated 5 being an acceptable credit that requires a more than normal level of 
supervision. 
Risk Rating 6: Special Mention 
A credit with potential weaknesses that deserves Management’s close attention is risk rated a 6. If left uncorrected, these potential 
weaknesses will result in deterioration in the capacity to repay debt. A key distinction between Special Mention and Substandard is that in a 
Special Mention credit, there are identified weaknesses that pose potential risk(s) to the repayment sources, versus well defined weaknesses 
that pose risk(s) to the repayment sources. Assets in this category are expected to be in this category no more than 9-12 months as the 
potential weaknesses in the credit are resolved. 
Risk Rating 7: Substandard 
A credit with well-defined weaknesses that jeopardize the ability to repay in full is risk rated a 7. These credits are inadequately protected by 
either the sound net worth and payment capacity of the borrower or the value of pledged collateral. These are credits with a distinct 
possibility of loss.  Loans headed for foreclosure and/or legal action due to deterioration are rated 7 or worse. 
Risk Rating 8: Doubtful 
A credit with an extremely high probability of loss is risk rated 8. These credits have all the same critical weaknesses that are found in a 
substandard loan; however, the weaknesses are elevated to the point that, based upon current information, collection or liquidation in full is 
improbable. 
While some loss on doubtful credits is expected, pending events may make the amount and timing of any loss 
indeterminable.  In these situations, taking the loss is inappropriate until the outcome of the pending event is clear. 
Risk Rating 9: Loss 
A credit that is considered to be currently uncollectible or of such little value that it is no longer a viable bank asset is risk rated 9. Losses 
should be taken in the accounting period in which the credit is determined to be uncollectible. Taking a loss does not mean that a credit has 
absolutely no recovery or salvage value but, rather, it is not practical or desirable to defer writing off the credit, even though partial recovery 
may occur in the future. 
Table of Contents 
97 

The following tables present the Company’s portfolio of risk-rated loans by class and by grade as of December 31, 2024 and 2023 (in thousands). In addition, the tables include the gross 
charge-offs for the year ended December 31, 2024. Revolving loans that are converted to term loans are treated as new originations in the table below and are presented by year of origination.  
Term loans that are renewed or extended for periods longer than 90 days are presented as a new origination in the year of the most recent renewal or extension. 
December 31, 2024 
By class: 
Term Loans by Year of Origination 
Revolving 
Loans 
Total 
Loans
2024 
2023 
2022 
2021 
2020 
Prior 
Commercial real estate - owner occupied 
Risk Rating 
Pass 
$ 188,895 
$ 171,046 
$ 120,470 
$ 152,940 
$ 107,495 
$ 174,221 
$ 
56,699 
$ 971,766 
Special Mention 
2,452 
— 
— 
— 
9,444 
— 
1,997 
13,893 
Substandard 
— 
292 
22,020 
2,182 
— 
17,273 
— 
41,767 
Doubtful 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
Loss 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
Total Commercial real estate - owner occupied 
$ 191,347 
$ 171,338 
$ 142,490 
$ 155,122 
$ 116,939 
$ 191,494 
$ 
58,696 
$ 1,027,426 
Current period gross charge-offs 
$ 
— 
$ 
— 
$ 
351 
$ 
— 
$ 
— 
$ 
— 
$ 
— 
$ 
351 
Commercial real estate - investment properties 
Risk Rating 
Pass 
$ 128,132 
$ 144,473 
$ 209,107 
$ 270,202 
$ 142,808 
$ 659,253 
$ 
51,925 
$ 1,605,900 
Special Mention 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
2,649 
2,027 
4,676 
Substandard 
— 
— 
5,724 
— 
— 
7,372 
— 
13,096 
Doubtful 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
Loss 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
Total Commercial real estate - investment properties 
$ 128,132 
$ 144,473 
$ 214,831 
$ 270,202 
$ 142,808 
$ 669,274 
$ 
53,952 
$ 1,623,672 
Current period gross charge-offs 
$ 
— 
$ 
— 
$ 
— 
$ 
— 
$ 
— 
$ 
— 
$ 
— 
$ 
— 
Multifamily real estate 
Risk Rating 
Pass 
$ 124,675 
$ 
87,955 
$ 206,373 
$ 205,964 
$ 
94,637 
$ 170,235 
$ 
2,461 
$ 892,300 
Special Mention 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
Substandard 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
2,125 
— 
2,125 
Doubtful 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
Loss 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
Total Multifamily real estate 
$ 124,675 
$ 
87,955 
$ 206,373 
$ 205,964 
$ 
94,637 
$ 172,360 
$ 
2,461 
$ 894,425 
Current period gross charge-offs 
$ 
— 
$ 
— 
$ 
— 
$ 
— 
$ 
— 
$ 
— 
$ 
— 
$ 
— 
Table of Contents 
98 

December 31, 2024 
By class: 
Term Loans by Year of Origination 
Revolving 
Loans 
Total 
Loans
2024 
2023 
2022 
2021 
2020 
Prior 
Commercial construction 
Risk Rating 
Pass 
$ 
75,095 
$ 
34,032 
$ 
12,481 
$ 
— 
$ 
— 
$ 
— 
$ 
— 
$ 121,608 
Special Mention 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
Substandard 
— 
— 
— 
754 
— 
— 
— 
754 
Doubtful 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
Loss 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
Total Commercial construction 
$ 
75,095 
$ 
34,032 
$ 
12,481 
$ 
754 
$ 
— 
$ 
— 
$ 
— 
$ 122,362 
Current period gross charge-offs 
$ 
— 
$ 
— 
$ 
— 
$ 
— 
$ 
— 
$ 
— 
$ 
— 
$ 
— 
Multifamily construction 
Risk Rating 
Pass 
$ 151,244 
$ 226,411 
$ 121,706 
$ 
— 
$ 
— 
$ 
— 
$ 
14,345 
$ 513,706 
Special Mention 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
Substandard 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
Doubtful 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
Loss 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
Total Multifamily construction 
$ 151,244 
$ 226,411 
$ 121,706 
$ 
— 
$ 
— 
$ 
— 
$ 
14,345 
$ 513,706 
Current period gross charge-offs 
$ 
— 
$ 
— 
$ 
— 
$ 
— 
$ 
— 
$ 
— 
$ 
— 
$ 
— 
One- to four- family construction 
Risk Rating 
Pass 
$ 445,602 
$ 
50,521 
$ 
10,744 
$ 
— 
$ 
— 
$ 
— 
$ 
322 
$ 507,189 
Special Mention 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
Substandard 
6,293 
738 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
7,031 
Doubtful 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
Loss 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
Total One- to four- family construction 
$ 451,895 
$ 
51,259 
$ 
10,744 
$ 
— 
$ 
— 
$ 
— 
$ 
322 
$ 514,220 
Current period gross charge-offs 
$ 
— 
$ 
— 
$ 
150 
$ 
— 
$ 
— 
$ 
— 
$ 
— 
$ 
150 
Table of Contents 
99 

December 31, 2024 
By class: 
Term Loans by Year of Origination 
Revolving 
Loans 
Total 
Loans
2024 
2023 
2022 
2021 
2020 
Prior 
Land and land development 
Risk Rating 
Pass 
$ 197,490 
$ 
85,344 
$ 
33,283 
$ 
22,897 
$ 
9,575 
$ 
13,871 
$ 
1,106 
$ 363,566 
Special Mention 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
Substandard 
3,764 
1,098 
396 
277 
562 
— 
— 
6,097 
Doubtful 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
Loss 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
Total Land and land development 
$ 201,254 
$ 
86,442 
$ 
33,679 
$ 
23,174 
$ 
10,137 
$ 
13,871 
$ 
1,106 
$ 369,663 
Current period gross charge-offs 
$ 
— 
$ 
— 
$ 
— 
$ 
— 
$ 
— 
$ 
— 
$ 
— 
$ 
— 
Commercial business 
Risk Rating 
Pass 
$ 168,794 
$ 129,476 
$ 186,001 
$ 
97,590 
$ 108,881 
$ 192,416 
$ 365,770 
$ 1,248,928 
Special Mention 
241 
— 
657 
818 
— 
727 
12,022 
14,465 
Substandard 
2,889 
1,714 
547 
947 
3,214 
2,274 
43,355 
54,940 
Doubtful 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
Loss 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
Total Commercial business 
$ 171,924 
$ 131,190 
$ 187,205 
$ 
99,355 
$ 112,095 
$ 195,417 
$ 421,147 
$ 1,318,333 
Current period gross charge-offs 
$ 
2,301 
$ 
418 
$ 
— 
$ 
689 
$ 
— 
$ 
54 
$ 
558 
$ 
4,020 
Agricultural business, including secured by farmland 
Risk Rating 
Pass 
$ 
22,330 
$ 
40,228 
$ 
19,475 
$ 
22,117 
$ 
12,746 
$ 
53,884 
$ 127,755 
$ 298,535 
Special Mention 
— 
— 
670 
— 
— 
— 
6,684 
7,354 
Substandard 
1,962 
8,980 
9,999 
1,183 
3,367 
8,850 
50 
34,391 
Doubtful 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
Loss 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
Total Agricultural business, including secured by farmland 
$ 
24,292 
$ 
49,208 
$ 
30,144 
$ 
23,300 
$ 
16,113 
$ 
62,734 
$ 134,489 
$ 340,280 
Current period gross charge-offs 
$ 
— 
$ 
— 
$ 
— 
$ 
— 
$ 
— 
$ 
— 
$ 
— 
$ 
— 
Table of Contents 
100 

December 31, 2023 
By class: 
Term Loans by Year of Origination 
Revolving 
Loans 
Total 
Loans
2023 
2022 
2021 
2020 
2019 
Prior 
Commercial real estate - owner occupied 
Risk Rating 
Pass 
$ 170,577 
$ 149,489 
$ 161,647 
$ 139,934 
$ 
65,424 
$ 154,036 
$ 
36,209 
$ 877,316 
Special Mention 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
1 
1 
Substandard 
— 
14,450 
217 
4,731 
18,999 
183 
— 
38,580 
Doubtful 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
Loss 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
Total Commercial real estate - owner occupied 
$ 170,577 
$ 163,939 
$ 161,864 
$ 144,665 
$ 
84,423 
$ 154,219 
$ 
36,210 
$ 915,897 
Commercial real estate - investment properties 
Risk Rating 
Pass 
$ 154,128 
$ 168,286 
$ 281,324 
$ 123,315 
$ 156,174 
$ 597,977 
$ 
47,936 
$ 1,529,140 
Special Mention 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
2,714 
1,198 
3,912 
Substandard 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
8,292 
— 
8,292 
Doubtful 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
Loss 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
Total Commercial real estate - investment properties 
$ 154,128 
$ 168,286 
$ 281,324 
$ 123,315 
$ 156,174 
$ 608,983 
$ 
49,134 
$ 1,541,344 
Multifamily real estate 
Risk Rating 
Pass 
$ 
96,865 
$ 177,907 
$ 215,220 
$ 101,336 
$ 
46,886 
$ 167,305 
$ 
3,285 
$ 808,804 
Special Mention 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
Substandard 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
2,428 
— 
2,428 
Doubtful 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
Loss 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
Total Multifamily real estate 
$ 
96,865 
$ 177,907 
$ 215,220 
$ 101,336 
$ 
46,886 
$ 169,733 
$ 
3,285 
$ 811,232 
Table of Contents 
101 

December 31, 2023 
By class: 
Term Loans by Year of Origination 
Revolving 
Loans 
Total 
Loans
2023 
2022 
2021 
2020 
2019 
Prior 
Commercial construction 
Risk Rating 
Pass 
$ 
86,165 
$ 
62,302 
$ 
4,056 
$ 
12,705 
$ 
— 
$ 
1,015 
$ 
— 
$ 166,243 
Special Mention 
3,010 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
3,010 
Substandard 
— 
— 
758 
— 
— 
— 
— 
758 
Doubtful 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
Loss 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
Total Commercial construction 
$ 
89,175 
$ 
62,302 
$ 
4,814 
$ 
12,705 
$ 
— 
$ 
1,015 
$ 
— 
$ 170,011 
Multifamily construction 
Risk Rating 
Pass 
$ 176,729 
$ 256,661 
$ 
70,189 
$ 
414 
$ 
— 
$ 
— 
$ 
— 
$ 503,993 
Special Mention 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
Substandard 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
Doubtful 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
Loss 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
Total Multifamily construction 
$ 176,729 
$ 256,661 
$ 
70,189 
$ 
414 
$ 
— 
$ 
— 
$ 
— 
$ 503,993 
One- to four- family construction 
Risk Rating 
Pass 
$ 447,818 
$ 
43,563 
$ 
25,229 
$ 
— 
$ 
329 
$ 
— 
$ 
381 
$ 517,320 
Special Mention 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
Substandard 
6,715 
253 
2,144 
— 
— 
— 
— 
9,112 
Doubtful 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
Loss 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
Total One- to four- family construction 
$ 454,533 
$ 
43,816 
$ 
27,373 
$ 
— 
$ 
329 
$ 
— 
$ 
381 
$ 526,432 
Table of Contents 
102 

December 31, 2023 
By class: 
Term Loans by Year of Origination 
Revolving 
Loans 
Total 
Loans
2023 
2022 
2021 
2020 
2019 
Prior 
Land and land development 
Risk Rating 
Pass 
$ 188,134 
$ 
80,472 
$ 
34,146 
$ 
12,338 
$ 
8,409 
$ 
10,152 
$ 
2,136 
$ 335,787 
Special Mention 
— 
852 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
852 
Substandard 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
Doubtful 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
Loss 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
Total Land and land development 
$ 188,134 
$ 
81,324 
$ 
34,146 
$ 
12,338 
$ 
8,409 
$ 
10,152 
$ 
2,136 
$ 336,639 
Commercial business 
Risk Rating 
Pass 
$ 157,830 
$ 223,582 
$ 121,031 
$ 134,066 
$ 102,545 
$ 126,175 
$ 363,652 
$ 1,228,881 
Special Mention 
199 
— 
— 
— 
43 
— 
2,548 
2,790 
Substandard 
1,919 
5,207 
3,398 
5,207 
1,509 
2,010 
4,813 
24,063 
Doubtful 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
Loss 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
Total Commercial business 
$ 159,948 
$ 228,789 
$ 124,429 
$ 139,273 
$ 104,097 
$ 128,185 
$ 371,013 
$ 1,255,734 
Agricultural business, including secured by farmland 
Risk Rating 
Pass 
$ 
48,620 
$ 
35,520 
$ 
24,659 
$ 
17,658 
$ 
23,885 
$ 
38,273 
$ 123,158 
$ 311,773 
Special Mention 
550 
— 
652 
— 
— 
301 
308 
1,811 
Substandard 
4,057 
— 
626 
— 
7,819 
2,280 
2,723 
17,505 
Doubtful 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
Loss 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
Total Agricultural business, including secured by farmland 
$ 
53,227 
$ 
35,520 
$ 
25,937 
$ 
17,658 
$ 
31,704 
$ 
40,854 
$ 126,189 
$ 331,089 
Table of Contents 
103 

The following tables present the Company’s portfolio of non-risk-rated loans by class and delinquency status as of December 31, 2024 and 2023 (in thousands). In addition, the tables include 
the gross charge-offs for the year ended December 31, 2024. Revolving loans that are converted to term loans are treated as new originations in the table below and are presented by year of 
origination.  Term loans that are renewed or extended for periods longer than 90 days are presented as a new origination in the year of the most recent renewal or extension. 
December 31, 2024 
Term Loans by Year of Origination 
Revolving 
Loans 
Total 
Loans
By class: 
2024 
2023 
2022 
2021 
2020 
Prior 
Small balance CRE 
Past Due Category 
Current 
$ 
66,708 
$ 
87,829 
$ 198,461 
$ 209,983 
$ 166,244 
$ 484,567 
$ 
— 
$ 1,213,792 
30-59 Days Past Due 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
60-89 Days Past Due 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
90 Days + Past Due 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
Total Small balance CRE 
$ 
66,708 
$ 
87,829 
$ 198,461 
$ 209,983 
$ 166,244 
$ 484,567 
$ 
— 
$ 1,213,792 
Current period gross charge-offs 
$ 
— 
$ 
— 
$ 
— 
$ 
— 
$ 
— 
$ 
— 
$ 
— 
$ 
— 
Small business scored 
Past Due Category 
Current 
$ 209,692 
$ 172,327 
$ 236,769 
$ 146,220 
$ 
69,795 
$ 123,250 
$ 139,836 
$ 1,097,889 
30-59 Days Past Due 
16 
62 
1,084 
650 
104 
523 
523 
2,962 
60-89 Days Past Due 
— 
823 
75 
252 
— 
88 
30 
1,268 
90 Days + Past Due 
— 
135 
1,349 
343 
5 
166 
— 
1,998 
Total Small business scored 
$ 209,708 
$ 173,347 
$ 239,277 
$ 147,465 
$ 
69,904 
$ 124,027 
$ 140,389 
$ 1,104,117 
Current period gross charge-offs 
$ 
82 
$ 
122 
$ 
522 
$ 
575 
$ 
47 
$ 
587 
$ 
— 
$ 
1,935 
One- to four- family residential 
Past Due Category 
Current 
$ 219,254 
$ 306,523 
$ 537,271 
$ 246,070 
$ 
51,761 
$ 207,017 
$ 
— 
$ 1,567,896 
30-59 Days Past Due 
1,743 
1,731 
2,733 
762 
469 
1,818 
— 
9,256 
60-89 Days Past Due 
533 
570 
1,635 
270 
442 
1,099 
— 
4,549 
90 Days + Past Due 
— 
2,000 
2,459 
2,983 
1,156 
961 
— 
9,559 
Total One- to four- family residential 
$ 221,530 
$ 310,824 
$ 544,098 
$ 250,085 
$ 
53,828 
$ 210,895 
$ 
— 
$ 1,591,260 
Current period gross charge-offs 
$ 
— 
$ 
— 
$ 
— 
$ 
— 
$ 
— 
$ 
— 
$ 
— 
$ 
— 
Table of Contents 
104 

December 31, 2024 
Term Loans by Year of Origination 
Revolving 
Loans 
Total 
Loans
By class: 
2024 
2023 
2022 
2021 
2020 
Prior 
Consumer—home equity revolving lines of credit 
Past Due Category 
Current 
$ 
4,551 
$ 
975 
$ 
6,884 
$ 
1,964 
$ 
2,243 
$ 
6,582 
$ 595,115 
$ 618,314 
30-59 Days Past Due 
— 
100 
1,571 
98 
— 
335 
1,532 
3,636 
60-89 Days Past Due 
— 
— 
237 
561 
— 
384 
136 
1,318 
90 Days + Past Due 
— 
766 
247 
190 
190 
1,019 
— 
2,412 
Total Consumer—home equity revolving lines of credit 
$ 
4,551 
$ 
1,841 
$ 
8,939 
$ 
2,813 
$ 
2,433 
$ 
8,320 
$ 596,783 
$ 625,680 
Current period gross charge-offs 
$ 
— 
$ 
— 
$ 
58 
$ 
— 
$ 
11 
$ 
1 
$ 
110 
$ 
180 
Consumer-other 
Past Due Category 
Current 
$ 
9,329 
$ 
6,333 
$ 
25,334 
$ 
8,243 
$ 
5,390 
$ 
17,374 
$ 
23,185 
$ 
95,188 
30-59 Days Past Due 
5 
— 
54 
— 
3 
88 
166 
316 
60-89 Days Past Due 
2 
15 
20 
39 
— 
1 
94 
171 
90 Days + Past Due 
— 
— 
45 
— 
— 
— 
— 
45 
Total Consumer-other 
$ 
9,336 
$ 
6,348 
$ 
25,453 
$ 
8,282 
$ 
5,393 
$ 
17,463 
$ 
23,445 
$ 
95,720 
Current period gross charge-offs 
$ 
9 
$ 
50 
$ 
105 
$ 
71 
$ 
37 
$ 
211 
$ 
1,247 
$ 
1,730 
Table of Contents 
105 

December 31, 2023 
Term Loans by Year of Origination 
Revolving 
Loans 
Total 
Loans
By class: 
2023 
2022 
2021 
2020 
2019 
Prior 
Small balance CRE 
Past Due Category 
Current 
$ 
83,077 
$ 194,213 
$ 215,550 
$ 163,689 
$ 121,596 
$ 399,025 
$ 
378 
$ 1,177,528 
30-59 Days Past Due 
— 
— 
— 
— 
159 
400 
— 
559 
60-89 Days Past Due 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
90 Days + Past Due 
— 
— 
— 
413 
— 
— 
— 
413 
Total Small balance CRE 
$ 
83,077 
$ 194,213 
$ 215,550 
$ 164,102 
$ 121,755 
$ 399,425 
$ 
378 
$ 1,178,500 
Small business scored 
Past Due Category 
Current 
$ 197,138 
$ 276,888 
$ 172,286 
$ 
84,320 
$ 
61,613 
$ 
96,269 
$ 129,998 
$ 1,018,512 
30-59 Days Past Due 
16 
171 
1,048 
52 
169 
287 
307 
2,050 
60-89 Days Past Due 
18 
— 
— 
60 
79 
393 
83 
633 
90 Days + Past Due 
24 
69 
148 
— 
460 
257 
1 
959 
Total Small business scored 
$ 197,196 
$ 277,128 
$ 173,482 
$ 
84,432 
$ 
62,321 
$ 
97,206 
$ 130,389 
$ 1,022,154 
One- to four- family residential 
Past Due Category 
Current 
$ 360,797 
$ 586,167 
$ 262,414 
$ 
56,436 
$ 
31,275 
$ 206,247 
$ 
209 
$ 1,503,545 
30-59 Days Past Due 
846 
3,087 
979 
511 
— 
1,441 
— 
6,864 
60-89 Days Past Due 
— 
540 
510 
388 
151 
790 
— 
2,379 
90 Days + Past Due 
1,060 
700 
1,582 
192 
633 
1,091 
— 
5,258 
Total One- to four- family residential 
$ 362,703 
$ 590,494 
$ 265,485 
$ 
57,527 
$ 
32,059 
$ 209,569 
$ 
209 
$ 1,518,046 
Table of Contents 
106 

December 31, 2023 
Term Loans by Year of Origination 
Revolving 
Loans 
Total 
Loans
By class: 
2023 
2022 
2021 
2020 
2019 
Prior 
Consumer—home equity revolving lines of credit 
Past Due Category 
Current 
$ 
5,003 
$ 
2,594 
$ 
1,564 
$ 
1,200 
$ 
1,177 
$ 
4,678 
$ 566,249 
$ 582,465 
30-59 Days Past Due 
— 
51 
93 
66 
175 
324 
2,063 
2,772 
60-89 Days Past Due 
— 
— 
98 
— 
50 
246 
445 
839 
90 Days + Past Due 
— 
365 
178 
1,043 
19 
966 
56 
2,627 
Total Consumer—home equity revolving lines of credit 
$ 
5,003 
$ 
3,010 
$ 
1,933 
$ 
2,309 
$ 
1,421 
$ 
6,214 
$ 568,813 
$ 588,703 
Consumer-other 
Past Due Category 
Current 
$ 
10,756 
$ 
31,836 
$ 
9,961 
$ 
6,906 
$ 
4,441 
$ 
17,920 
$ 
28,207 
$ 110,027 
30-59 Days Past Due 
5 
— 
62 
— 
— 
81 
269 
417 
60-89 Days Past Due 
12 
— 
4 
2 
20 
6 
97 
141 
90 Days + Past Due 
— 
58 
— 
28 
10 
— 
— 
96 
Total Consumer-other 
$ 
10,773 
$ 
31,894 
$ 
10,027 
$ 
6,936 
$ 
4,471 
$ 
18,007 
$ 
28,573 
$ 110,681 
Table of Contents 
107 

The following tables provide the amortized cost basis of collateral-dependent loans as of December 31, 2024 and 2023 (in thousands). Our collateral dependent loans presented in the tables 
below have no significant concentrations by property type or location. 
December 31, 2024 
Real Estate 
Accounts Receivable 
Equipment 
Inventory 
Total 
Commercial real estate: 
Owner-occupied 
$ 
2,182 
$ 
— 
$ 
— 
$ 
— 
$ 
2,182 
One- to four-family construction 
1,834 
— 
— 
— 
1,834 
Land and land development 
1,622 
— 
— 
— 
1,622 
Commercial business: 
Commercial business 
— 
1,789 
1,660 
427 
3,876 
Small business scored 
623 
— 
— 
— 
623 
Agricultural business, including secured by farmland 
5,013 
— 
3,447 
— 
8,460 
One- to four-family residential 
5,374 
— 
— 
— 
5,374 
Consumer—home equity revolving lines of credit 
977 
— 
— 
— 
977 
Total 
$ 
17,625 
$ 
1,789 
$ 
5,107 
$ 
427 
$ 
24,948 
December 31, 2023 
Real Estate 
Accounts Receivable 
Equipment 
Inventory 
Total 
Commercial real estate: 
Owner-occupied 
$ 
1,391 $ 
— $ 
— $ 
— $ 
1,391 
Small balance CRE 
$ 
755 
— $ 
— 
— $ 
755 
One- to four-family construction 
8,859 
— 
— 
— 
8,859 
Commercial business 
— 
1,059 
5,085 
812 
6,956 
Agricultural business, including secured by farmland 
2,576 
— 
— 
— 
2,576 
One- to four-family residential 
1,954 
— 
— 
— 
1,954 
Consumer—home equity revolving lines of credit 
821 
— 
— 
— 
821 
Total 
$ 
16,356 $ 
1,059 $ 
5,085 $ 
812 $ 
23,312 
Table of Contents 
108 

The following tables provide additional detail on the age analysis of the Company’s past due loans as of December 31, 2024 and 2023 (in thousands): 
December 31, 2024 
30-59 Days 
Past Due 
60-89 Days 
Past Due 
90 Days or 
More Past 
Due 
Total Past 
Due 
Current 
Total Loans 
Non-accrual 
with no 
Allowance 
Total Non-
accrual (1) 
Loans 90 
Days or 
More Past 
Due and 
Accruing 
Commercial real estate: 
Owner-occupied 
$ 
— 
$ 
— 
$ 
2,182 
$ 
2,182 
$ 1,025,244 
$ 1,027,426 
$ 
— 
$ 
2,182 
$ 
— 
Investment properties 
— 
— 
— 
— 
1,623,672 
1,623,672 
— 
— 
— 
Small balance CRE 
— 
— 
— 
— 
1,213,792 
1,213,792 
— 
4 
— 
Multifamily real estate 
— 
— 
— 
— 
894,425 
894,425 
— 
— 
— 
Construction, land and land development: 
Commercial construction 
754 
— 
— 
754 
121,608 
122,362 
— 
— 
— 
Multifamily construction 
— 
— 
— 
— 
513,706 
513,706 
— 
— 
— 
One- to four-family construction 
— 
— 
738 
738 
513,482 
514,220 
1,834 
1,834 
— 
Land and land development 
1,600 
796 
1,568 
3,964 
365,699 
369,663 
1,622 
2,129 
— 
Commercial business: 
Commercial business 
2,025 
— 
1,012 
3,037 
1,315,296 
1,318,333 
123 
4,103 
— 
Small business scored 
2,962 
1,268 
1,998 
6,228 
1,097,889 
1,104,117 
623 
2,964 
— 
Agricultural business, including secured by 
farmland 
190 
— 
7,077 
7,267 
333,013 
340,280 
4,829 
8,485 
— 
One- to four-family residential 
9,256 
4,549 
9,559 
23,364 
1,567,896 
1,591,260 
5,374 
10,016 
369 
Consumer: 
Consumer—home equity revolving lines of 
credit 
3,636 
1,318 
2,412 
7,366 
618,314 
625,680 
977 
4,790 
35 
Consumer—other 
316 
171 
45 
532 
95,188 
95,720 
— 
45 
— 
Total 
$ 
20,739 
$ 
8,102 
$ 
26,591 
$ 
55,432 
$ 11,299,224 
$ 11,354,656 
$ 
15,382 
$ 
36,552 
$ 
404 
Table of Contents 
109 

December 31, 2023 
30-59 Days 
Past Due 
60-89 Days 
Past Due 
90 Days or 
More Past 
Due 
Total Past 
Due 
Current 
Total Loans 
Non-accrual 
with no 
Allowance 
Total Non-
accrual (1) 
Loans 90 
Days or 
More Past 
Due and 
Accruing 
Commercial real estate: 
Owner-occupied 
$ 
— 
$ 
— 
$ 
— 
$ 
— 
$ 
915,897 
$ 
915,897 
$ 
1,391 $ 
1,450 
$ 
— 
Investment properties 
— 
— 
— 
— 
1,541,344 
1,541,344 
— 
— 
— 
Small balance CRE 
559 
— 
413 
972 
1,177,528 
1,178,500 
755 
1,227 
— 
Multifamily real estate 
— 
— 
— 
— 
811,232 
811,232 
— 
— 
— 
Construction, land and land development: 
Commercial construction 
— 
— 
— 
— 
170,011 
170,011 
— 
— 
— 
Multifamily construction 
— 
— 
— 
— 
503,993 
503,993 
— 
— 
— 
One- to four-family construction 
286 
— 
4,201 
4,487 
521,945 
526,432 
2,852 
3,105 
1,096 
Land and land development 
1,822 
553 
42 
2,417 
334,222 
336,639 
— 
— 
42 
Commercial business: 
Commercial business 
1,166 
5,735 
1,181 
8,082 
1,247,652 
1,255,734 
789 
7,346 
— 
Small business scored 
2,050 
633 
959 
3,642 
1,018,512 
1,022,154 
— 
1,656 
1 
Agricultural business, including secured by 
farmland 
— 
— 
2,171 
2,171 
328,918 
331,089 
3,167 
3,167 
— 
One- to four-family residential 
6,864 
2,379 
5,258 
14,501 
1,503,545 
1,518,046 
1,939 
5,702 
1,205 
Consumer: 
Consumer—home equity revolving lines of 
credit 
2,772 
839 
2,627 
6,238 
582,465 
588,703 
821 
3,110 
391 
Consumer—other 
417 
141 
96 
654 
110,027 
110,681 
— 
94 
10 
Total 
$ 
15,936 
$ 
10,280 
$ 
16,948 
$ 
43,164 
$ 10,767,291 
$ 10,810,455 
$ 
11,714 $ 
26,857 
$ 
2,745 
Table of Contents 
110 
(1)   The Company did not recognize any interest income on non-accrual loans during the years ended December 31, 2024 and 2023. 

Management estimates the allowance for credit losses using relevant information, from internal and external sources, relating to past events, current conditions, and reasonable and supportable 
forecasts. Management considers QE factors for each loan category to adjust for differences between the historical periods used to calculate historical loss rates and expected conditions over 
the remaining lives of the loans in the portfolio. Management uses a scale to assign QE factor adjustments based on the level of estimated impact which requires a significant amount of 
judgment. The Company evaluated each qualitative factor as of December 31, 2024 and concluded that the models adequately reflected the significant changes in credit conditions and overall 
portfolio risk. The qualitative adjustments in the allowance for credit losses during 2024 were primarily related to environmental, collateral and concentration related factors. This evaluation 
resulted in a 35 basis-point increase in the construction and land category.  All other loan categories had nominal changes in their qualitative factor adjustments. 
The following tables provide the activity in the allowance for credit losses - loans by portfolio segment for the years ended December 31, 2024, 2023 and 2022 (in thousands): 
For the Year Ended December 31, 2024 
Commercial 
Real Estate 
Multifamily 
Real Estate 
Construction 
and Land 
Commercial 
Business 
Agricultural 
Business 
One- to 
Four-Family 
Residential 
Consumer 
Total 
Allowance for credit losses: 
Beginning balance 
$ 
44,384 
$ 
9,326 
$ 
28,095 
$ 
35,464 
$ 
3,865 
$ 
19,271 
$ 
9,238 
$ 149,643 
(Recapture)/provision for credit losses 
(5,970) 
982 
1,093 
7,139 
1,558 
1,365 
2,396 
8,563 
Recoveries 
2,767 
— 
— 
1,963 
304 
171 
476 
5,681 
Charge-offs 
(351) 
— 
(150) 
(5,955) 
— 
— 
(1,910) 
(8,366) 
Ending balance 
$ 
40,830 
$ 
10,308 
$ 
29,038 
$ 
38,611 
$ 
5,727 
$ 
20,807 
$ 
10,200 
$ 155,521 
Net loan recoveries (charge-offs) as a percent of average 
outstanding loans during the period 
0.02 % 
— % 
— % 
(0.04) % 
— % 
— % 
(0.01) % 
(0.02) % 
For the Year Ended December 31, 2023 
Commercial 
Real Estate 
Multifamily 
Real Estate 
Construction 
and Land 
Commercial 
Business 
Agricultural 
Business 
One- to 
Four-Family 
Residential 
Consumer 
Total 
Allowance for credit losses: 
Beginning balance 
$ 
44,086 
$ 
7,734 
$ 
29,171 
$ 
33,299 
$ 
3,475 
$ 
14,729 
$ 
8,971 
$ 141,465 
(Recapture)/provision for credit losses 
(259) 
1,592 
(16) 
3,532 
808 
4,354 
1,086 
11,097 
Recoveries 
557 
— 
29 
1,283 
146 
230 
543 
2,788 
Charge-offs 
— 
— 
(1,089) 
(2,650) 
(564) 
(42) 
(1,362) 
(5,707) 
Ending balance 
$ 
44,384 
$ 
9,326 
$ 
28,095 
$ 
35,464 
$ 
3,865 
$ 
19,271 
$ 
9,238 
$ 149,643 
Net loan recoveries (charge-offs) as a percent of average 
outstanding loans during the period 
0.01 % 
— % 
(0.01) % 
(0.01) % 
— % 
— % 
(0.01) % 
(0.03) % 
Table of Contents 
111 

For the Year Ended December 31, 2022 
Commercial 
Real Estate 
Multifamily 
Real Estate 
Construction 
and Land 
Commercial 
Business 
Agricultural 
Business 
One- to 
Four-Family 
Residential 
Consumer 
Total 
Allowance for credit losses: 
Beginning balance 
$ 
52,995 
$ 
7,043 
$ 
27,294 
$ 
26,421 
$ 
3,190 
$ 
8,205 
$ 
6,951 
$ 132,099 
(Recapture)/provision for loan losses 
(9,299) 
691 
1,523 
6,654 
(148) 
6,343 
2,394 
8,158 
Recoveries 
392 
— 
384 
1,923 
475 
181 
566 
3,921 
Charge-offs 
(2) 
— 
(30) 
(1,699) 
(42) 
— 
(940) 
(2,713) 
Ending balance 
$ 
44,086 
$ 
7,734 
$ 
29,171 
$ 
33,299 
$ 
3,475 
$ 
14,729 
$ 
8,971 
$ 141,465 
Net loan recoveries as a percent of average outstanding loans 
during the period 
— % 
— % 
— % 
— % 
— % 
— % 
— % 
0.01 % 
Table of Contents 
112 

Note 5: PROPERTY AND EQUIPMENT, NET 
Land, buildings and equipment owned by the Company and its subsidiaries at December 31, 2024 and 2023, are summarized as follows (in 
thousands): 
December 31 
2024 
2023 
Land(1) 
$ 
25,616 
$ 
26,133 
Buildings and leasehold improvements (1) 
144,480 
145,467 
Furniture and equipment 
147,595 
137,640 
317,691 
309,240 
Less accumulated depreciation 
(193,102) 
(177,009) 
Property and equipment, net 
$ 
124,589 
$ 
132,231 
(1) The Company had $29,000 and $1.9 million of properties held for sale that were included in land and buildings at December 31, 2024 and 
2023, respectively. 
The Company’s depreciation expense related to property and equipment was $18.1 million, $17.9 million and $16.9 million for the years 
ended December 31, 2024, 2023 and 2022, respectively. 
Note 6: DEPOSITS 
Deposits consist of the following at December 31, 2024 and 2023 (in thousands): 
December 31 
2024 
2023 
Non-interest-bearing checking 
$ 
4,591,543 
$ 
4,792,369 
Interest-bearing checking 
2,393,864 
2,098,526 
Regular savings accounts 
3,478,423 
2,980,530 
Money market accounts 
1,550,896 
1,680,605 
Total interest-bearing transaction and savings accounts 
7,423,183 
6,759,661 
Certificates of deposit: 
Certificates of deposit greater than or equal to $250,000 
487,515 
473,124 
Certificates of deposit less than $250,000 
1,012,157 
1,004,343 
Total certificates of deposit 
1,499,672 
1,477,467 
Total deposits 
$ 
13,514,398 
$ 
13,029,497 
Included in total deposits: 
Public fund transaction accounts 
$ 
414,413 
$ 
356,615 
Public fund interest-bearing certificates 
25,423 
52,048 
Total public deposits 
$ 
439,836 
$ 
408,663 
Total brokered deposits 
$ 
50,346 
$ 
108,058 
Table of Contents 
113 
Deposits at December 31, 2024 and 2023 included deposits from the Company’s directors, executive officers and related entities totaling 
$10.2 million and $9.2 million, respectively. 

Scheduled maturities and weighted average interest rates of certificates of deposits at December 31, 2024 are as follows (dollars in 
thousands): 
December 31, 2024 
Amount 
Weighted Average Rate 
Maturing in one year or less 
$ 
1,448,449 
3.84 % 
Maturing after one year through two years 
31,053 
1.22 
Maturing after two years through three years 
13,222 
1.00 
Maturing after three years through four years 
3,857 
0.71 
Maturing after four years through five years 
2,492 
0.85 
Maturing after five years 
599 
0.58 
Total certificates of deposit 
$ 
1,499,672 
3.75 % 
Note 7: ADVANCES FROM FEDERAL HOME LOAN BANK 
Utilizing a blanket pledge, qualifying loans receivable at December 31, 2024 and 2023, were pledged as security for FHLB borrowings and 
there were no securities pledged as collateral as of December 31, 2024 or 2023. At December 31, 2024 and 2023, FHLB advances were 
scheduled to mature as follows (dollars in thousands): 
December 31, 
2024 
2023 
Amount 
Weighted Average Rate 
Amount 
Weighted Average Rate 
Maturing in one year or less 
$ 
290,000 
4.62 % $ 
323,000 
5.64 % 
Total FHLB advances 
$ 
290,000 
4.62 % $ 
323,000 
5.64 % 
The maximum amount outstanding from the FHLB advances at any month end for the years ended December 31, 2024 and 2023 was $398.0 
million and $645.0 million, respectively. The average FHLB advances balance outstanding for the years ended December 31, 2024 and 2023 
was $160.0 million and $196.8 million, respectively. The average contractual interest rate on the FHLB advances for the years ended 
December 31, 2024 and 2023 was 5.59% and 5.35%, respectively. As of December 31, 2024, the Bank has established a borrowing line with 
the FHLB to borrow up to 45% of its total assets, contingent on having sufficient qualifying collateral and ownership of FHLB stock. At 
December 31, 2024, under these credit facilities based on pledged collateral, the Bank had $2.95 billion of available credit capacity. 
Note 8: OTHER BORROWINGS 
Other borrowings consist of retail and wholesale repurchase agreements, other term borrowings and Federal Reserve Bank borrowings. 
Repurchase Agreements: At December 31, 2024, retail repurchase agreements carry interest rates ranging from 0.05% to 3.94%. These 
repurchase agreements are secured by the pledge of certain mortgage-backed and agency securities with a carrying value of 
$215.6 million. The Bank has the right to pledge or sell these securities, but it must replace them with substantially the same securities. The 
Bank had no borrowings under wholesale repurchase agreements at December 31, 2024 and 2023. 
Federal Reserve Bank of San Francisco and fed fund lines: The Bank periodically borrows funds on an overnight basis from the Federal 
Reserve Bank through the Borrower-In-Custody program. These borrowings are secured by a pledge of eligible loans. At December 31, 
2024, based upon available unencumbered collateral, the Bank was eligible to borrow $1.52 billion from the Federal Reserve Bank.  
However, as of that date, as well as December 31, 2023, the Bank had no funds borrowed under this arrangement. 
At December 31, 2024, the Bank had uncommitted federal funds lines of credit agreements with other financial institutions totaling $125.0 
million. No balances were outstanding under these agreements as of December 31, 2024 and 2023. Availability of lines is subject to federal 
funds balances available for loan and continued borrower eligibility. These lines are intended to support short-term liquidity needs and the 
agreements may restrict consecutive day usage. 
Table of Contents 
114 

A summary of all other borrowings at December 31, 2024 and 2023, by the period remaining to maturity is as follows (dollars in thousands): 
December 31, 
2024 
2023 
Amount 
Weighted 
Average Rate 
Amount 
Weighted 
Average Rate 
Repurchase agreements: 
Maturing in one year or less 
$ 
125,257 
1.98 % $ 
182,877 
2.48 % 
Total year-end outstanding 
$ 
125,257 
1.98 % $ 
182,877 
2.48 % 
Average outstanding 
$ 
164,613 
2.61 % $ 
199,290 
1.69 % 
Maximum outstanding at any month-end 
$ 
183,928 
n/a $ 
229,727 
n/a 
Table of Contents 
115 

Note 9: SUBORDINATED DEBT AND MANDATORILY REDEEMABLE TRUST PREFERRED SECURITIES 
At December 31, 2024, the Company had five wholly-owned subsidiary grantor trusts (the Trusts), which had issued $86.5 million of Trust Preferred Securities (TPS) to third parties, as well as 
$2.7 million of common capital securities, carried as other assets, which were issued to the Company. TPS and common capital securities accrue and pay distributions periodically at specified 
annual rates, as provided in the indentures, based on a spread over SOFR (Secured Overnight Financing Rate). The Trusts used the proceeds from the offerings to purchase a like amount of 
junior subordinated debentures (the Debentures) of the Company. The Debentures are the sole assets of the Trusts. The Company’s obligations under the debentures and related documents, 
taken together, constitute a full and unconditional guarantee by the Company of the obligations of the Trusts. The TPS are mandatorily redeemable upon the maturity of the Debentures, or 
upon earlier redemption as provided in the indentures. The Company has the right to redeem the Debentures in whole on or after specific dates, at a redemption price specified in the 
indentures plus any accrued but unpaid interest to the redemption date. During the years ended December 31, 2024 and 2023, no debentures were redeemed. At December 31, 2024, the 
remaining Trusts comprised $86.5 million or 4.3% of the Company’s total risk-based capital. 
The following table is a summary of TPS at December 31, 2024 (dollars in thousands): 
Name of Trust 
Aggregate 
Liquidation 
Amount of Trust 
Preferred 
Securities 
Aggregate 
Liquidation 
Amount of 
Common Capital 
Securities 
Aggregate 
Principal Amount 
of Junior 
Subordinated 
Debentures 
Stated 
Maturity (1) 
Current 
Interest 
Rate 
Reset 
Period 
Interest Rate Spread (3) 
Banner Capital Trust V 
$ 
25,000 
$ 
774 
$ 
25,774 
2035 
6.35 % 
Quarterly 
Three-month SOFR + 1.83% 
Banner Capital Trust VI 
25,000 
774 
25,774 
2037 
6.38 
Quarterly 
Three-month SOFR + 1.88% 
Banner Capital Trust VII 
25,000 
774 
25,774 
2037 
6.23 
Quarterly 
Three-month SOFR + 1.64% 
Greater Sacramento Bancorp Statutory Trust II 
4,000 
124 
4,124 
2035 
6.30 
Quarterly 
Three-month SOFR + 1.94% 
Mission Oaks Statutory Trust I 
7,500 
232 
7,732 
2036 
6.27 
Quarterly 
Three-month SOFR + 1.91% 
Total TPS liability at par 
$ 
86,500 
$ 
2,678 
89,178 
6.32 % 
Fair value adjustment (2) 
(21,701) 
Total TPS liability at fair value (2) 
$ 
67,477 
(1) All of the Company’s TPS are eligible for redemption. 
(2) The Company has elected to use fair value accounting on the Debentures. 
(3) The interest rate spread includes a 0.26% upward adjustment for the transition from LIBOR to SOFR. 
On June 30, 2020, Banner issued and sold in an underwritten offering $100.0 million aggregate principal amount of 5.00% Fixed-to-Floating Rate Subordinated Notes due 2030 (Notes) at a 
public offering price equal to 100% of the aggregate principal amount of the Notes, resulting in net proceeds, after underwriting discounts and estimated offering expenses, of approximately 
$98.1 million. The interest rate on the Notes remains fixed equal to 5.00% for the first 5 years, after 5 years the interest rate changes to a floating interest rate tied to a benchmark rate, which is 
expected to be Three-Month Term SOFR, plus a spread of 489 basis points. The Notes will mature on June 30, 2030. On or after June 30, 2025, the Company may redeem the Notes, in whole 
or in part.  During 2023 and 2024, the Bank purchased a portion of these notes as an available-for-sale investment, which are eliminated upon consolidation. 
The Notes are unsecured obligations and are subordinated in right of payment to all existing and future indebtedness, deposits and other liabilities of the Company’s current and future 
subsidiaries, including the Bank’s deposits as well as the Company’s subsidiaries’ liabilities to general creditors and liabilities arising during the ordinary course of business. The Notes are 
included in Tier 2 capital for the Company under current regulatory guidelines and interpretations. 
Table of Contents 
116 

Note 10: INCOME TAXES 
The following table presents the components of the provision for income taxes included in the Consolidated Statements of Operations for the 
years ended December 31, 2024, 2023 and 2022 (in thousands): 
Years Ended December 31 
2024 
2023 
2022 
Current 
Federal 
$ 
22,648 
$ 
28,805 
$ 
26,653 
State 
7,843 
6,296 
5,882 
Total Current 
30,491 
35,101 
32,535 
Deferred 
Federal 
10,567 
7,698 
11,595 
State 
(471) 
664 
1,267 
Total Deferred 
10,096 
8,362 
12,862 
Provision for income taxes 
$ 
40,587 
$ 
43,463 
$ 
45,397 
The following table presents the reconciliation of the provision for income taxes based on the federal statutory rate to the actual effective rate 
by amount and percent for the year ended December 31, 2024 (amounts in thousands): 
Year Ended December 31 
2024 
Amount 
Percent 
Federal income tax statutory rate 
$ 
43,992 
21.0 % 
State income taxes, net of federal tax offset (1) 
6,174 
3.0 
State audits and amended returns 
4 
— 
Tax credits 
(9,597) 
(4.6) 
Low income housing tax credit partnerships, net of amortization 
6,791 
3.2 
Nontaxable and nondeductible items: 
Tax-exempt interest 
(6,914) 
(3.3) 
Investment in life insurance 
(1,930) 
(0.9) 
Other 
2,067 
1.0 
Provision for income taxes and effective income tax rate 
$ 
40,587 
19.4 % 
(1) State taxes in California and Oregon made up the majority (greater than 50 percent) of the tax effect in this category. 
Table of Contents 
117 

The following table presents the reconciliation of the federal statutory rate to the actual effective rate by percent for the years ended 
December 31, 2023 and 2022: 
Years Ended December 31 
2023 
2022 
Percent 
Percent 
Federal income tax statutory rate 
21.0 % 
21.0 % 
State Income taxes, net of federal tax offset 
2.6 
2.3 
State audits and amended returns 
— 
(0.1) 
Tax credits 
(2.7) 
(1.9) 
Low income housing partnerships, net of amortization 
2.0 
1.4 
Nontaxable and nondeductible items: 
Tax-exempt interest 
(3.6) 
(3.6) 
Investment in life insurance 
(0.9) 
(0.7) 
Other 
0.7 
0.5 
Provision for income taxes and effective income tax rate 
19.1 % 
18.9 % 
The following table presents income taxes paid (net of refunds received) for the year ended December 31, 2024 (in thousands): 
Income Taxes Paid 
US federal 
$ 
20,000 
US state and local 
California 
2,705 
Oregon 
1,215 
Idaho 
220 
Utah 
39 
Montana 
15 
Total 
$ 
24,194 
Table of Contents 
118 

The following table reflects the effect of temporary differences that gave rise to the components of the net deferred tax asset as of 
December 31, 2024 and 2023 (in thousands): 
December 31 
2024 
2023 
Deferred tax assets: 
Loan loss and REO 
$ 
41,045 
$ 
39,495 
Deferred compensation 
22,983 
21,470 
Net operating loss carryforward 
10,482 
12,967 
Federal and state tax credits 
758 
758 
State net operating losses 
3,757 
3,978 
Loan discount 
379 
625 
Lease liability 
10,416 
11,547 
Unrealized loss on securities—available-for-sale, net 
87,709 
91,455 
Other 
1,191 
4,222 
Total deferred tax assets 
178,720 
186,517 
Deferred tax liabilities: 
Depreciation 
(3,783) 
(5,428) 
Deferred loan fees, servicing rights and loan origination costs 
(12,575) 
(13,008) 
Intangibles 
(2,922) 
(3,313) 
Right of use asset 
(9,583) 
(10,378) 
Financial instruments accounted for under fair value accounting 
(815) 
(841) 
Total deferred tax liabilities 
(29,678) 
(32,968) 
Deferred income tax asset 
149,042 
153,549 
Valuation allowance 
(184) 
(184) 
Deferred tax asset, net 
$ 
148,858 
$ 
153,365 
Deferred tax assets and liabilities are measured using enacted tax rates expected to apply to taxable income in the years in which those 
temporary differences are expected to be recognized or settled. The effect on deferred tax assets and liabilities of a change in tax rates is 
recognized in income tax expense in the period of enactment. 
At December 31, 2024, the Company had federal net operating loss carryforwards of approximately $49.9 million. The Company also has 
$53.0 million of state net operating loss carryforwards, against which the Company has established a $184,000 valuation reserve. The federal 
and state net operating losses will expire, if unused, by the end of 2034. The Company has federal general business credit carryforwards at 
December 31, 2024 of $219,000, which will expire, if unused, by the end of 2031. The Company also has federal alternative minimum tax 
credit carryforwards of $538,000, which are available to reduce future federal regular income taxes, if any, over an indefinite period. At 
December 31, 2023, the Company had federal and state net operating loss carryforwards of approximately $61.7 million and $56.8 million, 
respectively, and federal general business credits carryforwards of $219,000 and federal alternative minimum tax credit carryforwards of 
approximately $538,000.  
As a consequence of the Company’s 2015 acquisition of Starbuck Bancshares, Inc., the Company experienced a change in control within the 
meaning of Section 382 of the Code. In addition, the underlying Section 382 limitations at Starbuck Bancshares, Inc.’s level continue to 
apply to the Company. Section 382 limits the ability of a corporate taxpayer to use net operating loss carryforwards, general business credits, 
and recognized built-in-losses, on an annual basis, incurred prior to the change in control against income earned after the change in control.  
As a result of the Section 382 limitations, the Company is limited to utilizing $21.5 million on an annual basis (after the application of the 
Section 382 limitations carried over from Starbuck Bancshares, Inc.) of federal net operating loss carryforwards, general business credits, and 
recognized built-in losses. The applicable state Section 382 limitations range from $575,000 to $21.5 million. In 2017, the Company 
established a $184,000 valuation reserve against the portion of its various state net operating loss carryforwards and tax credits that it believed 
it is more likely than not that it would not realize the benefit because the application of the Section 382 limitations at the state level is based 
on future apportionment rates. 
As a consequence of Banner’s capital raise in June 2010, the Company experienced a change in control within the meaning of Section 382 of 
the Code. As a result of the Section 382 limitations, the Company is limited to utilizing $6.9 million of net operating loss carryforwards 
which existed prior to the acquisition of Starbuck Bancshares, Inc., on an annual basis. Based on its analysis, the Company believes it is more 
likely than not that the June 2010 change in control will not impact its ability to utilize all of the related available net operating loss 
carryforwards, general business credits, and recognized built-in-losses. As of December 31, 2024, the Company had utilized all federal net 
operating losses and credits limited due to the June 2010 change in control. Certain state net operating losses subject to the change of control 
limitations are still outstanding. 
Table of Contents 
119 

As a consequence of the Company’s 2019 acquisition of AltaPacific and AltaPacific Bank, the Company did not experience a change in 
control within the meaning of Section 382 of the Code. However, the underlying Section 382 limitations at AltaPacific and AltaPacific Bank 
continue to apply to the Company. As a result of the Section 382 limitations, the Company is limited to utilizing $110,000 of the federal net 
operating loss carryovers and general business credits acquired from AltaPacific and AltaPacific Bank based on underlying limits carried 
over. Based on its analysis, the Company believes it is more likely than not that the Section 382 limitations will not impact its ability to 
utilize all of the related available net operating loss carryforwards and general business credits. 
Retained earnings at December 31, 2024 and 2023 included approximately $5.4 million in tax basis bad debt reserves for which no income 
tax liability has been recorded. In the future, if this tax bad debt reserve is used for purposes other than to absorb bad debts or the Company 
no longer qualifies as a bank or is completely liquidated, the Company will incur a federal tax liability at the then-prevailing corporate tax 
rate, estimated as $1.1 million at December 31, 2024. 
A reconciliation of the beginning and ending amount of total unrecognized state tax benefits for the years ended December 31, 2024 and 
2023, is as follows (in thousands): 
Years Ended December 31 
2024 
2023 
Balance, beginning of year 
$ 
2,000 
$ 
1,600 
Changes related to prior year tax positions 
— 
149 
Changes related to current year tax positions 
— 
251 
Balance, end of year 
$ 
2,000 
$ 
2,000 
None of the unrecognized tax benefits, if recognized, would materially affect the effective tax rate. The Company does not anticipate that the 
amount of unrecognized tax benefits will significantly increase or decrease in the next twelve months.  The Company’s policy is to recognize 
interest and penalties on unrecognized tax benefits in income tax expense. The amount of interest and penalties accrued for the years ended 
December 31, 2024, 2023 and 2022 is immaterial. The Company files consolidated income tax returns in Oregon, California, Utah, Montana 
and Idaho and for federal purposes.  The Company is no longer subject to tax examination for tax years before 2021. 
Tax credit investments:  The Company invests in low income housing tax credit funds that are designed to generate a return primarily through 
the realization of federal tax credits. The Company accounts for these investments by amortizing the cost of tax credit investments over the 
life of the investment using a proportional amortization method and this tax credit investment amortization expense is a component of the 
provision for income taxes. The current balance of these tax credit investments is included in other assets, while the unfunded commitments 
are included in accrued expenses and other liabilities on the Consolidated Statements of Financial Condition. 
The following table presents the balances of the Company’s tax credit investments and related unfunded commitments at December 31, 2024 
and 2023 (in thousands): 
December 31, 2024 
December 31, 2023 
Tax Credit Investments: 
Total commitments 
$ 
153,618 
$ 
103,453 
Unfunded commitments 
94,416 
62,594 
The following table presents other information related to the Company’s tax credit investments for the years ended December 31, 2024, 2023 
and 2022 (in thousands): 
For the years ended December 31, 
2024 
2023 
2022 
Tax credits and other tax benefits recognized 
$ 
12,072 
$ 
8,018 
$ 
5,621 
Tax credit amortization expense included in provision for income taxes 
9,334 
6,449 
4,638 
Note 11: EMPLOYEE BENEFIT PLANS 
Employee Retirement Plans: Substantially all Company and Bank employees are eligible to participate in its 401(k)/Profit Sharing Plan, a 
defined contribution and profit sharing plan sponsored by the Company. Employees may elect to have a portion of their salary contributed to 
the plan in conformity with Section 401(k) of the Internal Revenue Code. At the discretion of the Company’s Board of Directors, the 
Company may elect to make matching and/or profit-sharing contributions for the employees’ benefit. For the years ended December 31, 
2024, 2023 and 2022, $7.1 million, $6.7 million and $6.9 million, respectively, was expensed for the Company’s 401(k) contributions.  
During 2024, the Board of Directors elected to make a matching contribution of 4% of eligible compensation. 
Table of Contents 
120 

Supplemental Retirement and Salary Continuation Plans: Through the Bank, the Company is obligated under various non-qualified deferred 
compensation plans to help supplement the retirement income of certain executives, including certain retired executives, selected by 
resolution of the Bank’s Boards of Directors or in certain cases by the former directors of acquired banks. These plans are unfunded, include 
both defined benefit and defined contribution plans, and provide for payments after the executive’s retirement. In the event of a participant 
employee’s death prior to or during retirement, the Company is obligated to pay to the designated beneficiary the benefits set forth under the 
plan. For the years ended December 31, 2024, 2023 and 2022, expense recorded for supplemental retirement and salary continuation plan 
benefits totaled $2.2 million, $2.5 million, and $2.0 million, respectively. At December 31, 2024 and 2023, liabilities recorded for the various 
supplemental retirement and salary continuation plan benefits totaled $34.8 million and $36.1 million, respectively, and are recorded in a 
deferred compensation liability account. 
Deferred Compensation Plans and Rabbi Trusts:  The Company and the Bank also offer non-qualified deferred compensation plans to 
members of their Boards of Directors and certain employees. The plans permit each participant to defer a portion of director fees, non-
qualified retirement contributions, salary or bonuses for future receipt. Compensation is charged to expense in the period earned. In 
connection with its acquisitions, the Company also assumed liability for certain deferred compensation plans for key employees, retired 
employees and directors. 
In order to fund the plans’ future obligations, the Company has purchased life insurance policies or other investments, including Banner 
common stock, which in certain instances are held in irrevocable trusts commonly referred to as “Rabbi Trusts.” As the Company is the 
owner of the investments and the beneficiary of the insurance policies, and in order to reflect the Company’s policy to pay benefits equal to 
the accumulations, the assets and liabilities are reflected in the Consolidated Statements of Financial Condition. Banner common stock held 
for such plans is reported as a contra-equity account and was recorded at an original cost of $6.2 million at December 31, 2024 and $6.6 
million at December 31, 2023. At December 31, 2024 and 2023, liabilities recorded in connection with deferred compensation plan benefits 
totaled $18.8 million ($6.2 million in contra-equity) and $15.8 million ($6.6 million in contra-equity), respectively, and are recorded in 
deferred compensation or equity as appropriate. 
The Bank has purchased, or acquired through mergers, life insurance policies in connection with the implementation of certain executive 
supplemental retirement, salary continuation and deferred compensation retirement plans, as well as additional policies not related to any 
specific plan. These policies provide protection against the adverse financial effects that could result from the death of a key employee and 
provide tax-exempt income to offset expenses associated with the plans. It is the Bank’s intent to hold these policies as a long-term 
investment. However, there will be an income tax impact if the Bank chooses to surrender certain policies. Although the lives of individual 
current or former management-level employees are insured, the Bank is the owner and sole or partial beneficiary. At December 31, 2024 and 
2023, the cash surrender value of these policies was $312.5 million and $304.4 million, respectively. The Bank is exposed to credit risk to the 
extent an insurance company is unable to fulfill its financial obligations under a policy. In order to mitigate this risk, the Bank uses a variety 
of insurance companies and regularly monitors their financial condition. 
Note 12: STOCK-BASED COMPENSATION PLANS 
The Company operates the following stock-based compensation plans as approved by its shareholders: 
• 
2014 Omnibus Incentive Plan (the 2014 Plan). 
• 
2018 Omnibus Incentive Plan (the 2018 Plan). 
• 
2023 Omnibus Incentive Plan (the 2023 Plan). 
The purpose of these plans is to promote the success and enhance the value of the Company by providing a means for attracting and retaining 
highly skilled employees, officers and directors of Banner and its affiliates and linking their personal interests with those of the Company’s 
shareholders.  Under these plans, the Company currently has outstanding restricted stock share grants and restricted stock unit grants. 
2014 Omnibus Incentive Plan 
The 2014 Plan was approved by shareholders on April 22, 2014. The 2014 Plan provides for the grant of incentive stock options, non-
qualified stock options, stock appreciation rights, restricted stock, restricted stock units, performance shares, performance units, other stock-
based awards and other cash awards, and provides for vesting requirements which may include time-based or performance-based conditions.  
The Company reserved 900,000 shares of its common stock for issuance under the 2014 Plan in connection with the exercise of awards. As 
of December 31, 2024, a total of 277,304 restricted stock shares and 597,096 restricted stock units have been granted under the 2014 Plan, of 
which no restricted stock shares and 158,478 restricted stock units were unvested. 
2018 Omnibus Incentive Plan 
The 2018 Plan was approved by shareholders on April 24, 2018. The 2018 Plan provides for the grant of incentive stock options, non-
qualified stock options, stock appreciation rights, restricted stock, restricted stock units, performance shares, performance units, other stock-
based awards and other cash awards, and provides for vesting requirements which may include time-based or performance-based conditions.  
The Company reserved 900,000 shares of common stock for issuance under the 2018 Plan in connection with the exercise of awards. As of 
December 31, 2024, 814,182 restricted stock units have been granted under the 2018 Plan, of which 270,679 were unvested. 
Table of Contents 
121 

2023 Omnibus Incentive Plan 
The 2023 Plan was approved by shareholders on May 24, 2023. The 2023 Plan provides for the grant of incentive stock options, non-
qualified stock options, stock appreciation rights, restricted stock, restricted stock units, performance shares, performance units, other stock-
based awards and other cash awards, and provides for vesting requirements which may include time-based or performance-based conditions.  
The Company reserved 625,000 shares of common stock for issuance under the 2023 Plan in connection with the exercise of awards. As of 
December 31, 2024, 4,927 restricted stock shares and 9,798 restricted stock units have been granted under the 2023 Plan, all of which were 
unvested. 
The expense associated with all restricted stock grants (including restricted stock shares and restricted stock units) was $10.0 million, $9.2 
million and $8.9 million for the years ended December 31, 2024, 2023 and 2022, respectively. Unrecognized compensation expense for these 
awards as of December 31, 2024 was $13.5 million and will be recognized over a weighted average period of 11 months. 
A summary of the Company’s Restricted Stock/Unit award activity during the years ended December 31, 2024, 2023 and 2022 follows: 
Shares/Units 
Weighted Average Grant-
Date Fair Value 
Unvested at January 1, 2021 
476,222 
$ 
43.62 
Granted (138,022 non-voting) 
139,574 
58.87 
Vested 
(193,082) 
45.30 
Forfeited 
(39,987) 
47.63 
Unvested at December 31, 2022 
382,727 
49.98 
Granted (203,464 non-voting) 
208,273 
53.64 
Vested 
(217,262) 
42.87 
Forfeited 
(16,158) 
55.43 
Unvested at December 31, 2023 
357,580 
55.44 
Granted (262,222 non-voting) 
276,947 
47.18 
Vested 
(166,144) 
54.62 
Forfeited 
(24,501) 
53.37 
Unvested at December 31, 2024 
443,882 
$ 
50.82 
Table of Contents 
122 

Note 13: REGULATORY CAPITAL REQUIREMENTS 
Banner is a bank holding company registered with the Federal Reserve.  Bank holding companies are subject to capital adequacy requirements 
of the Federal Reserve under the Bank Holding Company Act of 1956, as amended, and the regulations of the Federal Reserve. Banner Bank, 
as a state-chartered federally insured commercial bank, is subject to the capital requirements established by the FDIC. The Federal Reserve 
requires Banner to maintain capital adequacy that generally parallels the FDIC requirements. 
The following table shows the regulatory capital ratios of the Company and the Bank and the minimum regulatory requirements (dollars in 
thousands): 
Actual 
Minimum for Capital 
Adequacy Purposes 
Minimum to be 
Categorized as “Well 
Capitalized” Under 
Prompt Corrective Action 
Provisions 
Amount 
Ratio 
Amount 
Ratio 
Amount 
Ratio 
December 31, 2024: 
Banner Corporation—consolidated: 
Total capital to risk-weighted assets 
$ 2,024,046 
15.04 % $ 1,076,652 
8.00 % $ 1,345,814 
10.00 % 
Tier 1 capital to risk-weighted assets 
1,760,065 
13.08 
807,489 
6.00 
807,489 
6.00 
Tier 1 capital to average leverage assets 
1,760,065 
11.05 
636,913 
4.00 
n/a 
n/a 
Tier 1 common equity to risk-weighted assets 
1,673,565 
12.44 
605,616 
4.50 
n/a 
n/a 
Banner Bank: 
Total capital to risk-weighted assets 
1,890,438 
14.03 
1,077,725 
8.00 
1,347,157 
10.00 
Tier 1 capital to risk-weighted assets 
1,726,457 
12.82 
808,294 
6.00 
1,077,725 
8.00 
Tier 1 capital to average leverage assets 
1,726,457 
10.83 
637,392 
4.00 
796,740 
5.00 
Tier 1 common equity to risk-weighted assets 
1,726,457 
12.82 
606,221 
4.50 
875,652 
6.50 
December 31, 2023: 
Banner Corporation—consolidated: 
Total capital to risk-weighted assets 
$ 1,904,533 
14.58 % $ 1,045,181 
8.00 % $ 1,306,476 
10.00 % 
Tier 1 capital to risk-weighted assets 
1,650,872 
12.64 
783,886 
6.00 
783,886 
6.00 
Tier 1 capital to average leverage assets 
1,650,872 
10.56 
625,387 
4.00 
n/a 
n/a 
Tier 1 common equity to risk-weighted assets 
1,564,372 
11.97 
587,914 
4.50 
n/a 
n/a 
Banner Bank: 
Total capital to risk-weighted assets 
1,789,371 
13.69 
1,045,273 
8.00 
1,306,592 
10.00 
Tier 1 capital to risk-weighted assets 
1,635,710 
12.52 
783,955 
6.00 
1,045,273 
8.00 
Tier 1 capital to average leverage assets 
1,635,710 
10.46 
625,298 
4.00 
781,622 
5.00 
Tier 1 common equity to risk-weighted assets 
1,635,710 
12.52 
587,966 
4.50 
849,285 
6.50 
At December 31, 2024, Banner and the Bank each exceeded the requirements to be “well capitalized” and the fully phased-in capital 
conservation buffer requirement. There have been no conditions or events since December 31, 2024 that have materially adversely changed 
the Tier 1 or Tier 2 capital of the Company or the Bank. However, events beyond the control of the Bank, such as weak or depressed 
economic conditions in areas where the Bank has most of its loans, could adversely affect future earnings and, consequently, the ability of the 
Bank to meet its respective capital requirements. The Company may not declare or pay cash dividends on, or repurchase, any of its shares of 
common stock if the effect thereof would cause equity to be reduced below applicable regulatory capital maintenance requirements or if such 
declaration and payment would otherwise violate regulatory requirements. 
Note 14: GOODWILL, OTHER INTANGIBLE ASSETS AND MORTGAGE SERVICING RIGHTS 
Goodwill and Other Intangible Assets:  At December 31, 2024, intangible assets are comprised of goodwill and CDI acquired in business 
combinations. Goodwill is not amortized but is reviewed at least annually for impairment. Banner has identified one reporting unit for 
purposes of evaluating goodwill for impairment. At December 31, 2024, the Company completed an assessment of qualitative factors and 
concluded that no further analysis was required as it is more likely than not that the fair value of the Bank, the reporting unit, exceeds the 
carrying value. 
CDI represents the value of transaction-related deposits and the value of the client relationships associated with the deposits. The Company 
amortizes CDI assets over their estimated useful lives and reviews them at least annually for events or circumstances that could impair their 
value. The CDI assets shown in the table below represent the value ascribed to the long-term deposit relationships acquired in various bank 
acquisitions.  
Table of Contents 
123 

The following table summarizes the changes in the Company’s goodwill and other intangibles for the years ended December 31, 2024, 2023 
and 2022 (in thousands): 
Goodwill 
CDI 
Total 
Balance,  January 1, 2022 
$ 
373,121 
$ 
14,855 
$ 
387,976 
Amortization 
— 
(5,279) 
(5,279) 
Other Changes (1) 
— 
(136) 
(136) 
Balance, December 31, 2022 
373,121 
9,440 
382,561 
Amortization 
— 
(3,756) 
(3,756) 
Balance, December 31, 2023 
373,121 
5,684 
378,805 
Amortization 
— 
(2,626) 
(2,626) 
Balance, December 31, 2024 
$ 
373,121 
$ 
3,058 
$ 
376,179 
(1) 
Acquired CDI was adjusted for the sale of branches in 2022. 
Estimated amortization expense with respect to CDI as of December 31, 2024 for the periods indicated (in thousands): 
Year ended: 
Estimated Amortization 
2025 
$ 
1,567 
2026 
904 
2027 
426 
2028 
126 
2029 
35 
Net carrying amount 
$ 
3,058 
Mortgage Servicing Rights: Mortgage and SBA servicing rights are reported in other assets. SBA servicing rights are initially recorded and 
carried at fair value. Mortgage servicing rights are initially recognized at fair value and are amortized in proportion to, and over the period of, 
the estimated future net servicing income of the underlying financial assets. Mortgage servicing rights are subsequently evaluated for 
impairment based upon the fair value of the rights compared to the amortized cost (remaining unamortized initial fair value). If the fair value 
is less than the amortized cost, a valuation allowance is created through an impairment charge to servicing fee income. However, if the fair 
value is greater than the amortized cost, the amount above the amortized cost is not recognized in the carrying value. In 2024, 2023 and 2022, 
the Company did not record any impairment charges or recoveries against mortgage servicing rights. Unpaid principal balance of loans for 
which mortgage and SBA servicing rights have been recognized totaled $2.84 billion and $2.78 billion at December 31, 2024 and 2023, 
respectively. Custodial accounts maintained in connection with this servicing totaled $12.2 million and $11.6 million at December 31, 2024 
and 2023, respectively. 
An analysis of the mortgage and SBA servicing rights for the years ended December 31, 2024, 2023 and 2022, is presented below (in 
thousands): 
Years Ended December 31 
2024 
2023 
2022 
Balance, beginning of the year 
$ 
14,649 
$ 
16,166 
$ 
17,206 
Additions—amounts capitalized 
1,802 
1,590 
3,200 
Additions—through purchase 
211 
313 
285 
Amortization (1) 
(3,304) 
(3,325) 
(4,216) 
Fair value adjustments (2) 
129 
(95) 
(309) 
Balance, end of the year (2) 
$ 
13,487 
$ 
14,649 
$ 
16,166 
(1) 
Amortization of mortgage servicing rights is recorded as a reduction of loan servicing income within mortgage banking operations and 
any unamortized balance is fully amortized if the loan repays in full. 
(2) 
Fair value adjustments relate to SBA servicing rights. These adjustments are estimated based on an independent dealer analysis by 
discounting estimated net future cash flows from servicing SBA loans. 
Table of Contents 
124 

Note 15: FAIR VALUE OF FINANCIAL INSTRUMENTS 
The following table presents estimated fair values of the Company’s financial instruments as of December 31, 2024 and 2023, whether or not 
recognized or recorded in the Consolidated Statements of Financial Condition (in thousands): 
December 31, 2024 
December 31, 2023 
Level 
Carrying Value 
Estimated Fair 
Value 
Carrying Value 
Estimated Fair 
Value 
Assets: 
Cash and cash equivalents 
1 
$ 
501,858 
$ 
501,858 
$ 
254,464 
$ 
254,464 
Securities—available-for-sale 
2 
2,078,826 
2,078,826 
2,348,479 
2,348,479 
Securities—available-for-sale 
3 
25,685 
25,685 
25,304 
25,304 
Securities—held-to-maturity 
2 
995,237 
819,230 
1,052,028 
900,522 
Securities—held-to-maturity 
3 
6,327 
6,298 
7,027 
6,992 
Loans held for sale 
2 
32,021 
32,215 
11,170 
11,219 
Loans receivable, net 
3 
11,199,135 
10,894,024 
10,660,812 
10,250,271 
Equity securities 
1 
481 
481 
449 
449 
FHLB stock 
3 
22,451 
22,451 
24,028 
24,028 
Bank-owned life insurance 
1 
312,549 
312,549 
304,366 
304,366 
Mortgage servicing rights 
3 
12,618 
37,926 
13,909 
35,794 
SBA servicing rights 
3 
869 
869 
740 
740 
Investments in limited partnerships 
3 
13,955 
13,955 
13,475 
13,475 
Derivatives: 
Interest rate swaps 
2 
14,507 
14,507 
15,129 
15,129 
Interest rate lock and forward sales 
commitments 
2,3 
331 
331 
275 
275 
Liabilities: 
Demand, interest checking and money market 
accounts 
2 
8,536,303 
8,536,303 
8,571,500 
8,571,500 
Regular savings 
2 
3,478,423 
3,478,423 
2,980,530 
2,980,530 
Certificates of deposit 
2 
1,499,672 
1,492,829 
1,477,467 
1,465,612 
FHLB advances 
2 
290,000 
290,000 
323,000 
323,000 
Other borrowings 
2 
125,257 
125,257 
182,877 
182,877 
Subordinated notes, net 
2 
80,278 
78,832 
92,851 
85,536 
Junior subordinated debentures 
3 
67,477 
67,477 
66,413 
66,413 
Derivatives: 
Interest rate swaps 
2 
30,184 
30,184 
29,809 
29,809 
Interest rate lock and forward sales 
commitments 
2,3 
2 
2 
185 
185 
Risk participation agreement 
2 
6 
6 
42 
42 
The Company measures and discloses certain assets and liabilities at fair value. Fair value is defined as the price that would be received to 
sell an asset or paid to transfer a liability in an orderly transaction between market participants at the measurement date (that is, not a forced 
liquidation or distressed sale). When measuring fair value, Management will maximize the use of observable inputs and minimize the use of 
unobservable inputs whenever possible. Observable inputs reflect market data obtained from independent sources, while unobservable inputs 
reflect the Company’s estimates for market assumptions. 
The estimated fair value amounts of financial instruments have been determined by the Company using available market information and 
appropriate valuation methodologies. However, considerable judgment is required to interpret data to develop the estimates of fair 
value. Accordingly, the estimates presented herein are not necessarily indicative of the amounts the Company could realize at a future 
date. The use of different market assumptions and/or estimation methodologies may have a material effect on the estimated fair value 
amounts. In addition, reasonable comparability between financial institutions may not be likely due to the wide range of permitted valuation 
techniques and numerous estimates that must be made given the absence of active secondary markets for many of the financial 
instruments.  This lack of uniform valuation methodologies also introduces a greater degree of subjectivity to these estimated fair values. 
Table of Contents 
125 

Items Measured at Fair Value on a Recurring Basis: 
The following tables present financial assets and liabilities measured at fair value on a recurring basis and the level within the fair value 
hierarchy of the fair value measurements for those assets and liabilities as of December 31, 2024 and 2023 (in thousands): 
December 31, 2024 
Level 1 
Level 2 
Level 3 
Total 
Assets: 
Securities—available-for-sale 
U.S. Government and agency obligations 
$ 
— 
$ 
7,933 
$ 
— 
$ 
7,933 
Municipal bonds 
— 
123,982 
— 
123,982 
Corporate bonds 
— 
99,305 
25,685 
124,990 
Mortgage-backed or related securities 
— 
1,676,848 
— 
1,676,848 
Asset-backed securities 
— 
170,758 
— 
170,758 
— 
2,078,826 
25,685 
2,104,511 
Loans held for sale (1) 
— 
26,185 
— 
26,185 
Equity securities 
481 
— 
— 
481 
SBA servicing rights 
— 
— 
869 
869 
Investment in limited partnerships 
— 
— 
13,955 
13,955 
Derivatives 
Interest rate swaps 
— 
14,507 
— 
14,507 
Interest rate lock and forward sales commitments 
— 
221 
110 
331 
$ 
481 
$ 
2,119,739 
$ 
40,619 
$ 
2,160,839 
Liabilities: 
Junior subordinated debentures 
$ 
— 
$ 
— 
$ 
67,477 
$ 
67,477 
Derivatives 
Interest rate swaps 
— 
30,184 
— 
30,184 
Interest rate lock and forward sales commitments 
— 
— 
2 
2 
Risk participation agreement 
— 
6 
— 
6 
$ 
— 
$ 
30,190 
$ 
67,479 
$ 
97,669 
Table of Contents 
126 

December 31, 2023 
Level 1 
Level 2 
Level 3 
Total 
Assets: 
Securities—available-for-sale 
U.S. Government and agency obligations 
— 
34,189 
— 
34,189 
Municipal bonds 
— 
132,905 
— 
132,905 
Corporate bonds 
— 
93,819 
25,304 
119,123 
Mortgage-backed or related securities 
— 
1,866,714 
— 
1,866,714 
Asset-backed securities 
— 
220,852 
— 
220,852 
— 
2,348,479 
25,304 
2,373,783 
Loans held for sale(1) 
— 
9,105 
— 
9,105 
Equity securities 
449 
— 
— 
449 
SBA servicing rights 
— 
— 
740 
740 
Investment in limited partnerships 
— 
— 
13,475 
13,475 
Derivatives 
Interest rate swaps 
— 
15,129 
— 
15,129 
Interest rate lock and forward sales commitments 
— 
— 
275 
275 
$ 
449 
$ 
2,372,713 
$ 
39,794 
$ 
2,412,956 
Liabilities 
Junior subordinated debentures 
$ 
— 
$ 
— 
$ 
66,413 
$ 
66,413 
Derivatives 
Interest rate swaps 
— 
29,809 
— 
29,809 
Interest rate lock and forward sales commitments 
— 
161 
24 
185 
Risk participation agreement 
— 
42 
— 
42 
$ 
— 
$ 
30,012 
$ 
66,437 
$ 
96,449 
(1) 
The unpaid principal balance of one- to four family residential loans held for sale carried at fair value on a recurring basis was 
$25.7 million and $8.8 million at December 31, 2024 and 2023, respectively. 
The following methods were used to estimate the fair value of each class of financial instruments above: 
Securities:  The estimated fair values of investment securities and mortgage-backed securities are priced using current active market quotes, if 
available, which are considered Level 1 measurements. For most of the portfolio, matrix pricing based on the securities’ relationship to other 
benchmark quoted prices is used to establish the fair value. These measurements are considered Level 2. Due to the continued limited 
activity in the trust preferred markets that have limited the observability of market spreads for some of the Company’s TPS securities, 
Management has classified these securities, included in Corporate Bonds, as a Level 3 fair value measure. Management periodically reviews 
the pricing information received from third-party pricing services and tests those prices against other sources to validate the reported fair 
values. 
Loans Held for Sale:  Fair values for residential mortgage loans held for sale are determined by comparing actual loan rates to current 
secondary market prices for similar loans. 
Equity Securities:  Equity securities are invested in a publicly traded stock. The fair value of these securities is based on daily quoted market 
prices. 
SBA Servicing Rights: Fair values are estimated based on an independent dealer analysis by discounting estimated net future cash flows from 
servicing. The evaluation utilizes assumptions market participants would use in determining fair value including prepayment speeds, 
delinquency and foreclosure rates, the discount rate, servicing costs, and the timing of cash flows. The SBA servicing portfolio is stratified by 
loan type and fair value estimates are adjusted up or down based on the serviced loan interest rates versus current rates on new loan 
originations since the most recent independent analysis. 
Table of Contents 
127 

Junior Subordinated Debentures: The fair value of junior subordinated debentures is estimated using an income approach technique. The 
significant inputs included in the estimation of fair value are the credit risk adjusted spread and three month SOFR. The credit risk adjusted 
spread represents the nonperformance risk of the liability. The Company utilizes an external valuation firm to validate the reasonableness of 
the credit risk adjusted spread used to determine the fair value. The junior subordinated debentures are carried at fair value which represents 
the estimated amount that would be paid to transfer these liabilities in an orderly transaction amongst market participants. Due to inactivity in 
the trust preferred markets that have limited the observability of market spreads, Management has classified this as a Level 3 fair value 
measurement. 
Derivatives:  Derivatives include interest rate swap agreements, interest rate lock commitments to originate loans held for sale, forward sales 
contracts to sell loans and securities related to mortgage banking activities and risk participation agreements. Fair values for these 
instruments, which generally change as a result of changes in the level of market interest rates, are estimated based on dealer quotes and 
secondary market sources. As the interest rate lock commitments use a pull-through rate that is considered an unobservable input, these 
derivatives are classified as a level 3 fair value measurement. 
Off-Balance Sheet Items:  Off-balance sheet financial instruments include unfunded commitments to extend credit, including standby letters 
of credit, and commitments to purchase investment securities.  The fair value of these instruments is not considered to be material. 
Limitations: The fair value estimates presented herein are based on pertinent information available to Management as of December 31, 2024 
and 2023. The factors used in the fair value estimates are subject to change subsequent to the dates the fair value estimates are completed; 
therefore, current estimates of fair value may differ significantly from the amounts presented herein. 
Assets and Liabilities Measured at Fair Value Using Significant Unobservable Inputs (Level 3): 
The following table provides a description of the valuation technique, unobservable inputs and quantitative and qualitative information about 
the unobservable inputs for the Company’s assets and liabilities classified as Level 3 and measured at fair value on a recurring and non-
recurring basis at December 31, 2024 and 2023: 
Weighted Average Rate or Range 
December 31 
Financial Instruments 
Valuation Technique 
Unobservable Inputs 
2024 
2023 
Corporate bonds (TPS) 
Discounted cash flows 
Discount rate 
9.57 % 
10.84 % 
Junior subordinated debentures 
Discounted cash flows 
Discount rate 
9.57 % 
10.84 % 
Loans individually evaluated 
Collateral valuations 
Discount to appraised value 
0% to 75% 
8.75% to 25% 
Interest rate lock commitments 
Pricing model 
Pull-through rate 
92.34 % 
88.24 % 
SBA servicing rights 
Discounted cash flows 
Constant prepayment rate 
18.85 % 
16.92 % 
TPS: Management believes that the credit risk-adjusted spread used to develop the discount rate utilized in the fair value measurement of 
TPS is indicative of the risk premium a willing market participant would require under current market conditions for instruments with similar 
contractual rates and terms and conditions and issuers with similar credit risk profiles and with similar expected probability of default.  
Management attributes the change in fair value of these instruments, compared to their par value, primarily to perceived general market 
adjustments to the risk premiums for these types of assets subsequent to their issuance. 
Junior subordinated debentures: Similar to the TPS discussed above, Management believes the credit risk-adjusted spread utilized in the fair 
value measurement of the junior subordinated debentures is indicative of the risk premium a willing market participant would require under 
current market conditions for an issuer with Banner’s credit risk profile. Management attributes the change in fair value of the junior 
subordinated debentures, compared to their par value, primarily to perceived general market adjustments to the risk premiums for these types 
of liabilities subsequent to their issuance. Future contractions in the risk-adjusted spread relative to the spread currently utilized to measure 
the Company’s junior subordinated debentures at fair value as of December 31, 2024, or the passage of time, will result in negative fair value 
adjustments. At December 31, 2024, the discount rate utilized was based on a credit spread of 526 basis points and three month SOFR of 431 
basis points. 
Interest rate lock commitments: The fair value of the interest rate lock commitments is based on secondary market sources adjusted for an 
estimated pull-through rate. The pull-through rate is based on historical loan closing rates for similar interest rate lock commitments. An 
increase or decrease in the pull-through rate would have a corresponding, positive or negative fair value adjustment. 
SBA servicing asset:  The constant prepayment rate (CPR) is set based on industry data. An increase in the CPR would result in a negative 
fair value adjustment, where a decrease in CPR would result in a positive fair value adjustment. 
Table of Contents 
128 

The following table provides a reconciliation of the assets and liabilities measured at fair value using significant unobservable inputs (Level 
3) on a recurring basis during the years ended December 31, 2024 and 2023 (in thousands): 
Level 3 Fair Value Inputs 
TPS Securities 
Borrowings— 
Junior 
Subordinated 
Debentures 
Interest Rate 
Lock and 
Forward Sales 
Commitments 
Investments in 
Limited 
Partnerships 
SBA Servicing 
Asset 
Balance, January 1, 2023 
$ 
28,694 
$ 
74,857 $ 
39 
$ 
12,427 $ 
835 
Net change recognized in earnings 
(3,375) 
— 
212 
(719) 
(95) 
Net change recognized in AOCI 
(15) 
(8,444) 
— 
— 
— 
Purchases, issuances and settlements 
— 
— 
— 
1,767 
— 
Balance, December 31, 2023 
25,304 
66,413 
251 
13,475 
740 
Net change recognized in earnings 
115 
— 
(143) 
(1,013) 
129 
Net change recognized in AOCI 
266 
1,064 
— 
— 
— 
Purchases, issuances and settlements 
— 
— 
— 
1,493 
— 
Balance, December 31, 2024 
$ 
25,685 
$ 
67,477 $ 
108 
$ 
13,955 $ 
869 
Interest income, dividends and amortization related to TPS are recorded as a component of interest income. Interest expense related to the 
junior subordinated debentures is measured based on contractual interest rates and reported in interest expense. The change in fair value of 
the junior subordinated debentures, which represents changes in instrument specific credit risk. The change in fair value of the TPS was 
recorded as a component of non-interest income when it was held for trading. After the transfer of the TPS to available-for-sale in late 2023, 
the change in fair value is recorded in other comprehensive income. The change in fair value of the investment in limited partnerships and the 
SBA servicing asset are recorded as a component of non-interest income. The change in fair value of the interest rate lock and forward sales 
commitments are included in mortgage banking operations in non-interest income.  
Items Measured at Fair Value on a Non-recurring Basis 
The following tables present financial assets and liabilities measured at fair value on a non-recurring basis and the level within the fair value 
hierarchy of the fair value measurements for those assets at December 31, 2024 and 2023 (in thousands): 
December 31, 2024 
Level 1 
Level 2 
Level 3 
Total 
Loans individually evaluated 
$ 
— 
$ 
— 
$ 
6,590 
$ 
6,590 
REO 
— 
— 
2,367 
2,367 
December 31, 2023 
Level 1 
Level 2 
Level 3 
Total 
Loans individually evaluated 
$ 
— 
$ 
— 
$ 
8,308 
$ 
8,308 
REO 
— 
— 
526 
526 
The following table presents the gains and losses resulting from non-recurring fair value adjustments for the years ended December 31, 2024, 
2023 and 2022 (in thousands): 
For the years ended December 31, 
2024 
2023 
2022 
Loans individually evaluated 
$ 
(1,483) $ 
(933) $ 
(626) 
Loans held for sale (1) 
— 
2,538 
(2,538) 
Total loss from non-recurring measurements 
$ 
(1,483) $ 
1,605 
$ 
(3,164) 
(1) Gains and losses related to loans held for sale were due to the multifamily real estate loans held for sale until the loans were transferred to 
loans held in portfolio in the fourth quarter of 2023. 
Table of Contents 
129 

Loans individually evaluated: Expected credit losses for loans evaluated individually are measured based on the present value of expected 
future cash flows discounted at the loan’s original effective interest rate or when the Bank determines that foreclosure is probable, the 
expected credit loss is measured based on the fair value of the collateral as of the reporting date, less estimated selling costs, as applicable. As 
a practical expedient, the Bank measures the expected credit loss for a loan using the fair value of the collateral, if repayment is expected to be 
provided substantially through the operation or sale of the collateral when the borrower is experiencing financial difficulty based on the 
Bank’s assessment as of the reporting date. In both cases, if the fair value of the collateral is less than the amortized cost basis of the loan, the 
Bank will recognize an allowance as the difference between the fair value of the collateral, less costs to sell (if applicable) and the amortized 
cost basis of the loan. If the fair value of the collateral exceeds the amortized cost basis of the loan, any expected recovery added to the 
amortized cost basis will be limited to the amount previously charged-off. Subsequent changes in the expected credit losses for loans 
evaluated individually are included within the provision for credit losses in the same manner in which the expected credit loss initially was 
recognized or as a reduction in the provision that would otherwise be reported. 
REO:  The Company records REO (acquired through a lending relationship) at fair value on a non-recurring basis. Fair value adjustments on 
REO are based on updated real estate appraisals which are based on current market conditions. All REO properties are recorded at the lower 
of the estimated fair value of the real estate, less expected selling costs, or the carrying amount of the defaulted loans. From time to time, 
non-recurring fair value adjustments to REO are recorded to reflect partial write-downs based on an observable market price or current 
appraised value of property. Banner considers any valuation inputs related to REO to be Level 3 inputs. The individual carrying values of 
these assets are reviewed for impairment at least annually and any additional impairment charges are expensed. 
Note 16: BANNER CORPORATION (PARENT COMPANY ONLY) 
Summary financial information is as follows (in thousands): 
Statements of Financial Condition 
December 31 
2024 
2023 
ASSETS 
Cash 
$ 
75,712 
$ 
108,513 
Investment in trust equities 
2,678 
2,678 
Investment in subsidiaries 
1,813,001 
1,709,153 
Note receivable from subsidiary 
50,000 
— 
Other assets 
11,446 
10,467 
Total assets 
$ 
1,952,837 
$ 
1,830,811 
LIABILITIES AND SHAREHOLDERS’ EQUITY 
Miscellaneous liabilities 
$ 
6,879 
$ 
7,838 
Deferred tax liability, net 
4,377 
4,518 
Subordinated notes, net 
99,778 
99,351 
Junior subordinated debentures at fair value 
67,477 
66,413 
Shareholders’ equity 
1,774,326 
1,652,691 
Total liabilities and shareholders’ equity 
$ 
1,952,837 
$ 
1,830,811 
Statements of Operations 
Years Ended December 31 
2024 
2023 
2022 
INTEREST INCOME: 
Interest-bearing deposits 
$ 
2,919 
$ 
844 
$ 
80 
Note receivable from subsidiary 
1,559 
— 
— 
OTHER INCOME (EXPENSE): 
Dividend income from subsidiaries 
87,799 
104,004 
101,931 
Equity in undistributed income of subsidiaries 
91,179 
92,018 
104,391 
Other income 
186 
1 
96 
Interest expense on other borrowings 
(11,764) 
(11,568) 
(8,400) 
Other expenses 
(5,801) 
(5,491) 
(6,092) 
Net income before taxes 
166,077 
179,808 
192,006 
BENEFIT FROM INCOME TAXES 
(2,821) 
(3,816) 
(3,372) 
NET INCOME 
$ 
168,898 
$ 
183,624 
$ 
195,378 
Table of Contents 
130 

Statements of Cash Flows 
Years Ended December 31 
2024 
2023 
2022 
OPERATING ACTIVITIES: 
Net income 
$ 
168,898 
$ 
183,624 
$ 
195,378 
Adjustments to reconcile net income to net cash provided by operating 
activities: 
Equity in undistributed income of subsidiaries 
(91,179) 
(92,018) 
(104,391) 
Decrease in deferred taxes 
114 
(52) 
(43) 
Net change in valuation of financial instruments carried at fair value 
(186) 
253 
(56) 
Share-based compensation 
10,031 
9,169 
8,870 
Loss on extinguishment of debt 
— 
— 
765 
Net change in other assets 
(793) 
442 
(4,169) 
Net change in other liabilities 
374 
(609) 
3,765 
Net cash provided from operating activities 
87,259 
100,809 
100,119 
INVESTING ACTIVITIES: 
Other investing activities 
(1,155) 
488 
(1,549) 
Reduction in investment in subsidiaries 
— 
— 
(3,072) 
Increase in note receivables from subsidiaries 
(50,000) 
— 
— 
Net cash (used by) provided investing activities 
(51,155) 
488 
(4,621) 
FINANCING ACTIVITIES: 
Repayment of junior subordinated debentures 
— 
— 
(50,518) 
Proceeds from redemption of trust securities related to junior subordinated 
debentures 
— 
— 
1,518 
Taxes paid related to net share settlement for equity awards 
(2,172) 
(3,476) 
(3,332) 
Repurchase of common stock 
— 
— 
(10,960) 
Cash dividends paid 
(66,733) 
(66,765) 
(61,078) 
Net cash used by financing activities 
(68,905) 
(70,241) 
(124,370) 
NET CHANGE IN CASH 
(32,801) 
31,056 
(28,872) 
CASH, BEGINNING OF PERIOD 
108,513 
77,457 
106,329 
CASH, END OF PERIOD 
$ 
75,712 
$ 
108,513 
$ 
77,457 
Note 17: CALCULATION OF EARNINGS PER COMMON SHARE 
The following table reconciles basic to diluted weighted average shares outstanding used to calculate earnings per share data (dollars in 
thousands, except per share data): 
Years Ended December 31 
2024 
2023 
2022 
Net income 
$ 
168,898 
$ 
183,624 
$ 
195,378 
Basic weighted average shares outstanding 
34,470,057 
34,344,142 
34,264,322 
Dilutive effect of unvested restricted stock 
158,653 
106,270 
195,600 
Diluted weighted shares outstanding 
34,628,710 
34,450,412 
34,459,922 
Earnings per common share 
Basic 
$ 
4.90 
$ 
5.35 
$ 
5.70 
Diluted 
$ 
4.88 
$ 
5.33 
$ 
5.67 
Anti-dilutive restricted stock excluded from the diluted average outstanding share 
calculation (1) 
1,929 
21,865 
— 
(1) 
Anti-dilution occurs when the unrecognized compensation cost per share of restricted stock exceeds the current market price of the 
Company’s stock. 
131 
Table of Contents 

Note 18: COMMITMENTS AND CONTINGENCIES 
Financial Instruments with Off-Balance Sheet Risk - The Company has financial instruments with off-balance-sheet risk generated in the 
normal course of business to meet the financing needs of its clients. These financial instruments include commitments to extend credit, 
commitments related to standby letters of credit, commitments to originate loans, commitments to sell loans, and commitments to buy or sell 
securities. These instruments involve, to varying degrees, elements of credit and interest rate risk similar to the risk involved in on-balance 
sheet items. 
Our exposure to credit loss in the event of nonperformance by the other party to the financial instrument from commitments to extend credit 
and standby letters of credit is represented by the contractual notional amount of those instruments. We use the same credit policies in 
making commitments and conditional obligations as on-balance sheet instruments. 
Outstanding commitments consisted of the following at the dates indicated (in thousands): 
Contract or Notional Amount 
December 31, 2024 
December 31, 2023 
Commitments to extend credit 
$ 
3,843,421 $ 
3,887,423 
Standby letters of credit and financial guarantees 
28,287 
29,312 
Commitments to originate loans 
14,361 
27,487 
Risk participation agreements 
43,913 
46,348 
Derivatives also included in Note 19: 
Commitments to originate loans held for sale 
35,512 
19,572 
Commitments to sell loans secured by one- to four-family residential properties 
17,963 
8,437 
Commitments to sell securities related to mortgage banking activities 
37,500 
17,000 
In addition to the commitments disclosed in the table above, the Company is also committed to funding the unfunded portion of its tax credit 
investments, as discussed previously in Note 10, Income Taxes, as well as the remaining unfunded portion of its investments in limited 
partnerships. As of December 31, 2024 and 2023, the remaining outstanding commitments related to the unfunded tax credit investments and 
limited partnership investments were as follows (in thousands): 
Unfunded commitment balance for: 
December 31, 2024 
December 31, 2023 
Tax credit investments 
$ 
94,416 $ 
62,594 
Limited partnerships investments 
$ 
14,706 $ 
10,462 
Commitments to extend credit are agreements to lend to a client, as long as there is no violation of any condition established in the 
contract. Commitments generally have fixed expiration dates or other termination clauses and may require payment of a fee. Many of the 
commitments may expire without being drawn upon; therefore, the total commitment amounts do not necessarily represent future cash 
requirements. Each client’s creditworthiness is evaluated on a case-by-case basis. The amount of collateral obtained, if deemed necessary 
upon extension of credit, is based on Management’s credit evaluation of the client. Collateral held varies, but may include accounts 
receivable, inventory, property, plant and equipment, and income producing commercial properties. The Company’s allowance for credit 
losses - unfunded loan commitments was $13.6 million and $14.5 million at December 31, 2024 and 2023, respectively. 
Standby letters of credit are conditional commitments issued to guarantee a client’s performance or payment to a third party. The credit risk 
involved in issuing letters of credit is essentially the same as that involved in extending loan facilities to clients. Under a risk participation 
agreement, the Bank guarantees the financial performance of a borrower on the participated portion of an interest rate swap on a loan. 
Interest rates on one- to four-family residential loan applications are typically rate locked (committed) to clients during the application stage 
for periods ranging from 30 to 60 days, the most typical period being 45 days. Traditionally, these loan applications with rate lock 
commitments have the pricing for the sale of these loans locked with various qualified investors under a best-efforts delivery program at or 
near the time the interest rate is locked with the client. The Bank then attempts to deliver these loans before their rate locks expire. This 
arrangement generally requires delivery of the loans prior to the expiration of the rate lock. Delays in funding the loans may require a lock 
extension. The cost of a lock extension is sometimes covered by the client and other times by the Bank. These lock extension costs have not 
had a material impact to the Company’s operations. For mandatory delivery commitments the Company enters into forward commitments at 
specific prices and settlement dates to deliver either: (1) residential mortgage loans for purchase by secondary market investors (i.e., Freddie 
Mac or Fannie Mae), or (2) mortgage-backed securities to broker/dealers. The purpose of these forward commitments is to offset the 
movement in interest rates between the execution of its residential mortgage rate lock commitments with borrowers and the sale of those loans 
to the secondary market investor. There were no counterparty default losses on forward contracts during 2024 and 2023. Market risk with 
respect to forward contracts arises principally from changes in the value of contractual positions due to changes in interest rates. The 
Company limits its exposure to market risk by monitoring differences between commitments to clients and forward contracts with market 
investors and securities broker/dealers. In the event the Company has forward delivery contract commitments in excess of available mortgage 
loans, the transaction is completed by either paying or receiving a fee to or from the investor or broker/dealer equal to the increase or decrease 
in the market value of the forward contract.  Changes in the value of rate lock commitments are recorded as assets and liabilities. 
132 
Table of Contents 

In the normal course of business, the Company and/or its subsidiaries have various legal proceedings and other contingent matters 
outstanding. These proceedings and the associated legal claims are often contested and the outcome of individual matters is not always 
predictable. These claims and counterclaims typically arise during the course of collection efforts on problem loans or with respect to action 
to enforce liens on properties in which the Bank holds a security interest. Based upon the information known to Management, there were no 
legal proceedings, pending or threatened, that Management believes would have a material adverse effect on the results of operations or 
consolidated financial position at December 31, 2024. 
In connection with certain asset sales, the Bank typically makes representations and warranties about the underlying assets conforming to 
specified guidelines. If the underlying assets do not conform to the specifications, the Bank may have an obligation to repurchase the assets 
or indemnify the purchaser against any loss. 
The Bank believes that the potential for material loss under these arrangements is 
remote.  Accordingly, the fair value of such obligations is not material. 
Note 19: DERIVATIVES AND HEDGING 
The Company is party to various derivative instruments that are used for asset and liability management and client financing needs.  
Derivative instruments are contracts between two or more parties that have a notional amount and an underlying variable, require no net 
investment and allow for the net settlement of positions. The notional amount serves as the basis for the payment provision of the contract 
and takes the form of units, such as shares or dollars. The underlying variable represents a specified interest rate, index, or other component.  
The interaction between the notional amount and the underlying variable determines the number of units to be exchanged between the parties 
and influences the market value of the derivative contract. 
The Company’s predominant derivative and hedging activities involve interest rate swaps related to certain term loans and forward sales 
contracts associated with mortgage banking activities. Generally, these instruments help the Company manage exposure to market risk and 
meet client financing needs. Market risk represents the possibility that economic value or net interest income will be adversely affected by 
fluctuations in external factors such as market-driven interest rates and prices or other economic factors. 
As of December 31, 2024 and 2023, the notional values or contractual amounts and fair values of the Company’s derivatives were as follows 
(in thousands): 
Asset Derivatives 
Liability Derivatives 
December 31, 2024 
December 31, 2023 
December 31, 2024 
December 31, 2023 
Notional/ 
Contract 
Amount 
Fair   
Value 
Notional/ 
Contract 
Amount 
Fair  
Value 
Notional/ 
Contract 
Amount 
Fair  
Value 
Notional/ 
Contract 
Amount 
Fair  
Value 
Hedged interest rate swaps 
$ 
— 
$ 
— 
$ 
— 
$ 
— 
$ 
— 
$ 
— 
$ 400,000 
$ 15,141 
Interest rate swaps not 
designated in hedge 
relationships 
$ 386,995 
$ 30,134 
$ 416,711 
$ 29,058 
$ 386,995 
$ 30,184 
$ 416,711 
$ 29,126 
Master netting agreements 
(15,627) 
(13,929) 
— 
(13,929) 
Cash offset/(settlement) 
— 
— 
— 
(529) 
Net interest rate swaps 
14,507 
15,129 
30,184 
29,809 
Risk participation agreements 
817 
— 
1,050 
— 
43,097 
6 
45,298 
42 
Mortgage loan commitments 
30,085 
108 
19,572 
275 
5,427 
2 
— 
— 
Forward sales contracts 
49,628 
223 
5,406 
— 
— 
— 
17,966 
185 
Total 
$ 467,525 
$ 14,838 
$ 442,739 
$ 15,404 
$ 435,519 
$ 30,192 
$ 479,975 
$ 30,036 
The Company’s asset derivatives are included in other assets, while the liability derivatives are included in accrued expenses and other 
liabilities on the Consolidated Statements of Financial Condition. 
Interest Rate Swaps used in Cash Flow Hedges: During the fourth quarter of 2021, the Company entered into interest rate swaps designated as 
cash flow hedges to hedge the variable cash flows associated with existing floating rate loans. These hedge contracts involved the receipt of 
fixed-rate payments from a counterparty in exchange for the Company making floating-rate payments over the life of the agreements without 
the exchange of the underlying notional amount.  In late 2024, these interest rate swap derivatives matured. 
Since the derivatives were designated and qualified as cash flow hedges, the unrealized gains and losses on these derivatives were recorded in 
AOCI and subsequently reclassified into interest income in the same period that the hedged transaction affected earnings. Amounts reported 
in AOCI related to the derivatives were reclassified to interest income as interest payments were made on the Company’s variable-rate assets.  
As these derivatives have matured, no additional amounts will be reclassified as a decrease to interest income. 
Table of Contents 
133 

The following table presents the effect of cash flow hedge accounting on AOCI for the years ended December 31, 2024 and 2023 (in 
thousands): 
For the Year Ended December 31, 2024 
Amount of 
Gain or (Loss) 
Recognized in 
AOCI on 
Derivative 
Amount of 
Gain or (Loss) 
Recognized in 
AOCI Included 
Component 
Amount of 
Gain or (Loss) 
Recognized in 
AOCI 
Excluded 
Component 
Location of 
Gain or (Loss) 
Recognized 
from AOCI 
into Income 
Amount of 
Gain or (Loss) 
Reclassified 
from AOCI 
into Income 
Amount of 
Gain or (Loss) 
Reclassified 
from AOCI 
into Income 
Included 
Component 
Amount of 
Gain or (Loss) 
Reclassified 
from AOCI 
into Income 
Excluded 
Component 
Interest rate 
swaps 
$ 
(2,145) $ 
(2,145) $ 
— 
Interest Income $ 
(16,074) $ 
(16,074) $ 
— 
For the Year Ended December 31, 2023 
Amount of 
Gain or (Loss) 
Recognized in 
AOCI on 
Derivative 
Amount of 
Gain or (Loss) 
Recognized in 
AOCI Included 
Component 
Amount of 
Gain or (Loss)
Recognized in
AOCI 
Excluded 
Component 
 
 
Location of 
Gain or (Loss) 
Recognized 
from AOCI 
into Income 
Amount of 
Gain or (Loss) 
Reclassified 
from AOCI 
into Income 
Amount of 
Gain or (Loss) 
Reclassified 
from AOCI 
into Income 
Included 
Component 
Amount of 
Gain or (Loss) 
Reclassified 
from AOCI 
into Income 
Excluded 
Component 
Interest rate 
swaps 
$ 
(4,398) $ 
(4,398) $ 
— 
Interest Income $ 
(16,955) $ 
(16,955) $ 
— 
At December 31, 2024, no net unrealized gains or losses on cash flow hedges remain in AOCI, compared to a loss of $10.6 million at 
December 31, 2023. 
Interest Rate Swaps:  The Bank offers an interest rate swap program for commercial loan clients that provides the client with a variable-rate 
loan and enters into an interest rate swap in which the client receives a variable-rate payment in exchange for a fixed-rate payment. The Bank 
offsets its risk exposure by entering into an offsetting interest rate swap with a dealer counterparty for the same notional amount and length of 
term as the client interest rate swap providing the dealer counterparty with a fixed-rate payment in exchange for a variable-rate payment.  
These swaps do not qualify as designated hedges; therefore, each swap is accounted for as a freestanding derivative. 
Risk Participation Agreements:  In conjunction with the purchase or sale of participating interests in loans, the Company also participates in 
related swaps through risk participation agreements. The existing credit derivatives resulting from these participations are not designated as 
hedges as they are not used to manage interest rate risk in the Company’s assets or liabilities and are not speculative.  
Mortgage Loan Commitments:  The Company sells originated one- to four-family residential loans into the secondary mortgage loan markets.  
During the period of loan origination and prior to the sale of the loans in the secondary market, the Company has exposure to movements in 
interest rates associated with written interest rate lock commitments with potential borrowers to originate one- to four-family residential loans 
that are intended to be sold and for closed one- to four-family residential loans held for sale for which fair value accounting has been elected, 
that are awaiting sale and delivery into the secondary market. The Company economically hedges the risk of changing interest rates 
associated with these one- to four-family residential loan commitments by entering into forward sales contracts to sell these loans or 
mortgage-backed securities to broker/dealers at specific prices and dates. 
Gains (losses) recognized in income within mortgage banking operations on non-designated hedging instruments for the years ended 
December 31, 2024, 2023 and 2022, were as follows (in thousands): 
For the Years Ended December 31 
2024 
2023 
2022 
Mortgage loan commitments 
$ 
(79) $ 
263 
$ 
(1,427) 
Forward sales contracts 
320 
313 
84 
$ 
241 
$ 
576 
$ 
(1,343) 
The Company is exposed to credit-related losses in the event of nonperformance by the counterparty to these agreements. Credit risk of the 
financial contract is controlled through the credit approval, limits, and monitoring procedures and Management does not expect the 
counterparties to fail their obligations. 
134 
Table of Contents 

In connection with the interest rate swaps between the Bank and the dealer counterparties, the agreements contain a provision where if the 
Bank fails to maintain its status as a well or adequately capitalized institution, then the counterparty could terminate the derivative positions 
and the Bank would be required to settle its obligations. Similarly, the Bank could be required to settle its obligations under certain of its 
agreements if specific regulatory events occur, such as a publicly issued prompt corrective action directive, cease and desist order, or a capital 
maintenance agreement that required the Bank to maintain a specific capital level. If the Bank had breached any of these provisions, it could 
have been required to settle its obligations under the agreements at the termination value. As of December 31, 2024 and 2023, the Company 
had no obligations to dealer counterparties related to these agreements. The Company generally posts collateral against derivative liabilities 
in the form of cash, government agency-issued bonds, mortgage-backed securities, or commercial mortgage-backed securities. Collateral 
posted against derivative liabilities was $19.9 million and $15.0 million as of December 31, 2024 and 2023, respectively. The collateral 
posted included restricted cash of $18.9 million and $14.0 million as of December 31, 2024 and 2023, respectively. 
Derivative assets and liabilities are recorded at fair value on the balance sheet. Master netting agreements allow the Company to settle all 
derivative contracts held with a single counterparty on a net basis and to offset net derivative positions with related collateral where 
applicable. In addition, some interest rate swap derivatives between the Company and the dealer counterparties are cleared through central 
clearing houses. These clearing houses characterize the variation margin payments as settlements of the derivative’s market exposure and not 
as collateral. The variation margin is treated as an adjustment to our cash collateral, as well as a corresponding adjustment to our derivative 
asset or liability. As of December 31, 2024 and 2023, the variation margin adjustment was a positive adjustment of $15.6 million and 
negative adjustment of $529,000, respectively. 
The following presents additional information related to the Company’s interest rate swaps, both designated and non-designated as hedged, as 
of December 31, 2024 and 2023 (in thousands): 
December 31, 2024 
Gross Amounts of Financial 
Instruments Not Offset in the 
Consolidated Statement of 
Financial Condition 
Gross 
Amounts 
Recognized 
Amounts 
offset in the 
Statement of 
Financial 
Condition 
Net Amounts
in the 
Statement of 
Financial 
Condition 
 
Netting 
Adjustment Per 
Applicable 
Master Netting 
Agreements 
Fair Value of 
Financial 
Collateral in the 
Statement of 
Financial 
Condition 
Net Amount 
Derivative assets 
Interest rate swaps 
$ 
30,134 
$ 
(15,627) $ 
14,507 
$ 
— 
$ 
— 
$ 
14,507 
$ 
30,134 
$ 
(15,627) $ 
14,507 
$ 
— 
$ 
— 
$ 
14,507 
Derivative liabilities 
Interest rate swaps 
$ 
30,184 
$ 
— 
$ 
30,184 
$ 
— 
$ 
(18,228) $ 
11,956 
$ 
30,184 
$ 
— 
$ 
30,184 
$ 
— 
$ 
(18,228) $ 
11,956 
December 31, 2023 
Gross Amounts of Financial 
Instruments Not Offset in the 
Consolidated Statement of 
Financial Condition 
Gross 
Amounts 
Recognized 
Amounts 
offset in the 
Statement of 
Financial 
Condition 
Net Amounts 
in the 
Statement of 
Financial 
Condition 
Netting 
Adjustment Per 
Applicable 
Master Netting 
Agreements 
Fair Value of 
Financial 
Collateral in the 
Statement of 
Financial 
Condition 
Net Amount 
Derivative assets 
Interest rate swaps 
$ 
29,058 
$ 
(13,929) $ 
15,129 
$ 
— 
$ 
— 
$ 
15,129 
$ 
29,058 
$ 
(13,929) $ 
15,129 
$ 
— 
$ 
— 
$ 
15,129 
Derivative liabilities 
Interest rate swaps 
$ 
44,267 
$ 
(14,458) $ 
29,809 
$ 
— 
$ 
(13,124) $ 
16,685 
$ 
44,267 
$ 
(14,458) $ 
29,809 
$ 
— 
$ 
(13,124) $ 
16,685 
Table of Contents 
135 

Note 20: REVENUE FROM CONTRACTS WITH CLIENTS 
Disaggregation of Revenue: 
Deposit fees and other service charges for the years ended December 31, 2024, 2023 and 2022, are summarized as follows (in thousands): 
Years Ended December 31 
2024 
2023 
2022 
Deposit service charges 
$ 
24,708 
$ 
22,497 
$ 
23,710 
Debit and credit card interchange fees 
23,766 
24,021 
23,766 
Debit and credit card expense 
(12,632) 
(12,386) 
(11,487) 
Merchant services income 
13,431 
14,466 
15,551 
Merchant services expense 
(11,246) 
(11,687) 
(12,754) 
Other service charges 
5,344 
4,727 
5,673 
Total deposit fees and other service charges 
$ 
43,371 
$ 
41,638 
$ 
44,459 
Deposit fees and other service charges 
Deposit fees and other service charges include transaction and non-transaction based deposit fees. Transaction based fees on deposit accounts 
are charged to deposit clients for specific services provided to them. These fees include such items as wire fees, official check fees, and 
overdraft fees. These are contract specific to each individual transaction and do not extend beyond the individual transaction. The 
performance obligation is completed, and the fees are recognized, at the time the specific transactional service is provided to the client. Non-
transactional deposit fees are typically monthly account maintenance fees charged on deposit accounts. These are day-to-day contracts that 
can be canceled by either party without notice. The performance obligation is satisfied, and the fees are recognized, on a monthly basis after 
the service period is completed. 
Debit and credit card interchange income and expenses 
Debit and credit card interchange income represent fees earned when a credit or debit card issued by the Bank is used to purchase goods or 
services at a merchant. The merchant’s bank pays the Bank a default interchange rate set by Mastercard on a transaction-by-transaction basis.  
The merchant acquiring bank can stop accepting the Bank’s cards at any time and the Bank can stop further use of cards issued by them at any 
time. The performance obligation is satisfied, and the fees are earned, when the cost of the transaction is charged to the Bank’s cardholders’ 
card.  Direct expenses associated with the credit and debit card are recorded as a net reduction against the interchange income. 
Merchant services income 
Merchant services income represents fees earned by the Bank for card payment services provided to its merchant clients. The Bank has a 
contract with a third party to provide card payment services to the Bank’s merchants that contract for those services. The third party provider 
has contracts with the Bank’s merchants to provide the card payment services. The Bank does not have a direct contractual relationship with 
its merchants for these services. The Bank sets the rates for the services provided by the third party. The third party provider passes the 
payments made by the Bank’s merchants through to the Bank. The Bank, in turn, pays the third party provider for the services it provides to 
the Bank’s merchants.  These payments to the third party provider are recorded as expenses as a net reduction against fee income.  In addition, 
a portion of the payment received by the Bank represents interchange fees passed through to the card issuing bank. Income is primarily 
earned based on the dollar volume and number of transactions processed. The performance obligation is satisfied and the related fee is earned 
when each payment is accepted by the processing network. 
Note 21: LEASES 
The Company leases 89 buildings and offices under non-cancelable operating leases. The leases contain various provisions for increases in 
rental rates, based either on changes in the published Consumer Price Index or a predetermined escalation schedule. Substantially all of the 
leases provide the Company with the option to extend the lease term one or more times following expiration of the initial term.  The table 
below presents the lease ROU assets and lease liabilities recorded on the balance sheet at December 31, 2024 and 2023 (dollars in thousands): 
December 31, 2024 
December 31, 2023 
Assets 
Operating lease ROU assets 
$ 
39,998 
$ 
43,731 
Liabilities 
Operating lease liabilities 
$ 
43,472 
$ 
48,659 
Weighted average remaining lease term - operating leases 
4.4 years 
4.5 years 
Weighted average discount rate - operating leases 
4.0 % 
3.3 % 
Table of Contents 
136 

The table below presents certain information related to the lease costs for operating leases for the years ended December 31, 2024, 2023 and 
2022 (in thousands): 
Year Ended December 31, 
2024 
2023 
2022 
Operating lease cost 
$ 
13,863 
$ 
13,848 $ 
16,647 
Short-term lease cost 
9 
132 
125 
Variable lease cost 
2,454 
2,231 
2,189 
Less sublease income 
(1,547) 
(1,447) 
(1,126) 
Total lease cost (1) 
$ 
14,779 
$ 
14,764 $ 
17,835 
(1) Lease expenses and sublease income are classified within occupancy and equipment expense on the Consolidated Statements of Operations. 
Operating cash flows paid for operating lease amounts included in the measurement of lease liabilities were $14.9 million for the year ended 
December 31, 2024, and $14.8 million for the year ended December 31, 2023. The Company recorded $8.2 million of lease ROU assets in 
exchange for operating lease liabilities for the year ended December 31, 2024, and $6.8 million for the year ended December 31, 2023. 
The table below reconciles the undiscounted cash flows for each of the first five years beginning with 2025 and the total of the remaining 
years to the operating lease liabilities recorded on the Consolidated Statements of Financial Position (in thousands): 
Operating Leases 
2025 
$ 
14,117 
2026 
12,272 
2027 
9,307 
2028 
4,756 
2029 
3,025 
Thereafter 
3,854 
Total minimum lease payments 
47,331 
Less: amount of lease payments representing interest 
(3,859) 
Lease obligations 
$ 
43,472 
As of December 31, 2024 and 2023, the Company had no undiscounted lease payments under an operating lease that had not yet commenced. 
Table of Contents 
137 

Note 22: SEGMENT DISCLOSURES 
The Company is managed by legal entity, rather than by lines of business, and its activities are considered a single operating segment for 
financial reporting purposes. The Bank is engaged in the single line of business of community banking, which involves gathering deposits 
and originating loans in its primary market areas. The Bank manages its operations, allocates resources, and monitors and reports its 
financials as a single operating segment.  
Banner’s Chief Executive Officer is considered the Chief Operating Decision Maker (CODM). The CODM assesses performance based on 
net income that is reported on our Consolidated Statements of Operations. The CODM uses consolidated net income as the primary measure 
to evaluate resource allocations. In addition to our consolidated financial statements, specifically the statement of operations and the 
statement of cash flows, the operating and financial condition data below is used to monitor budget versus actual results and assess 
performance: 
OPERATING DATA: 
(In thousands) 
For the Year Ended December 31 
2024 
2023 
2022 
Interest income 
$ 
766,103 
$ 
701,572 
$ 
572,569 
Interest expense 
224,387 
125,567 
19,390 
Net interest income 
541,716 
576,005 
553,179 
Provision for credit losses 
7,581 
10,789 
10,364 
Non-interest income 
66,888 
44,409 
75,255 
Non-interest expense 
391,538 
382,538 
377,295 
Net income 
$ 
168,898 
$ 
183,624 
$ 
195,378 
FINANCIAL CONDITION DATA: 
(In thousands) 
December 31 
2024 
2023 
2022 
Cash and securities (1) 
$ 3,607,933 
$ 3,687,302 
$ 4,178,375 
Loans receivable, net 
11,199,135 
10,660,812 
10,005,259 
Total assets 
16,200,037 
15,670,391 
15,833,431 
Core deposits 
12,014,726 
11,552,030 
12,896,529 
Total deposits 
13,514,398 
13,029,497 
13,620,059 
KEY FINANCIAL RATIOS: 
For the Years Ended December 31 
2024 
2023 
2022 
Performance Ratios: 
Return on average assets (2) 
1.07 % 
1.18 % 
1.18 % 
Net interest margin (tax equivalent) (3) 
3.75 
4.01 
3.68 
Non-interest expense to average assets 
2.48 
2.46 
2.29 
Efficiency ratio (4) 
64.33 
61.66 
60.04 
(1) 
Includes available-for-sale and held-to-maturity securities. 
(2) 
Net income divided by average assets. 
(3) 
Net interest income as a percent of average interest-earning assets on a tax equivalent basis. 
(4) 
Non-interest expenses divided by the total of net interest income and non-interest income. 
Table of Contents 
138 

SKU:  004CTN3E23 
Member FDIC